ACCA Paper F7 (INT) Financial Reporting Essential text British library cataloguing­in­publication data A catalogue record for this book is available from the British Library. Published by: Kaplan Publishing UK Unit 2 The Business Centre Molly Millars Lane Wokingham Berkshire RG41 2QZ ISBN 978 1 84710 543 1 © Kaplan Financial Limited, 2008 Printed and bound in Great Britain. Acknowledgements We are grateful to the Association of Chartered Certified Accountants and the Chartered Institute of Management Accountants for permisssion to reproduce past examination questions. The answers have been prepared by Kaplan Publishing. All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted, in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or otherwise, without the prior written permission of Kaplan Publishing. ii KAPLAN PUBLISHING Contents Page Chapter 1 The regulatory framework 1 Chapter 2 A conceptual framework 25 Chapter 3 Accounting concepts and policies 37 Chapter 4 Principles of consolidated financial statements 53 Chapter 5 Consolidated statement of financial position 61 Chapter 6 Consolidated income statement 93 Chapter 7 Associates 109 Chapter 8 Tangible non­current assets 125 Chapter 9 Intangible assets 145 Chapter 10 Impairment of assets 159 Chapter 11 Inventories and construction contracts 169 Chapter 12 Financial assets and financial liabilities 181 Chapter 13 Leases 201 Chapter 14 Substance over form 217 Chapter 15 Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets 231 Chapter 16 Taxation 247 Chapter 17 Reporting financial performance 259 Chapter 18 Earnings per share 275 Chapter 19 Interpretation of financial statements 293 Chapter 20 Statement of cash flows 323 Chapter 21 Questions & Answers 337 KAPLAN PUBLISHING iii iv KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter Intro Paper Introduction v How to Use the Materials These Kaplan Publishing learning materials have been carefully designed to make your learning experience as easy as possible and to give you the best chances of success in your examinations. The product range contains a number of features to help you in the study process. They include: (1) Detailed study guide and syllabus objectives (2) Description of the examination (3) Study skills and revision guidance (4) Complete text or essential text (5) Question practice The sections on the study guide, the syllabus objectives, the examination and study skills should all be read before you commence your studies. They are designed to familiarise you with the nature and content of the examination and give you tips on how to best to approach your learning. The complete text or essential text comprises the main learning materials and gives guidance as to the importance of topics and where other related resources can be found. Each chapter includes: vi • The learning objectives contained in each chapter, which have been carefully mapped to the examining body's own syllabus learning objectives or outcomes. You should use these to check you have a clear understanding of all the topics on which you might be assessed in the examination. • The chapter diagram provides a visual reference for the content in the chapter, giving an overview of the topics and how they link together. • The content for each topic area commences with a brief explanation or definition to put the topic into context before covering the topic in detail. You should follow your studying of the content with a review of the illustration/s. These are worked examples which will help you to understand better how to apply the content for the topic. KAPLAN PUBLISHING • Test your understanding sections provide an opportunity to assess your understanding of the key topics by applying what you have learned to short questions. Answers can be found at the back of each chapter. • Summary diagrams complete each chapter to show the important links between topics and the overall content of the paper. These diagrams should be used to check that you have covered and understood the core topics before moving on. • Question practice is provided at the back of each text. Icon Explanations Definition ­ Key definitions that you will need to learn from the core content. Key Point ­ Identifies topics that are key to success and are often examined. Expandable Text ­ Expandable text provides you with additional information about a topic area and may help you gain a better understanding of the core content. Essential text users can access this additional content on­line (read it where you need further guidance or skip over when you are happy with the topic) Illustration ­ Worked examples help you understand the core content better. Test Your Understanding ­ Exercises for you to complete to ensure that you have understood the topics just learned. Tricky topic ­ When reviewing these areas care should be taken and all illustrations and test your understanding exercises should be completed to ensure that the topic is understood. For more details about the syllabus and the format of your exam please see your Complete Text or go online. On­line subscribers Paper introduction Syllabus objectives Paper­based examination tips KAPLAN PUBLISHING vii Study skills and revision guidance Preparing to study Effective studying Further reading You can find further reading and technical articles under the student section of ACCA's website. viii KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 1 The regulatory framework Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • • explain why a regulatory framework is necessary • distinguish between a principles­based and a rules­based framework • discuss whether a principles­based framework and a rules­ based framework can be complementary • describe the structure and objectives of the International Accounting Standards Committee (IASC) Foundation, the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB), the Standards Advisory Council (SAC) and the International Financial Reporting Interpretations Committee (IFRIC) • describe the IASB’s standard­setting process including revisions to and interpretations of standards • explain the relationship between national standard setters and the IASB in respect of the standard­setting process • describe the structure (format) and content of financial statements presented under International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) • prepare an entity’s financial statements in accordance with prescribed structure and content • distinguish between the primary aims of not­for­profit and public sector entities and those of profit­orientated entities • discuss the extent to which IFRS are relevant to specialised, not­ for­ profit and public sector entities. explain why accounting standards on their own are not a complete regulatory framework 1 The regulatory framework 1 The regulatory system Structure of the international regulatory system International Accounting Standards Committee (IASC) Foundation The IASC Foundation: • • • is the supervisory body for the new structure has 22 trustees is responsible for governance issues and ensuring each body is properly funded. The objectives of the IASC Foundation are to: • 2 develop a set of global accounting standards which are of high quality, are understandable and are enforceable KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 1 • which require high quality, transparent and comparable information in financial statements to help those in the world’s capital markets and other users make economic decisions • • promote using and applying these standards bring about the convergence of national and international accounting standards. International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) The IASB: • is solely responsible for issuing International Accounting Standards (IASs) • standards now called International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRSs) • • is made up of 14 members has the same objectives as the IASC Foundation. Expandable text International Financial Reporting Interpretations Committee (IFRIC) The IFRIC: • issues rapid guidance on accounting matters where divergent interpretations of IFRSs have arisen • issues interpretations called IFRIC 1, IFRIC 2, etc. Expandable text ­ Compliance with IFRSs Standards Advisory Council (SAC) The SAC provides a forum for a range of experts from different countries and different business sectors to offer advice to the IASB when drawing up new standards. The development of an IFRS The procedure for the development of an IFRS is as follows: • The IASB identifies a subject and appoints an advisory committee to advise on the issues. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 3 The regulatory framework • The IASB publishes an exposure draft for public comment, being a draft version of the intended standard. • Following the consideration of comments received on the draft, the IASB publishes the final text of the IFRS. • At any stage the IASB may issue a discussion paper to encourage comment. • The publication of an IFRS, exposure draft or IFRIC interpretation requires the votes of at least eight of the 14 IASB members. Expandable text ­ Status of IFRSs Benchmark treatment and allowed alternative treatment Some older IASs have two choices of treatment of items in the financial statements: • • the benchmark treatment, and the allowed alternative treatment. In future IFRSs: • • If different treatments are allowed they will be given equal status. No treatment will be designated as the benchmark treatment. This is the case in IFRS 3 (revised), issued in 2008, which provides a choice of treatment with regard to goodwill. The IASB and national standard setters The intentions of the IASB are: • to develop a single set of understandable and enforceable high quality worldwide accounting standards, however • • the IASB cannot enforce compliance with its standards, therefore it needs the co­operation of national standard setters. In order to achieve this the IASB works in partnership with the major national standard­setting bodies: • 4 All the most important national standard setters are represented on the IASB and their views are taken into account so that a consensus can be reached. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 1 • All national standard setters can issue IASB discussion papers and exposure drafts for comment in their own countries, so that the views of all preparers and users of financial statements can be represented. • Each major national standard setter ‘leads’ certain international standard­setting projects. Expandable text Test your understanding 1 What would be the advantages of international harmonisation of accounting standards for investors and potential investors? The regulatory framework The regulatory framework of accounting in each country which uses IFRS is affected by a number of legislative and quasi­legislative influences as well as IFRS: • • • national company law EU directives security exchange rules. Why a regulatory framework is necessary A regulatory framework for the preparation of financial statements is necessary for the following reasons: • Financial statements are used by a wide range of users – investors, lenders, customers, etc. • • • • They need to be useful to these users. • They regulate the behaviour of companies towards their investors. They need to be comparable. They need to provide at the least some basic information. They increase users’ understanding of, and confidence in, financial statements. Accounting standards on their own would not be a complete regulatory framework. In order to fully regulate the preparation of financial statements and the obligations of companies and directors, legal and market regulations are also required. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 5 The regulatory framework Principles­based and rules­based framework Principles­based framework: • • based upon a conceptual framework such as the IASB's Framework accounting standards are set on the basis of the conceptual framework. Rules­based framework: • • ‘Cookbook’ approach accounting standards are a set of rules which companies must follow. In the UK there is a principles­based framework in terms of the Statement of Principles and accounting standards and a rules­based framework in terms of the Companies Acts, EU directives and stock exchange rulings. Test your understanding 2 What are the objectives of the IASC Foundation? 2 Preparation of financial statements for companies IAS 1 Presentation of financial statements In most jurisdictions the structure and content of financial statements are defined by local law. IASs are, however, designed to work in any jurisdiction and therefore require their own set of requirements for presentation of financial statements. This is provided in IAS 1, revised 2007. A complete set of financial statements comprises: • • a statement of financial position either – a statement of comprehensive income, or – • • • an income statement plus a statement showing other comprehensive income a statement of changes in equity a statement of cash flows accounting policies and explanatory notes. IAS 1 (revised) does not require the above titles to be used by companies. It is likely in practice that many companies will continue to use the previous terms of balance sheet rather than statement of financial position and cash flow statement rather than statement of cash flows. 6 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 1 The statement of financial position A recommended format is as follows: XYZ Group Statement of Financial Position as at 31 December 20X2 Assets Non­current assets: Property, plant and equipment Goodwill Other intangible assets $ $ X X X ––– X Current assets: Inventories Trade receivables Cash and cash equivalents X X X ––– X –– X ––– Total assets Equity and liabilities Capital and reserves: Share capital Retained earnings Other components of equity Total equity KAPLAN PUBLISHING X X X –– X –– X –– 7 The regulatory framework Non­current liabilities: Long­term borrowings Deferred tax Current liabilities: Trade and other payables Short­term borrowings Current tax payable Short­term provisions X X –– X X X X –– X –– X –– Total equity and liabilities • • X it will be settled within 12 months of the reporting date, or it is part of the entity's normal operating cycle. Within the capital and reserves section of the statement of financial position, other components of equity include: • • revaluation reserve general reserve. Statement of changes in equity The statement of changes in equity provides a summary of all changes in equity arising from transactions with owners in their capacity as owners. This includes the effect of share issues and dividends. Other non­owner changes in equity are disclosed in aggregate only. 8 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 1 XYZ Group Statement of changes in equity for the year ended 31 December 20X2 Share Share Revaluation Retained Total capital premium surplus earnings equity Balance at 31 December 20X1 Change in accounting policy Restated balance Dividends Issue of share capital Total comprehensive income for the year Transfer to retained earnings Balance at 31 December 20X2 $ X $ X –– X –– X X X –– X –– X $ X $ X $ X (X) (X) –– X –– X (X) –– X (X) X X X X (X) X ­ –– X –– X –– X Statement of comprehensive income Total comprehensive income is the realised profit or loss for the period, plus other comprehensive income. Other comprehensive income is income and expenses that are not recognised in profit or loss (i.e. they are recorded in reserves rather than as an element of the realised profit for the period). For the purposes of F7, other comprehensive income includes any change in the revaluation surplus. IAS 1 allows a choice of two presentations of comprehensive income: (1) A statement of comprehensive income showing total comprehensive income , or (2) An income statement showing the realised profit or loss for the period PLUS a statement showing other comprehensive income. Throughout this text, other than where indicated, the second approach will be adopted. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 9 The regulatory framework Statement of comprehensive income A recommended format is as follows: XYZ Group : Statement of comprehensive income for the year ended 31 December 20X2 $ Revenue X Cost of sales (X) –– Gross profit X Distribution costs Administrative expenses Profit from operations Finance costs Profit before tax Income tax expense Profit for the year Other comprehensive income Gain on property revaluation X Income tax relating to components of other comprehensive income (X) –– Other comprehensive income for the year, net of tax X –– X –– Total comprehensive income for the year 10 (X) (X) –– X (X) –– X (X) –– X KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 1 Income statement plus statement of comprehensive income A recommended format for the income statement is as follows: XYZ Group Income statement for the year ended 31 December 20X2 Revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Distribution costs Administrative expenses Profit from operations Finance costs Profit before tax Income tax expense Net profit for the period $ X (X) –– X (X) (X) –– X (X) –– X (X) –– X A recommended format for the presentation of other comprehensive income is: XYZ Group Other comprehensive income for the year ended 31 December 20X2 $ Profit for the year X Other comprehensive income Gain on property revaluation Income tax relating to components of other Comprehensive income Other comprehensive income for the year, net of tax Total comprehensive income for the year KAPLAN PUBLISHING X (X) –– X –– X –– 11 The regulatory framework Test your understanding 3 Slamometer, which has traded for many years, has an authorised and issued capital of 60,000 5.6% redeemable preference shares of $1 and 140,000 ordinary shares of $1. The ordinary shares are fully paid and qualify as equity shares. The redeemable preference shares qualify as a liability and are to be treated as such. It also has in issue $20,000 9% loan notes redeemable on 31 December 20X9. The income statement for the year ended 31 March 20X4 has been drafted: $ Profit on trading Interest received Less: Interest on loan notes Income taxes under ­provided for previous year $ 71,570 910 –––––– 72,480 1,800 870 –––––– 2,670 –––––– 69,810 –––––– The following further information is relevant: (a) Total sales revenue for the year was $1,013,000. 12 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 1 (b) Profit on trading is calculated after charging: $ Distribution costs 152,571 Raw materials 366,238 Manufacturing overheads 159,302 Wages of production employees 98,789 Salaries of sales staff 56,400 Depreciation of factory 4,000 Depreciation on plant and machinery 7,300 Office rent 2,300 Management remuneration 91,100 Auditors’ remuneration 1,500 Legal and accounting charges 620 Interest on bank overdraft 1,310 (c) Management remuneration is to be allocated as follows: Cost of sales Distribution costs Administrative expenses $12,300 $15,300 $63,500 (d) The loan note interest was paid on 31 March 20X4. (e) Income tax on the profits of the year ended 31 March 20X4 is estimated at $32,000, based on a rate of 25%. (f) The $3,360 dividend for the year on the redeemable preference shares has been paid and is treated as a finance cost. (g) The balances on the company’s retained earnings at 1 April 20X3 was $51,700 (h) An ordinary dividend of $18,360 in respect of the year ended 31 March 20X3 was paid during the year. (i) Slalometer revalued land during the year by $200,000. The tax effect is a debit of $60,000. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 13 The regulatory framework Prepare the income statement and statement showing other comprehensive income of Slamometer Limited for the year ended 31 March 20X4. Test your understanding 4 The following trial balance has been extracted from the books of Arran as at 31 March 20X7: Accounts office rent Audit fee Salaries Irrecoverable debts General administration General distribution Distribution centre storage costs Advertising Share capital (all ordinary shares of $1 each) Share premium Revaluation reserve Dividend Cash at bank and in hand Receivables Non­current asset investments Interest paid Dividends received Interest received Land and buildings at cost (land 100, buildings 100) Land and buildings: accumulated depreciation Plant and machinery at cost Plant and machinery: accumulated depreciation Retained earnings account (at 1 April 20X6) Purchases Sales Inventory at 1 April 20X6 Trade payables Bank loan 14 $000 $000 98 22 150 27 125 23 110 40 270 80 20 27 3 233 280 25 15 1 200 30 400 170 235 1,210 2,165 140 27 100 ––––– ––––– 3,113 3,113 ––––– ––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 1 Additional information (1) Inventory at 31 March 20X7 had a cost of $85,000. (2) Depreciation for the year to 31 March 20X7 is to be charged against cost of sales as follows: Buildings 5% on cost (straight line) Plant and machinery balance) 30% on carrying value (CV) (reducing (3) Income tax of $165,000 is to be provided for the year to 31 March 20X7. A dividend of 10c per share was paid. The loan is repayable in five years. (4) Non­current asset investments are to be revalued up by $100,000. (5) Salaries are to be apportioned equally between cost of sales, administration expenses and distribution costs. Prepare the statement of comprehensive income, statement of changes in equity and statement of financial position for year ended 31 March 20X7. Note: Show all workings but notes are not required. 3 Not­for­profit and public sector entities Comparison of aims The main aims of not­for­profit and public sector entities are very different to those of profit­orientated entities: Profit­orientated sector Not­for­profit/public sector Financial aim is to make profit Financial aim is to achieve value for and increase shareholder wealth. money/provide service. Directors are accountable to shareholders. Managers are accountable to trustees/government/public. External finance freely available in Finance limited to donations/ the form of loans and share government subsidies. capital. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 15 The regulatory framework Accounting standards and not­for­profit and public sector entities Accounting standards are designed to: • • • measure financial performance accurately and consistently report the financial position accurately and consistently account for the directors' stewardship of the resources and assets. Not­for­profit and public sector organisations: • do not aim to achieve a profit but will have to account for their income and costs • • will have to account for their effectiveness, economy and efficiency do not have to produce financial statements for the public (but in many cases may do so). Some measurement accounting standards will be relevant such as those relating to inventory, non­current assets, leasing, etc. Others relating purely to reporting such as earnings per share (EPS) will not be so relevant. 16 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 1 Chapter summary KAPLAN PUBLISHING 17 The regulatory framework Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 Investors increasingly make investment decisions on a worldwide basis, because businesses progressively operate across national boundaries. Therefore investors need to compare the financial statements of companies operating in different countries. At present most non­domestic investments are made by public investment companies and unit trusts which employ analysts skilled in the examination of financial statements from different countries. An individual investor would have difficulty making an informed investment decision with the present differences in international financial reporting. Test your understanding 2 The objectives of the IASC Foundation are to: (a) develop a set of global accounting standards which are of high quality, are understandable and are enforceable (b) require high quality, transparent and comparable information in financial statements to help those in the world’s capital markets and other users make economic decisions (c) promote using and applying these standards (d) bring about the convergence of national and international accounting standards. 18 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 1 Test your understanding 3 Slamometer: Income statement for the year ended 31 March 20X4 $ $ Sales revenue 1,013,000 Cost of sales (W2) (647,929) –––––––– Gross profit 365,071 Distribution costs (W2) 224,271 Administrative expenses (W2) 67,920 –––––––– (292,191) –––––––– Profit from operations 72,880 Interest receivable 910 Finance cost $(1,800 + 1,310 + 3,360) (6,470) –––––––– (5,560) –––––––– Profit before tax 67,320 Income tax expense (W1) (32,870) –––––––– Profit for the year 34,450 –––––––– Slalometer ­ Other comprehensive income for the year ended 31 March 20X4 Profit for the year Other comprehensive income Gain on property revaluation Income tax relating to components of other Comprehensive income Other comprehensive income for the year, net of tax Total comprehensive income for the year KAPLAN PUBLISHING $ 34,450 200 (60) ––––– 140 ––––– 34,590 ––––– 19 The regulatory framework Workings (W1) Taxation $ 32,000 870 –––––––– 32,870 –––––––– Income tax at 25% Tax under­provided in previous year (W2) Classification of expenses Cost of Distribution Administrative sales costs expenses $ $ $ Expenses per note (b) Distribution costs Raw materials Manufacturing overheads Staff costs Directors Depreciation $(4,000 + 7,300) Office rent Audit Legal and accountancy 152,571 366,238 159,302 98,789 12,300 11,300 –––––––– 647,929 –––––––– 56,400 15,300 63,500 –––––––– 224,271 –––––––– 2,300 1,500 620 –––––––– 67,920 –––––––– Note: 20 • Ordinary dividends declared/paid in the year are included in the statement of changes in equity, not the income statement or statement of comprehensive income. • Dividends on redeemable preference shares are always treated as a finance cost. This is covered in further detail in chapter 12. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 1 Test your understanding 4 Statement of comprehensive income for the year ended 31 March 20X7 $000 2,165 (1,389) –––––– 776 (295) (250) –––––– 231 (25) 1 15 –––––– 222 (165) –––––– 57 –––––– Revenue Cost of sales (W1) Gross profit Administration (W1) Distribution (W1) Operating profit Finance cost Interest receivable Investment income Profit before tax Income tax expense Profit for the year Other comprehensive income Gain on property revaluation 100 ––––– 157 –––––– Total comprehensive income for the year Statement of changes in equity B/f Total comprehensive income for the year Dividends C/f KAPLAN PUBLISHING Share Share Revaluation Retained Total capital premium surplus earnings equity $000 $000 $000 $000 $000 270 80 20 235 605 100 57 157 ––– 270 ––– 80 ––– 120 (27) ––– 265 (27) ––– 735 21 The regulatory framework Statement of financial position as at 31 March 20X7 $000 Non­current assets: Property, plant and equipment (W2) Investment (280 + 100) Current assets: Inventory Receivables Bank Share capital Share premium Revaluation reserve Retained earnings Non­current liabilities Current liabilities ($27 + $165) 22 326 380 85 233 3 ––– 321 –––– 1,027 –––– 270 80 120 265 –––– 735 100 192 –––– 1,027 –––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 1 Workings (W1) Costs Cost of sales $000 Accounts office rent Audit fee Salaries Irrecoverable debts General administration General distribution Distribution centre Advertising Purchase Opening inventory Closing inventory Depreciation (5% × 100) + (400 – 170) × 30% Distribution Admin $000 50 50 27 $000 98 22 50 125 23 110 40 1,210 140 (85) 74 ––––– 1,389 ––––– Total ––––– ––––– 250 295 ––––– ––––– (W2) Tangible non­current assets Land and buildings Plant and machinery Total CV b/f Depreciation charge CV c/f KAPLAN PUBLISHING $000 170 (5) $000 230 (69) $000 400 (74) ––––– 165 ––––– 161 –––– 326 23 The regulatory framework 24 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 2 A conceptual framework Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • • • describe what is meant by a conceptual framework • explain what is meant by understandability in relation to the provision of financial information • • • • define the qualitative characteristics of relevance and reliability • • • • • • define recognition in financial statements • indicate when income and expense recognition should occur under the financial position approach. discuss whether a conceptual framework is necessary discuss what an alternative system to a conceptual framework might be describe the qualities that enhance these two characteristics define the characteristic of comparability discuss the importance of comparability to users of financial statements explain the recognition criteria in financial statements apply the recognition criteria to assets apply the recognition criteria to liabilities apply the recognition criteria to income and expenses discuss what is meant by the financial position approach to recognition 25 A conceptual framework 1 The meaning of a conceptual framework Introduction There are two main approaches to accounting: • A principles­based or conceptual framework approach such as that used by the IASB. • A rules­based approach such as that used in the US. What is a conceptual framework? A conceptual framework is: • • a coherent system of interrelated objectives and fundamental principles a framework which prescribes the nature, function and limits of financial accounting and financial statements. Expandable text ­ Reasons for conceptual framework 26 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 2 Purpose of the Framework The conceptual framework published by the IASB is called the Framework. It includes guidance with regard to • • • the qualitative characteristics of financial information the elements of financial statements recognition of the elements of financial statements. The purpose of the Framework is to: • help the IASB in their role of developing future accounting standards and in reviewing existing IFRSs • help the IASB by providing a basis for reducing the number of alternative accounting treatments permitted by IFRSs • • help national standard­setting bodies in developing national standards • help auditors when they are forming an opinion as to whether financial statements conform with IFRSs • help users of financial statements when they are trying to interpret the information in financial statements which have been prepared in accordance with IFRSs • provide information to other parties that are interested in the work of the IASB. help those preparing financial statements to apply IFRSs and also to deal with areas where there is no relevant standard 2 Qualitative characteristics of financial information Introduction Qualitative characteristics are the attributes that make information provided in financial statements useful to others. The Framework identifies four qualitative characteristics: • • • • relevance reliability comparability understandability. All are subject to a threshold quality of materiality. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 27 A conceptual framework Materiality A threshold quality is: • one that needs to be studied before considering the other qualities of that information • a cut­off point – if any information does not pass the test of the threshold quality, it is not material and does not need to be considered further. Information is material if its omission or misstatement could influence the economic decisions of users taken on the basis of the financial statements. This depends on the size of the item or error judged in the particular circumstances of its omission or misstatement. Understandability Understandability depends on: • • the way in which information is presented the capabilities of users. It is assumed that users: • • have a reasonable knowledge of business and economic activities are willing to study the information provided with reasonable diligence. For information to be understandable users need to be able to perceive its significance. Information that is relevant and reliable should not be excluded from the financial statements simply because it is difficult for some users to understand. Relevance Information is relevant if: • • 28 it has the ability to influence the economic decisions of users, and is provided in time to influence those decisions. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 2 Qualities of relevance Information provided by financial statements needs to be relevant. Information that is relevant has predictive, or confirmatory, value. • Predictive value enables users to evaluate or assess past, present or future events. • Confirmatory value helps users to confirm or correct past evaluations and assessments. Where choices have to be made between mutually­exclusive options, the option selected should be the one that results in the relevance of the information being maximised – in other words, the one that would be of most use in taking economic decisions. Expandable text­ Relevance Illustration 1 ­ Relevance A business is a going concern with no intentions to reduce or curtail its operations. Which would be the most relevant valuation for its machinery – the net realisable value of the machinery or its depreciated cost? Expandable Text ­ Solution Reliability Reliable information can be depended upon to present a faithful representation and is neutral, error free, complete and prudent. Qualities of reliability Information is reliable when: • it can be depended upon by users to represent faithfully what it either purports to represent or could reasonably be expected to represent • • • it is free from material error it is free from deliberate or systematic bias (i.e. it is neutral). It is complete within the bounds of materiality KAPLAN PUBLISHING 29 A conceptual framework • in conditions of uncertainty, a degree of caution (i.e. prudence) has been applied in exercising judgement and making the necessary estimates. Expandable text ­ Qualities of reliability Test your understanding 1 A business is facing legal proceedings which may result in a potential liability. At the time of producing the financial statements no realistic estimate can be made of the possible amount of any damages. How would the characteristics of relevance and reliability be applied to this situation? Comparability Users must be able to: • compare the financial statements of an entity over time to identify trends in its financial position and performance • compare the financial statements of different entities to evaluate their relative financial performance and financial position. For this to be the case there must be: • • consistency and disclosure. Expandable text ­ Comparability 3 Elements of the financial statements Assets Assets are: • • • 30 resources controlled by the entity as a result of past events from which future economic benefits are expected to flow to the entity. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 2 Liabilities Liabilities are: • • • an entity’s obligations to transfer economic benefits as a result of past transactions or events. Equity interest Equity interest is the residual amount found by deducting all liabilities of the entity from all of the entity’s assets. Expandable text ­ Assets, liabilities and equity interest Income Income is: • an increase in economic benefits during the accounting period in the form of inflows or enhancements of assets or decreases in liabilities • transactions that result in increases in equity, other than those relating to contributions from equity participants. Expenses Expenses are: • decreases in economic benefits during the accounting period in the form of outflows or depletions of assets or incurrences of liabilities • transactions that result in decreases in equity, other than those relating to distributions to equity participants. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 31 A conceptual framework 4 Recognition of assets, liabilities, income and expenses Recognition Recognition is: • • • the depiction of an element in words and by monetary amount in the financial statements. Recognition of assets An asset will only be recognised if: • it gives rights or other access to future economic benefits controlled by an entity as a result of past transactions or events • • it can be measured with sufficient reliability there is sufficient evidence of its existence. Recognition of liabilities A liability will only be recognised if: • there is an obligation to transfer economic benefits as a result of past transactions or events • • it can be measured with sufficient reliability there is sufficient evidence of its existence. Illustration 2 – Assets, liabilities, income and expenses Below are listed four situations. (1) M has paid $3 million towards the cost of a new hospital in the nearby town, on condition that the hospital agrees to give priority treatment to its employees if they are injured at work. (2) N is the freehold legal owner of a waste disposal tip. It has charged customers for the right to dispose of their waste for many years. The tip is now full, and heavily polluted with chemicals. If cleaned up, which would cost $8 million, the site of the tip could be sold for housing purposes for $6 million. 32 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 2 (3) P has signed a contract to pay its finance director $300,000 pa for the next five years. He has agreed to work full time for the firm over that period. (4) Q has paid $25,000 to buy a patent right, giving the right to sole use, for 8 years, of a manufacturing method which saves costs. For each situation, state whether an asset or a liability is created. Expandable text ­ Solution Recognition of income Income is recognised in the income statement when: • an increase in future economic benefits arises from an increase in an asset (or a reduction in a liability), and • the increase can be measured reliably. Recognition of expenses Expenses are recognised in the income statement when: • a decrease in future economic benefits arises from a decrease in an asset or an increase in a liability, and • can be measured reliably. Financial position approach to recognition It can be seen therefore that: • • income is an increase in an asset/decrease in a liability expenses are an increase in a liability/decrease in an asset. As income and expenses are therefore recognised on the basis of changes in assets and liabilities this is known as a financial position (or balance sheet) approach to recognition. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 33 A conceptual framework Chapter summary 34 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 2 Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 It is likely that the existence of the court case will be highly relevant to users of the financial statements, however at the current time there is no reliable estimate of the amount of any possible damages. As the case is relevant, the facts of it should be disclosed, even if the amounts are not quantified due to lack of reliability. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 35 A conceptual framework 36 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 3 Accounting concepts and policies Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • distinguish between an accounting policy and an accounting estimate • distinguish between a change in accounting policy and a change in accounting estimate • describe how IAS 8 applies the principle of comparability where an entity changes its accounting policies • • • • account for a change in accounting policy • • • • • • • • • define historical cost • discuss whether the use of current value accounting overcomes the problems of historical cost accounting recognise a prior period error account for a prior period adjustment describe the underlying assumptions of financial statements – the accruals concept and going concern compute an asset value using historical cost define fair value/current value compute fair value/current value define net realisable value (NRV) compute the NRV of an asset define present value (PV) of future cash flows compute the PV of future cash flows describe the advantages and disadvantages of historical cost accounting 37 Accounting concepts and policies 38 • describe the concepts of financial and physical capital maintenance • explain how the use of financial or physical capital maintenance affects the determination of profits • describe what is meant by financial statements achieving a faithful representation • discuss whether faithful representation constitutes more than compliance with accounting standards • • list the circumstances where a true and fair override may apply explain the disclosures required where a true and fair override applies. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 3 1 IAS 8 Accounting policies, changes in accounting estimates and errors Introduction IAS 8 governs the following topics: • • • • selection of accounting policies changes in accounting policies changes in accounting estimates correction of prior period errors. Accounting policies Accounting policies are the principles, bases, conventions, rules and practices applied by an entity which specify how the effects of transactions and other events are reflected in the financial statements. IAS 8 requires an entity to select and apply appropriate accounting policies complying with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRSs) and Interpretations to ensure that the financial statements provide information that is: • • relevant to the decision­making needs of users reliable in that they: – represent faithfully the results and financial position of the entity – reflect the economic substance of events and transactions and not merely the legal form – are neutral, i.e. free from bias – are prudent – are complete in all material respects. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 39 Accounting concepts and policies Changing accounting policies The general rule is that accounting policies are normally kept the same from period to period to ensure comparability of financial statements over time. IAS 8 requires accounting policies to be changed only if the change: • • is required by IFRSs or will result in a reliable and more relevant presentation of events or transactions. A change in accounting policy occurs if there has been a change in: • • recognition, e.g. an expense is now recognised rather than an asset • measurement basis, e.g. stating assets at replacement cost rather than historical cost. presentation, e.g. depreciation is now included in cost of sales rather than administrative expenses, or Accounting for a change in accounting policy The required accounting treatment is that: • the change should be applied retrospectively, with an adjustment to the opening balance of retained earnings in the statement of changes in equity • comparative information should be restated unless it is impracticable to do so • if the adjustment to opening retained earnings cannot be reasonably determined, the change should be adjusted prospectively, i.e. included in the current period’s income statement. Disclosure When a change in accounting policy has a material effect on the current period or any prior period presented, or may have a material effect in subsequent periods, the following disclosures should be made: 40 • • the reasons for the change • the amount of the adjustment relating to periods prior to those included in the financial statements. the amounts of the adjustments recognised in the current period and the previous period presented (i.e. the comparative figures) KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 3 Accounting estimates An accounting estimate is a method adopted by an entity to arrive at estimated amounts for the financial statements. Most figures in the financial statements require some estimation: • the exercise of judgement based on the latest information available at the time • at a later date, estimates may have to be revised as a result of the availability of new information, more experience or subsequent developments. Ilustration 1 ­ Accounting estimates If a non­current asset has a depreciable amount of $5,000 to be written off over five years, different depreciation methods such as straight line, reducing balance, sum of the digits, etc. all represent different estimation techniques. The choice of method of depreciation would be the estimation technique whereas the policy of writing off the cost of non­current assets over their useful lives would be the accounting policy. Estimation techniques therefore implement the measurement aspects of accounting policies. Changes in accounting estimates The requirements of IAS 8 are: • The effects of a change in accounting estimate should be included in the income statement in the period of the change and, if subsequent periods are affected, in those subsequent periods. • The effects of the change should be included in the same income or expense classification as was used for the original estimate. • If the effect of the change is material, its nature and amount must be disclosed. Examples of changes in accounting estimates are changes in: • • • the useful lives of non­current assets the residual values of non­current assets the method of depreciating non­current assets KAPLAN PUBLISHING 41 Accounting concepts and policies • warranty provisions, based upon more up­to­date information about claims frequency. Test your understanding 1 Which of the following is a change in accounting policy as opposed to a change in estimation technique? (1) An entity has previously charged interest incurred in connection with the construction of tangible non­current assets to the income statement. Following the revision of IAS 23, and in accordance with the revised requirements of that standard, it now capitalises this interest. (2) An entity has previously depreciated vehicles using the reducing balance method at 40% pa. It now uses the straight­line method over a period of five years. (3) An entity has previously shown certain overheads within cost of sales. It now shows those overheads within administrative expenses. (4) An entity has previously measured inventory at weighted average cost. It now measures inventory using the first in first out (FIFO) method. Prior period errors Prior period errors are omissions from, and misstatements in, the financial statements for one or more prior periods arising from a failure to use information that: • was available when the financial statements for those periods were authorised for issue and • could reasonably be expected to have been taken into account in preparing those financial statements. Such errors include mathematical mistakes, mistakes in applying accounting policies, oversights and fraud. Current period errors that are discovered in that period should be corrected before the financial statements are authorised for issue. 42 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 3 Correction of prior period errors Prior period errors are dealt with by: • restating the opening balance of assets, liabilities and equity as if the error had never occurred, and presenting the necessary adjustment to the opening balance of retained earnings in the statement of changes in equity • restating the comparative figures presented, as if the error had never occurred • disclosing within the accounts a statement of financial position at the beginning of the earliest comparative period. In effect this means that three statements of financial position will be presented within a set of financial statements: – at the end of the current year – at the end of the previous year – at the beginning of the previous year. Illustration 2 – Prior period errors During 20X1 a company discovered that certain items had been included in inventory at 31 December 20X0 at a value of $2.5 million but they had in fact been sold before the year end. The original figures reported for the year ending 31 December 20X0 and the figures the current year 20X1 are given below: Sales Cost of sales Gross profit Tax Net profit 20X1 $000 52,100 (33,500) _______ 18,600 (4,600) _______ 14,000 20X0 $000 48,300 (30,200) _______ 18,100 (4,300) _______ 13,800 The cost of goods sold in 20X1 includes the $2.5 million error in opening inventory. The retained earnings at 1 January 20X0 were $11.2 million. (Assume that the adjustment will have no effect on the tax charge.) Show the 20X1 income statement with comparative figures and the retained earnings for each year. Disclosure of other comprehensive income is not required. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 43 Accounting concepts and policies Expandable text ­ Solution Expandable text ­ Disclosure Illustration 3 ­ Prior period errors During 20X2 a company discovered that certain items of research expenditure had been incorrectly capitalised as development expenditure at 31 December 20X1. The amount of expenditure capitalised was $4 million. This research expenditure should have been included in cost of sales. The original figures reported for year ending 31 December 20X1 and the figures the current year 20X2 are given below: Sales Cost of sales Gross profit Tax Net profit 20X2 $000 60,000 (40,000) ______ 20,000 (5,000) ______ 15,000 ______ 20X1 $000 50,000 (32,000) ______ 18,000 (4,000) ______ 14,000 ______ The opening retained earnings at 1 January 20X1 were $50 million. The adjustment has no effect on the tax for the year. Show the 20X2 income statement with comparative figures and the retained profits for each year. 44 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 3 Solution Income statement for the year ended 31 December 20X2 Sales Cost of sales (32,000 + 4,000) Gross profit Tax Net profit Retained profits Retained profits b/f As previously reported (50,000 + 14,000) Prior period adjustment As restated Profit for the year Retained profits c/f 20X2 $000 60,000 (40,000) –––––– 20,000 (5,000) –––––– 15,000 –––––– 20X1 $000 50,000 (36,000) –––––– 14,000 (4,000) –––––– 10,000 –––––– 64,000 50,000 (4,000) –––––– 60,000 15,000 –––––– 75,000 –––––– ­ –––––– 50,000 10,000 –––––– 60,000 –––––– Underlying assumptions The Framework identifies the underlying assumptions governing financial statements – the accruals basis of accounting and going concern. • The accruals basis of accounting means that the effects of transactions and other events are recognised as they occur and not as cash or its equivalent is received or paid. • The going concern basis assumes that the entity has neither the need nor the intention to liquidate or curtail materially the scale of its operations. These must be taken into account by an entity when deciding on accounting policies and estimates. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 45 Accounting concepts and policies 2 Measurement in financial statements Expandable text ­ Historical cost Expandable text ­ Fair value Illustration 4 ­ Fair value • If the item is quoted on an active market, then its fair value is its market value on that market. For example, the shares in large public companies are quoted on stock exchanges. The fair value of 1,000 shares in Company AB quoted at $2 each would be $2,000. • If the item is not quoted on an active market, but similar items are, then the item’s fair value should be determined by reference to these similar items. For example, a company might own 1,000 shares in an unquoted company CD. If CD is identical in every way to the quoted company AB which has a share price of $2 each, then perhaps the fair value of the shares held in CD is $2,000. • If the item is not quoted on an active market, and no similar items can be identified that are quoted, then the fair value must be estimated using a valuation model. For example, a shareholding in an unquoted company may be valued using a variety of techniques such as a dividend model. Expandable text ­ Further illustration: fair value Expandable text ­ Other asset values Illustration 5 ­ Other asset values A company owns a machine which it purchased four years ago for $100,000. The accumulated depreciation on the machine to date is $40,000. The machine could be sold to another manufacturer for $50,000 but there would be dismantling costs of $5,000. To replace the machine with a new version would cost $110,000. The cash flows from the existing machine are estimated to be $25,000 for the next two years followed by $20,000 per year for the remaining four years of the machine's life. 46 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 3 The relevant discount rate for this company is 10% and the discount factors are: Year 1 Year 2 Years 3­6 inclusive 0.909 0.826 2.619 (annuity rate) Calculate the following values for the machine: (a) Historical cost (b) NRV (c) Replacement cost (d) Economic value Solution a. Historical cost Cost Less: depreciation $ 100,000 (40,000) ______ 60,000 ______ b. NRV Selling price Less: costs to sell $ 50,000 (5,000) ______ 45,000 ______ c. Replacement cost Replacement cost for new asset Less: 4 years’ depreciation (4 × 10% × $110,000) $ 110,000 (44,000) ______ 66,000 KAPLAN PUBLISHING 47 Accounting concepts and policies d. Economic value $ 22,725 20,650 52,380 ______ 95,755 ______ $25,000 × 0.909 $25,000 × 0.826 $20,000 × 2.619 Expandable Text­ Historical cost accounting Illustration 6 ­ Deficiencies of historical cost accounts Company A acquires a new machine in 20X4. This machine costs $50,000 and has an estimated useful life of ten years. Company B acquires an identical one­year old machine in 20X5. The cost of the machine is $48,000 and it has an estimated useful life of nine years. Depreciation charges (straight­line basis) in 20X5 are as follows. Company A Company B CVs at the end of 20X5 are: Company A Company B $50,000/10 $48,000/9 = $5,000 = $5,333 $50,000 – (2 × $5,000) = $40,000 $48,000 – $5,333 = $42,667 Both companies are using identical machines during 20X5, but the income statements will show quite different profit figures because of adherence to historical cost. Is the comparison of financial statements for the two companies in 20X5 meaningful? Expandable text ­ Alternatives to historical cost accounting Expandable text ­ Constant purchasing power accounting Expandable text ­ Advantages and disadvantages of CPP 48 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 3 Expandable text ­ Current cost accounting Expandable text ­ Advantages and disadvantages of CCA Illustration 7 ­ Current cost accounting Describe the types of business that would be most heavily affected by the replacement of historical cost accounting with a system based on current values. Expandable text ­ Solution Expandable text ­ Capital maintenance Expandable text ­ Fair presentation KAPLAN PUBLISHING 49 Accounting concepts and policies Chapter summary 50 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 3 Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 For each of the items, ask whether this involves a change to: • • • recognition presentation measurement basis. If the answer to any of these is yes, the change is a change in accounting policy. (1) This is a change in recognition and presentation. Therefore this is a change in accounting policy. (2) The answer to all three questions is no. This is only a change in estimation technique. (3) This is a change in presentation and therefore a change in accounting policy. (4) This is a change in measurement basis and therefore a change in accounting policy. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 51 Accounting concepts and policies 52 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 4 Principles of consolidated financial statements Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • • • • • • describe the concept of a group as a single economic unit • explain the need for using coterminous year ends and uniform accounting policies when preparing consolidated financial statements • • explain why it is necessary to eliminate intra­group transactions explain the objective of consolidated financial statements explain the definition of a subsidiary according to IAS 27 apply the IAS 27 definition of a subsidiary explain why directors may not wish to consolidate a subsidiary list the circumstances where it is permitted not to consolidate a subsidiary identify the effect that the related party relationship between a parent and subsidiary may have on the subsidiary’s entity statements and the consolidated financial statements. 53 Principles of consolidated financial statements 1 The concept of group accounts What is a group? If one company owns more than 50% of the ordinary shares of another company: • • this will usually give the first company ‘control’ of the second company • P is, in effect, able to manage S as if it were merely a department of P, rather than a separate entity • in strict legal terms P and S remain distinct, but in economic substance they can be regarded as a single unit (a ‘group’). the first company (the parent company, P) has enough voting power to appoint all the directors of the second company (the subsidiary company, S) Expandable text Group accounts The key principle underlying group accounts is the need to reflect the economic substance of the relationship. 54 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 4 • • P is an individual legal entity. S is an individual legal entity. P controls S and therefore they form a single economic entity – the Group. The objective of the consolidated financial statements is to show the position of the group as if it were a single economic entity, therefore: • all of the assets and liabilities of P and S are included in the consolidated statement of financial position • all of the income and expenses of P and S are included in the consolidated income statement • all of the other comprehensive income of P and S is included in the consolidated statement showing other comprehensive income. Expandable text Expandable text ­ The single economic unit concept Expandable text 2 Definitions IAS 27 Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements uses the following definitions: • subsidiary – an entity that is controlled by another entity (known as the parent) • control – the power to govern the financial and operating policies of an entity so as to obtain benefits from its activities. Control is usually based on ownership of more than 50% of voting power, but other forms of control are possible. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 55 Principles of consolidated financial statements Expandable text ­ Other forms of control Test your understanding 1 Hercules is considering an investment in Samson, the capital structure of which is as follows: 10,000 A voting ordinary shares 10,000 B non­voting ordinary shares. Both classes of shares have the same dividend rights. Describe the appropriate group accounting for Samson if: (i) Hercules purchases 6,000 A ordinary shares. (ii) Hercules purchases 10,000 B and 4,000 A ordinary shares. Expandable text ­ Excluded subsidiaries Expandable text ­ Excluded subsidiaries: further detail Illustration 1 ­ Excluded subsidiaries Hobart Group owns 90% of the voting ordinary shares of Storey. Consider the following statements: (i) Storey is a foreign subsidiary. (ii) Storey operates a very different business to Hobart. (iii) Storey was acquired with another subsidiary and has always been intended to be sold. Discuss how each of the above statements could affect how Hobart accounts for Storey in the group. Expandable text ­ Solution Expandable Text ­ reasons for wanting to exclude a subsidiary 56 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 4 Expandable text Expandable text ­ Principles of consolidation Illustration 2 ­ Intragroup transactions If intra­group transactions were not eliminated before consolidation, a group could buy an item of inventory, sell it to another member of the group (at a profit), who in turn could sell it to another member of the group and so on. • The result would be that each member of the group would make a profit which would then be combined to form a large group profit. • This would be ‘balanced’ by an over­inflated inventory value in the statement of financial position. Such accounting would not show a fair presentation. Expandable text ­ Related parties KAPLAN PUBLISHING 57 Principles of consolidated financial statements Chapter summary 58 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 4 Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 (i) Hercules has purchased 6,000 of the 10,000 voting A shares but no non­voting B shares. It is the voting shares that give Hercules the influence in Samson. With 60% of the voting shares Hercules should control Samson. Samson should therefore be treated as a subsidiary. (ii) Hercules has purchased 4,000 of the 10,000 voting A shares and 10,000 non­voting B shares. As Hercules has less than 50% of the voting share this time it probably will not be able to control Samson. Samson will not be a subsidiary. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 59 Principles of consolidated financial statements 60 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 5 Consolidated statement of financial position Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • prepare a consolidated statement of financial position for a simple group (parent and one subsidiary) • • • deal with pre­ and post­acquisition profits • • • apply the required accounting treatment of consolidated goodwill • • account for the consolidation of other reserves • explain why it is necessary to use fair values when preparing consolidated financial statements • account for the effects of fair value adjustments (including the effect of consolidated goodwill) to: deal with non­controlling interests describe the required accounting treatment of consolidated goodwill account for impairment of goodwill explain the consolidation of other reserves (e.g. share premium and revaluation) account for the effects of intra­group trading in the statement of financial position (i) depreciating and non­depreciating non­current assets (ii) inventory (iii) monetary liabilities (iv) assets and liabilities not included in the subsidiary’s own statement of financial position including contingent assets and liabilities. 61 Consolidated statement of financial position 1 Principles of the consolidated statement of financial position Basic principle The basic principle of a consolidated statement of financial position is that it shows all assets and liabilities of the parent and subsidiary. Intra­group items are excluded, e.g. receivables and payables shown in the consolidated statement of financial position only include amounts owed from/to third parties. Method of preparing a consolidated statement of financial position (1) The investment in the subsidiary (S) shown in the parent’s (P’s) statement of financial position is replaced by the net assets of S. (2) The cost of the investment in S is effectively cancelled with the ordinary share capital and reserves of the subsidiary This leaves a consolidated statement of financial position showing: 62 • • the net assets of the whole group (P + S) • the retained profits, comprising profits made by the group (i.e. all of P’s historical profits + profits made by S post­acquisition). the share capital of the group which always equals the share capital of P only and KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 5 Illustration 1 – Principles of the consolidated SFP Statements of financial position at 31 December 20X4 Non­current assets Investment in S at cost Current assets Ordinary share capital ($1 shares) Retained earnings Current liabilities P S $000 60 50 40 ___ 150 ___ 100 30 20 ___ 150 ___ $000 50 40 ___ 90 ___ 40 10 40 ___ 90 ___ P acquired all the shares in S on 31 December 20X4 for a cost of $50,000. Prepare the consolidated statement of financial position at 31 December 20X4. Expandable text ­ Solution Goodwill on acquisition In the previous illustration, the cost of the shares in S was $50,000. Equally the net assets of S were $50,000. This is not always the case. The value of a company will normally exceed the value of its net assets. The difference is goodwill. This goodwill represents assets not shown in the statement of financial position of the acquired company such as the reputation of the business. Goodwill on acquisition is calculated by comparing the value of the subsidiary acquired to its net assets. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 63 Consolidated statement of financial position Where 100% of the subsidiary is acquired, the calculation is therefore: Cost of investment (= value of the subsidiary) Net assets of subsidiary Goodwill $ X (X) ___ X Where less than 100% of the subsidiary is acquired, the value of the subsidiary comprises two elements: • • The value of the part acquired by the parent The value of the part not acquired by the parent, known as the non­ controlling interest There are 2 methods in which Goodwill may now be calculated following the update to IFRS3. (i) Partial Goodwill (ii) Full goodwill Partial Goodwill (old method) Cost of Investment For: Parents share of sub's NA @Acq Goodwill on consolidation (parent's share) $000 X (X) — X — 64 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 5 Full Goodwill (new method) $000 Cost of Investment $000 X For: Parents share of sub's NA @ Acq (X) — Goodwill ­ parents share F.V of NCI at acquisition X X Less: NCI share of NA @ Acq (X) — Goodwill ­ NCI share X — Total Goodwill X ══ This method is referred to as the full goodwill method, as it results in 100% of the goodwill being shown in the group statement of financial position – that belonging to the shareholders of the parent and that belonging to the non­ controlling interest. An alternative presentation of the full goodwill method as allowed by the standard is shown below: $ Cost of investment(value of acquired part) X Non­ controlling invest (value of part not acquired) X — X Net assets of subsidiary (X) — Goodwill X — Positive goodwill is presented as a non­current asset on the face of the consolidated statement of financial position and is subject to impairment reviews to assess whether its value has fallen. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 65 Consolidated statement of financial position Test your understanding 1 Daniel acquired 80% of the ordinary share capital of Craig on 31 December 20X6 for $78,000. At this date the net assets of Craig were $85,000. What goodwill arises on the acquisition (i) if the NCI is valued using the proportion of net assets method (ii) if the NCI is valued using the full goodwill method and the fair value of the NCI on the acquisition date is $21,000? The mechanics of consolidation A standard group accounting question will provide the accounts of P and the accounts of S and will require the preparation of consolidated accounts. The best approach is to use a set of standard workings. (W1) Establish the group structure (W2) Net assets of subsidiary Share capital Reserves: Retained earnings 66 At date of acquisition $ X At the reporting date $ X X –– X –– X –– X –– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 5 (W3) Goodwill ­ Proportion of net Assets method (old) method) Purchase consideration X for: Parents % of sub's Net assets @ Acquisition (X) — Goodwill on acquisition X Less: Impairments to date (X) — Carrying Goodwill ═ or: ­ Fair value method (new method) Purchase consideration X for: Parents % of sub's NA @ Acq (X) — Goodwill on acquisition­ parents share FV of NCI @ Acq X X Less: NCI % of subs NA @ Acq (X) — Goodwill ­ NCI share. X — X (W4) Non­ controlling interest (NCI) (Old method) M1 % of subsidiarys net assets at at reporting date(W2) (W4) Non­ controlling interest (NCI) (New method) X M1 % of subsidiarys net assets at reporting date(W2) X NCI share of goodwill (W3) X — X — KAPLAN PUBLISHING 67 Consolidated statement of financial position (W5) Group retained earnings $ P's retained earnings (100%) X S:group share of post­acquisition retained earnings Less: Goodwill impairments to date(W3) X (X) — X — Illustration 2– Principles of the consolidated SFP Consolidated statement of financial position Austin buys all of the share capital of Reed on 31 December 20X7. The SFPs of the two companies at 31 December 20X7, are as follows: Austin Non­current assets: Tangible Investments Shares in Reed Current assets Capital and reserves: Share capital Retained earnings Current liabilities: 68 Reed $ $ 80,000 8,000 17,000 ______ 97,000 198,000 ______ 295,000 ______ 24,000 ______ 32,000 ______ 100,000 30,000 –––––– 130,000 –––––– 165,000 –––––– 295,000 –––––– 10,000 5,000 –––––– 15,000 –––––– 17,000 –––––– 32,000 –––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 5 There has been no impairment in the value of goodwill. Prepare the consolidated statement of financial position of Austin as at 31 December 20X7. Expandable text ­ Solution 2 Pre­acquisition profits and group reserves Pre­ and post­acquisition profits Pre­acquisition profits are the reserves which exist in a subsidiary company at the date when it is acquired. They are capitalised at the date of acquisition by including them in the goodwill calculation. Post­acquisition profits are profits made and included in the retained earnings of the subsidiary company since acquisition. They are included in group reserves. Group reserves When looking at the reserves of S at the year end, e.g revaluation reserve, a distinction must be made between: • those reserves of S which existed at the date of acquisition by P (pre­ acquisition reserves) and • the increase in the reserves of S which arose after acquisition by P (post­acquisition reserves). As with retained earnings, only the group share of post­acquisition reserves of S is included in the group statement of financial position. Expandable text ­ Illustration: pre and post­acquisition profits 3 Non­controlling interests What is a non­controlling interest? In some situations a parent may not own all of the shares in the subsidiary, e.g. if P owns only 80% of the ordinary shares of S, there is a non­controlling interest of 20%. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 69 Consolidated statement of financial position Note, however, that P still controls S. Accounting treatment of a non­controlling interest As P controls S: • in the consolidated statement of financial position, include all of the net assets of S • ‘give back’ the net assets of S which belong to the non­controlling interest within the capital and reserves section of the consolidated statement of financial position (calculated in W4).Where the full goodwill method is used to value the NCI, a proportion of goodwill on acquisition is also 'given back' to the NCI. Expandable text Illustration 3 – Non­controlling interests Draft SFPs of Piper and Swans on 31 December 20X1 are as follows. Piper Swans $000 $000 Non­current assets 90 100 Investment in Swans at cost 110 Current assets 50 30 –––– –––– 250 130 –––– –––– Equity and liabilities Capital and reserves Ordinary share capital $1 100 100 Retained earnings 120 20 ––– ––– 220 120 ––– ––– Current liabilities 30 10 ––– ––– 250 130 ––– ––– Piper had bought 80% of the ordinary shares of Swans on 1 January 20X1 when the retained profits of Swans were $10,000. No impairment of goodwill has occurred to date. 70 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 5 Prepare a consolidated statement of financial position as at 31 December 20X1, assuming that the Piper group values the non­ controlling interest using the proportion of net assets method. Expandable text ­ Solution Test your understanding 2 The following SFPs have been prepared at 31 December 20X8. Dickens Non­current assets: Tangible assets Investments Shares in Jones Current assets Capital and reserves: Called­up share capital Share premium Retained earnings Current liabilities Jones $ $ 85,000 18,000 60,000 –––––– 145,000 160,000 –––––– 305,000 –––––– 84,000 –––––– 102,000 –––––– 65,000 35,000 70,000 –––––– 170,000 135,000 –––––– 305,000 –––––– 20,000 10,000 25,000 –––––– 55,000 47,000 –––––– 102,000 –––––– Dickens acquired its 80% holding in Jones on 1 January 20X8, when Jones’ retained earnings stood at $20,000.On this date, the fair value of the 20% non­controlling shareholding in Jones was $12,500. There has been no impairment of goodwill since acquisition. The Dickens Group uses the full goodwill method to value the non­ controlling interest. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 71 Consolidated statement of financial position Prepare the consolidated statement of financial position of Dickens as at 31 December 20X8. 4 Intra­group trading Types of intra­group trading P and S may well trade with each other leading to the following potential problem areas: • • • • • current accounts between P and S unrealised profits on sales of inventory (see below) unrealised profits on sales of non­current assets (see below) loan stock held by one company in the other dividends and loan interest. Current accounts If P and S trade with each other then this will probably be done on credit leading to: • • a receivables (current) account in one company’s SFP a payables (current) account in the other company’s SFP. These are amounts owing within the group rather than outside the group and therefore they must not appear in the consolidated statement of financial position. They are therefore cancelled (contra’d) against each other on consolidation. Cash/goods in transit At the year end, current accounts may not agree, owing to the existence of in­transit items such as goods or cash. The usual rules are as follows: – If the goods or cash are in transit between P and S, make the adjusting entry to the statement of financial position of the recipient: – cash in transit adjusting entry is: – Dr Cash in transit – 72 Cr Receivables current account KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 5 – goods in transit adjusting entry is: – Dr Inventory – Cr Payables current account this adjustment is for the purpose of consolidation only. • Once in agreement, the current accounts may be contra’d and cancelled as part of the process of cross casting the assets and liabilities. • This means that reconciled current account balance amounts are removed from both receivables and payables in the consolidated statement of financial position . Illustration 4 – Intra­group trading Current accounts and cash in transit Draft SFPs of Plant and Shrub on 31 March 20X7 are as follows. Tangible non­current assets Investment in S at cost Current assets Inventory Trade receivables Cash Equity and liabilities Capital and reserves: Share capital: Ordinary $1 shares Share premium Retained earnings Non­current liabilities: 10% loan notes Current liabilities KAPLAN PUBLISHING Plant $000 100 180 Shrub $000 140 30 20 10 ___ 340 35 10 5 ___ 190 250 – – ___ 250 100 30 20 ___ 150 65 25 ___ 340 – 40 ___ 190 73 Consolidated statement of financial position Notes: • Plant bought 80,000 shares in Shrub in 20X1 when Shrub’s reserves included a share premium of $30,000 and retained profits of $5,000. • Plant's accounts show $6,000 owing to Shrub; Shrub's accounts show $8,000 owed by Plant. The difference is explained as cash in transit. • • No impairment of goodwill has occurred to date. Plant uses the proportion of net assets method to value the non­ controlling interest. Prepare a consolidated statement of financial position as at 31 March 20X7. Expandable text ­ Solution 5 Goodwill IFRS 3 Business combinations IFRS 3 revised governs accounting for all business combinations other than joint ventures and a number of other unusual arrangements not included in this syllabus. The definition of goodwill is: Goodwill is an asset representing the future economic benefits arising from other assets acquired in a business combination that are not individually identified and separately recognised. Goodwill is calculated as the excess of the consideration transferred and amount of any non­controlling interest over the net of the acquisition date identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed. Treatment of goodwill Positive goodwill • Capitalised as an intangible non­current asset. • • Tested annually for possible impairments. Amortisation of goodwill is not permitted by the standard. Expandable text 74 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 5 Negative goodwill • Arises where the cost of the investment is less that the value of net assets purchased. • IFRS 3 does not refer to this as negative goodwill, however this is the commonly used term. • Most likely reason for this to arise is a misstatement of the fair values of assets and liabilities and accordingly the standard requires that the calculation is reviewed. • After such a review, any negative goodwill remaining is credited directly to the income statement. Expandable text ­ Illustration: Goodwill 6 Fair values Fair value of consideration and net assets To ensure that an accurate figure is calculated for goodwill: • the consideration paid for a subsidiary must be accounted for at fair value • the subsidiary’s identifiable assets and liabilities acquired must be accounted for at their fair values. The fair value of assets and liabilities is defined in IFRS 3 (and several other IFRSs) as ‘the amount for which an asset could be exchanged or a liability settled between knowledgeable, willing parties in an arm’s length transaction’. Expandable text Calculation of cost of investment The cost of acquisition includes the following elements: • • cash paid fair value of any other consideration Incidental costs of acquisition such as legal, accounting, valuation and other professional fees should be expensed as incurred. The issue costs of debt or equity associated with the acquisition should be recognised in accordance with IAS 39 (see chapter 12). KAPLAN PUBLISHING 75 Consolidated statement of financial position Deferred and contingent consideration In some situations not all of the purchase consideration is paid at the date of the acquisition, instead a part of the payment is deferred until a later date – deferred consideration. • Deferred consideration should be measured at fair value at the date of the acquisition. • Any contingent consideration should always be included as long as it can be measured reliably.This will be indicated where relevant in an exam question. Where contingent consideration involves the issue of shares, there is no liability (obligation to transfer economic benefits). This should be recognised as part of shareholders' funds under a separate caption representing shares to be issued. Subsequent changes If the cost of acquisition changes subsequently as the result of a different outcome of a contingency, the change should generally be recognised in income statement. Goodwill is therefore not reinstated. Subsequent changes to contingent consideration classified as equity are, however, not remeasured. If the cost of acquisition changes within 12 months as the result of new information about fair values of consideration at the acquisition date then the change should be recorded and goodwill reinstated. Illustration 5 – Fair values Jack acquires 24 million $1 shares (80% ) of the ordinary shares of Becky by offering a share­for­share exchange of two shares for every three shares acquired in Becky and a cash payment of $1 per share payable three years later. The current market value of a Jack’s share is $2. There are two ways to discount the deferred amount to fair value at acquisition date: (1) The examiner gives you the present value of the payment based on a cost of capital (10%). In this example it is $0.75. 76 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 5 (2) Use the interest rate given and apply the discount fraction where r is the interest rate and n the number of years to settlement 1 –––––– (1 + r ) n (i) Calculate the cost of investment and show the journals to record it in Jack's accounts. (ii) Show how the discount would be unwound. Expandable text ­ Solution Fair value of net assets acquired IFRS 3 revised requires that the subsidiary’s assets and liabilities are recorded at their fair value for the purposes of the calculation of goodwill and production of consolidated accounts. Adjustments will therefore be required where the subsidiary’s accounts themselves do not reflect fair value. Expandable text ­ Illustration: Fair value of net assets acquired Expandable text How to include fair values in consolidation workings (1) Adjust both columns of W2to bring the net assets to fair value at acquisition and reporting date. This will ensure that the fair value of net assets is carried through to the goodwill and non­controlling interest calculations. At acquisition At reporting date $000 $000 Ordinary share capital + Reserves X X Fair value adjustments X X X X ___ ___ (2) At the reporting date make the adjustment on the face of the SFP when adding across assets and liabilities. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 77 Consolidated statement of financial position Expandable text ­ Uniform accounting policies 7 Unrealised profit Profits made by members of a group on transactions with other group members are: • • recognised in the accounts of the individual companies concerned, but in terms of the group as a whole, such profits are unrealised and must be eliminated from the consolidated accounts. Unrealised profit may arise within a group scenario on: • • inventory where companies trade with each other non­current assets where one group company has transferred an asset to another. Intra­group trading and unrealised profit in inventory When one group company sells goods to another a number of adjustments may be needed. • • Current accounts must be cancelled (see earlier in this chapter). • Inventory must be included at original cost to the group (i.e. cost to the company which then sold it). Where goods are still held by a group company, any unrealised profit must be cancelled. Expandable text Adjustments for unrealised profit in inventory The process to adjust is: (1) Determine the value of closing inventory included in an individual company’s accounts which has been purchased from another company in the group. (2) Use mark­up or margin to calculate how much of that value represents profit earned by the selling company. (3) Make the adjustments. These will depend on who the seller is. 78 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 5 If the seller is the parent company, the profit element is included in the holding company’s accounts and relates entirely to the group. Adjustment required: Dr Group retained earnings (deduct the profit in W5) Cr Group inventory (deduct the profit when adding P’s inventory + S’s inventory on the face of the consolidated SFP. If the seller is the subsidiary, the profit element is included in the subsidiary company’s accounts and relates partly to the group, partly to non­controlling interests (if any). Adjustment required: Dr Subsidiary retained earnings (deduct the profit in W2) Cr Group inventory (deduct the profit when adding P’s inventory + S’s inventory on the face of the consolidated SFP). Expandable text Illustration 6 – Unrealised profit Health (H) bought 90% of the equity share capital of Safety (S), two years ago on 1 January 20X2 when the retained earnings of Safety stood at $5,000. Statements of financial position at the year end of 31 December 20X3 are as follows: H $000 Non­current assets: Property,plans+equipment Investment KAPLAN PUBLISHING S $000 100 34 –––– 134 $000 $000 30 79 Consolidated statement of financial position Current assets: Inventory Receivables Bank 90 110 10 –––– Share capital Retained earnings Non­current liabilities Current liabilities 20 25 5 –––– 210 –––– 344 15 159 174 50 –––– 80 5 31 36 120 50 –––– 344 –––– 28 16 –––– 80 –––– S transferred goods to H at a transfer price of $18,000 and a mark­up of 50%. Two­thirds remained in inventory at the year end. The current account in parent and subsidiary stood at $22,000 on that day. Goodwill has suffered an impairment of $10,000. Prepare the CSFP at 31/12/X3. Note: the non­controlling interest is valued using the proportion of net assets method. Expandable text Non­current assets If one group member sells non­current assets to another group member adjustments must be made to recreate the situation that would have existed if the sale had not occurred: • • There would have been no profit on the sale. Depreciation would have been based on the original cost of the asset to the group. Expandable text 80 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 5 Adjustments for unrealised profit in non­current assets The easiest way to calculate the adjustment required is to compare the carrying value (CV) of the asset now with the CV that it would have been held at had the transfer never occurred: CV at reporting date CV at reporting date if intra­group transfer had not occurred Adjustment required X (X) ––– X The calculated amount should be: (1) deducted when adding across P’s non­current assets + S’s non­current assets (2) deducted in the retained earnings of the seller (W2 if the seller is the subsidiary; W5 if it is the parent company). Illustration 7 ­ Non­current asset PURP Unrealised profit in non­current assets Parent company (P) transfers an item of plant to subsidiary (S) for $6,000 at the start of the 20X1. The plant originally cost P $10,000 and has been depreciated at the group depreciation rate of 20% since acquisition 3 years ago. What is the unrealised profit on the transaction at the end of the year of transfer? Expandable text ­ Solution Test your understanding 3 H owns 80% of S. In separate years transfers are: (1) From H to S, $20,000, mark­up 25%, half in inventory. (2) From S to H, $150,000, mark­up 50%, 20% in inventory. (3) From H to S, $120,000, mark­up one third, third in inventory. (4) From S to H, $65,000, mark­up 30%, third in inventory. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 81 Consolidated statement of financial position (5) H sold goods to S at a price of $12 million. These goods cost H $9 million. During the year S sold $10 million (at the cost to S) of these goods for $15 million. (6) S sold a machine with a book value of $100,000 to H at a transfer price of $120,000 at the year start. Group policy dictates that the machine is depreciated over its remaining life of five years. (7) H sold an item of plant to S for $240,000. The transfer had a mark up of 20%. S charged $24,000 in depreciation. Calculate the provision for unrealised profit in each case. 8 Mid­year acquisitions Calculation of reserves at date of acquisition If a parent company acquires a subsidiary mid­year, the net assets at the date of acquisition must be calculated based on the net assets at the start of the subsidiary's financial year plus the profits of up to the date of acquisition. To calculate this it is normally assumed that S’s profit after tax accrues evenly over time. Expandable text ­ Illustration: Mid­year acquisitions Test your understanding 4 Hazelnut acquired 80% of the share capital of Peppermint two years ago, when the reserves of Peppermint stood at $125,000. Hazelnut paid initial cash consideration of $1 million. Additionally Hazelnut issued 200,000 shares with a nominal value of $1 and a current market value of $1.80. It was also agreed that Hazelnut would pay a further $500,000 in three years’ time. Current interest rates are 10% pa. The appropriate discount factor for $1 receivable three years from now is 0.751. The shares and contingent consideration have not yet been recorded. 82 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 5 Below are the statements of financial position of Hazelnut and Peppermint as at 31 December 20X4: Hazelnut Peppermint $000 $000 Investment in Peppermint at cost 1,000 Non­current assets 5,500 1,500 Current assets: Inventory 550 100 Receivables 400 200 Cash 200 50 ––––– ––––– 7,650 1,850 ––––– ––––– Share capital 2,000 500 Retained earnings 1,400 300 ––––– ––––– 3,400 800 Non­current liabilities 3,000 400 Current liabilities 1,250 650 ––––– ––––– 7,650 1,850 ––––– ––––– At acquisition the fair values of Peppermint’s non­current assets exceeded their book value by $200,000. They had a remaining useful life of five years at this date. The consolidated goodwill has been impaired by one fifth of its value. The Hazelnut Group values the non­controlling interest using the full goodwill method. At the date of acquisition the fair value of the 20% non­ controlling interest was $380,000 Prepare the consolidated statement of financial position as at 31 December 20X4. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 83 Consolidated statement of financial position Chapter summary 84 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 5 Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 (ii) Cost of investment for: 80% of NA @ acquisition (80% × $85,000(W2)) Goodwill ­ parents share f.V of NCI @ acquisition NCI in NA @ acquisition (20% × $85,000) Goodwill ­ NCI Total Goodwill $ 78,000 (68,000) ———— 10,000 21,000 (17,000) ——— 4,000 ——— 14,000 ——— Test your understanding 2 Dickens consolidated statement of financial position as at 31 December 20X8 Non­current assets: Goodwill (W3) Tangible $(85,000 + 18,000) Current assets $(160,000 + 84,000) Share capital Share premium Retained earnings (W5) Non­controlling interest (W4) Current liabilities $(135,000 + 47,000) KAPLAN PUBLISHING $000 22.5 103 244 ___ 369.5 ___ 65 35 74 13.5 ___ 187.5 182 ___ 369.5 ___ 85 Consolidated statement of financial position (W1) Group structure (W2) Net assets of Jones At date of acquisition Share capital Share premium Retained earnings Net assets At reporting date $ 20,000 10,000 20,000 ______ 50,000 ______ $ 20,000 10,000 25,000 ______ 55,000 ______ (W3) Goodwill $000 Cost of Investment Less: 80% of NA @ acquisition (80% × $50,000 (W2) ) Goodwill ­ parents share f.v of NCI at acquisition Less: 20% of NA @ acq (20% × $50,000(W2)) NCI shareof goodwill Total Goodwill 86 $000 60,000 (40,000) ——— 20,000 12,500 10,000 ——— 2,500 ——— 22,500 ═════ KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 5 (W4) NCI 20% of NA @ reporting date (20% × $55,000 (W2)) NCI share of goodwill (W3) 11,000 2,500 ——— 13,500 ——— Test your understanding 3 (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) $2,000 $10,000 $10,000 $5,000 $500,000 $16,000 $36,000 [(20) × (25/125) × (½)] [(150) × (50/150) × (20%)] [(120) × (33/133) × (1/3)] [(65) × (30/130) × (1/3)] [(12,000 – 9,000) × (2/12)] [(4/5) × (120 – 100)] [240 × (20/120) × (1 – 24/240)] Test your understanding 4 Hazelnut consolidated statement of financial position at 31 December 20X4 Goodwill (W3) Non­current assets (5.5m + 1.5m + 200,000 ­ 80,000) Current assets: Inventory $(550,000 + 100,000) Receivables $(400,000 + 200,000) Cash $(200,000 + 50,000) KAPLAN PUBLISHING $000 1,033 7,120 650 600 250 ––––– 9,653 ––––– 87 Consolidated statement of financial position Share capital $(2m + 200,000) Share premium $(0 + 160,000) Retained earnings (W5) 2,200 160 1,191 ––––– 3,551 347 ––––– 3,898 ––––– 3,400 1,900 455 ––––– 9,653 ––––– Non­controlling interest (W4) Non­current liabilities $(3m + 400,000) Current liabilities $(1.25m + 650,000) Deferred consideration $(376,000 + 79,000) Workings (W1) Group structure (W2) Net assets of Peppermint At date of acquisition Share capital Retained earnings Fair value adjustment Depreciation adjustment (200 × 2/5) 88 At reporting date $000 500 125 200 $000 500 300 200 (80) ___ 825 ___ ___ 920 ___ KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 5 Note: the cost of the investment in Hazelnut’s SFP is $1 million, i.e. the cash consideration paid. Hazelnut has: Dr Cr Investment Bank $1 million $1 million Hazelnut has not yet recorded the share consideration or the deferred consideration. The journals required to record these are: and Dr Cr Cr Dr Cr Investment Share capital Share premium Investment Deferred consideration $360,000 $200,000 $160,000 $376,000 $376,000 In the CSFP, since the cost of the investment does not appear there is no need to worry about the debit side of the entries. The credit entries do, however, need recording. (W3) Goodwill $000 $000 Cost of investment 1,000 • Cash • Shares (200 × $1.80) 360 • Deferred consideration (500 × 0.751 ) 376 _____ 1,736 For: 80% of NA @ Acquisition (80% × $825(W2)) Goodwill­ parents share F.V of NCI @ Acquisition KAPLAN PUBLISHING (660) ——— 1,076 380 89 Consolidated statement of financial position Less: 20% of NA @ Acquisition (20% x $ 825 (W2)) (165) —— Goodwill­ NCI share Total Goodwill @ Acquisition Impairment Carrying Goodwill 215 ——— 1,291 (258) ——— 1,033 ——— (W4) Non­ controlling interest 20% of NA @ reporting date (20% × $920 (W2)) NCI share of Goodwill (W3) NCI share of impairment 184 215 (52) —— 347 —— (W5) Group retained earnings Hazelnut (1,400 – 79) (W6) Peppermint (80% × (920 – 825)) Impairment of goodwill (W3) $000 1,321 76 (206) _____ 1,191 _____ (W6) Unwinding of discount Present value of deferred consideration at acquisition Present value of deferred consideration at reporting date 90 $000 376 455 ___ 79 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 5 At acquisition, Hazelnut should record a liability of 376, being the present value of the future cash flow at that date. The reporting date is two years’ liability and there is only one year to go until the deferred consideration will be paid. Therefore the liability in Hazelnut’s SFP at this date is 376 × 1.102. So, Hazelnut needs to: Dr Income statement Cr Deferred consideration liability KAPLAN PUBLISHING 79 79 91 Consolidated statement of financial position 92 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 6 Consolidated income statement Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • prepare a consolidated income statement for a simple group and a non­controlling interest • account for the effects of intra­group trading in the income statement • prepare a consolidated income statement for a simple group with an acquisition in the period and non­controlling interest • account for impairment of goodwill. 93 Consolidated income statement 1 Principles of the consolidated income statement Basic principle The consolidated income statement shows the profit generated by all resources disclosed in the related consolidated statement of financial position, i.e. the net assets of the parent company (P) and its subsidiaries (Ss). The consolidated income statement follows these basic principles: • From revenue to profit after tax include all of P’s income and expenses plus all of S’s income and expenses (reflectingcontrol of S). • After profit after tax deduct share of profits due to the non­controlling interest (to reflect ownership). Expandable text ­ Basic principle The mechanics of consolidation As with the statement of financial position, it is common to use standard workings when producing a consolidated income statement: • • • 94 consolidation schedule (see below) group structure diagram net assets of subsidiary at acquisition (required for goodwill calculation) KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 6 • goodwill calculation (required where an impairment is to be charged to profits (see below)) • non­controlling interest (NCI) (see below). Consolidation schedule This schedule is used as a tool to add together P's and S’s income and expenses and make any necessary adjustments. It includes: • • 100% of P's income and expenses 100% of S's income and expenses (unless a mid­year acquisition has occurred in which case this is time apportioned). P S Adj Total Time apportion if mid­year Revenue X X (X) X Cost of sales (X) (X) X (X) Operating expenses (X) (X) (X) (X) Finance cost (X) (X) (X) Income taxes (X) (X) (X) ––– ––– Profit after tax X X Impairment of goodwill Once any impairment has been identified during the year, the charge for the year will be passed through the consolidated income statement. This will usually be through operating expenses, however always follow instructions from the examiner. Total impairment to date is an adjustment in retained earnings in the consolidated statement of financial position. Non­controlling interest This is calculated as: NCI% × subsidiary’s profit after tax (taken from S’s column of consolidation schedule). KAPLAN PUBLISHING 95 Consolidated income statement Illustration 1 – Basic consolidated income statement Poplin acquired, several years ago, 80% of the ordinary share capital of Silk. Their results for the year ended 30 November 20X4 were as follows: P S $000 $000 Sales revenue 8,500 2,200 Cost of sales and expenses (7,650) (1,980) ______ ______ Trading profit before tax 850 220 Income taxes (400) (100) ______ ______ 450 120 ______ ______ Prepare the consolidated income statement for the year ended 30 November 20X4. Expandable text ­ Solution Dividends A payment of a dividend by S to P will need to be cancelled. The effect of this on the consolidated income statement is: • only dividends paid by P to its own shareholders appear in the consolidated financial statements. These are shown within the consolidated statement of changes in equity which you will not be required to prepare for the F7 examination. • any dividend income shown in the consolidated income statement must arise from investments other than those in subsidiaries or associates (covered in chapter 7). Expandable Text ­ NCI dividend Fair values If a depreciating non­current asset of the subsidiary has been revalued as part of a fair value exercise when calculating goodwill, this will result in an adjustment to the consolidated income statement. 96 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 6 The subsidiary's own income statement will include depreciation based on the value the asset is held at in the subsidiary's own SFP. The consolidated income statement must include a depreciation charge based on the fair value of the asset, included in the consolidated SFP. Extra depreciation must therefore be calculated and charged to an appropriate cost category within the consolidation schedule. Test your understanding 1 The income statements for Paddle and Skip for the year ended 31 August 20X4 are shown below. Paddle acquired 75% of the ordinary share capital of Skip several years ago. Sales revenue Cost of sales and expenses Trading profit Investment income: Dividend received from Skip Profit before tax Tax Profit for the year Paddle Skip $ 2,400,000 (2,160,000) –––––––– 240,000 $ 800,000 (720,000) ––––––– 80,000 1,500 –––––––– 241,500 (115,000) –––––––– 126,500 ––––––– 80,000 (38,000) ––––––– 42,000 Prepare the consolidated income statement for the year. Ignore goodwill. 2 Sales, purchases and inventories The effect of intra­group trading must be eliminated from the consolidated income statement. Sales and purchases Such trading will be included in the sales revenue of one group company and the purchases of another. • Consolidated sales revenue = P’s revenue + S’s revenue – intra­group sales. • Consolidated cost of sales = P’s COS + S’s COS – intra­group sales. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 97 Consolidated income statement The deduction of the intra­group sales in both cases should be shown in the adjustments column of the consolidation schedule. Inventory If any goods sold intra­group are included in closing inventory, their value must be adjusted to the lower of cost and net realisable value (NRV) to the group (as in the CSFP). The adjustment for unrealised profit should be shown as an increase to cost of sales in the seller’s column in the consolidation schedule. Expandable text ­ Unrealised profit in inventory Illustration 2 – Sales, purchases and inventories Given below are the income statements for Paris and its subsidiary London for the year ended 31 December 20X5. Sales revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Distribution costs Administrative expenses Investment income Taxation Net profit for the year Paris $000 3,200 (2,200) ––––– 1,000 (160) (400) ––––– 440 160 ––––– 600 (400) ––––– 200 London $000 2,560 (1,480) ––––– 1,080 (120) (80) ––––– 880 – ––––– 880 (480) ––––– 400 Additional information: 98 • Paris paid $1.5 million on 31 December 20X1 for 80% of London’s ordinary share capital of $800,000. The balance on London’s retained earnings was $600,000 at that time. • Goodwill impairments at 1 January 20X5 amounted to $152,000. A further impairment of $38,000 was found to be necessary at the year end. Impairments are included within administrative expenses. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 6 • Paris made sales to London, at a selling price of $600,000 during the year. Not all of the goods had been sold externally by the year end. The profit element included in London’s closing inventory was $30,000. • The figure for investment income in Paris’s income statement comprises the parent company’s share of the subsidiary’s total dividend for the year. Prepare a consolidated income statement for the year ended 31 December 20X5 for the Paris group. Expandable text ­ Solution Test your understanding 2 On 1 January 20X9 Zebedee acquired 60% of the ordinary shares of Xavier. The following income statements have been produced by Zebedee and Xavier for the year ended 31 December 20X9. Sales revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Distribution costs Administration expenses Profit from operations Investment income from Xavier Profit before taxation Taxation Profit after taxation Zebedee $000 1,260 (420) ––––– 840 (180) (120) ––––– 540 36 ––––– 576 (130) ––––– 446 Xavier $000 520 (210) ––––– 310 (60) (90) ––––– 160 ––––– 160 (26) ––––– 134 During the year ended 31 December 20X9 Zebedee had sold $84,000 worth of goods to Xavier. These goods had cost Zebedee $56,000. On 31 December 20X9 Xavier still had $36,000 worth of these goods in inventories (held at cost to Xavier). KAPLAN PUBLISHING 99 Consolidated income statement Prepare the consolidated income statement to incorporate Zebedee and Xavier for the year ended 31 December 20X9. Note: Goodwill on consolidation has not been impaired. Interest If loans are outstanding between group companies, intra­group loan interest will be paid and received. Both the loan and loan interest must be excluded from the consolidated results. The relevant amount of interest should be deducted from group investment income and group finance costs through the adjustments column of the consolidation schedule. Transfers of non­current assets If one group company sells a non­current asset to another group company the following adjustments are needed in the income statement. • Any profit or loss arising on the transfer must be deducted from the appropriate category within the seller’s column in the consolidation schedule. • The depreciation charge must be adjusted (again in the seller’s column of the schedule) so that it is based on the cost of the asset to the group. Expandable text ­ Unrealised profit on non­current assets 3 Mid­year acquisitions Mid­year acquisition procedure If a subsidiary is acquired part way through the year, then the subsidiary’s results should only be consolidated from the date of acquisition, i.e. the date on which control is obtained. In practice this will require: 100 • Identification of the net assets of S at the date of acquisition in order to calculate goodwill. • Time apportionment of the results of S in the year of acquisition.For this purpose, unless indicated otherwise, assume that revenue and expenses accrue evenly. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 6 • After time­apportioning S’s results, deduction of post acquisition intra­ group items as normal. Expandable text ­ Illustration: Mid­year acquisition Expandable text Test your understanding 3 Set out below are the draft income statements of Smiths and its subsidiary company Flowers for the year ended 31 December 20X7. On 1 January 20X6 Smiths purchased 75,000 ordinary shares in Flowers at a cost of $170,000. The issued share capital of Flowers is 100,000 $1 ordinary shares. At that date the income statement of Flowers showed a credit balance of $60,000. Income statements for the year ended 31 December 20X7 Smiths Flowers $000 $000 Sales revenue 600 300 Cost of sales (360) (140) –––– –––– Gross profit 240 160 Operating costs (93) (45) –––– –––– Operating profit Interest payable Profit before tax Tax Profit for the year 147 –––– 147 (50) –––– 97 115 (3) –––– 112 (32) –––– 80 The following additional information is relevant. (1) During the year Flowers sold goods to Smiths for $20,000, making a mark­up of one third. Only 20% of these goods were sold before the end of the year, the rest were still in inventory. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 101 Consolidated income statement (2) Goodwill has been subject to an impairment review at the end of each year since acquisition. The first review at the end of last year revealed an impairment of $5,000 and the review at the end of this year revealed another impairment of $5,000. The current impairment is to be recognised as an operating cost. Prepare for presentation to members the consolidated income statement account for the year ended 31 December 20X7. 102 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 6 Chapter summary KAPLAN PUBLISHING 103 Consolidated income statement Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 Paddle consolidated income statement for year ended31 August 20X4 Sales revenue Cost of sales and expenses Group profit before tax Tax Profit for the year Attributable to: Group (167,000 – NCI) Non­controlling interest ( W1) Consolidation schedule Revenue Cost of sales and expenses Income taxes Profit after tax $ 3,200,000 (2,880,000) –––––––– 320,000 (153,000) –––––––– 167,000 156,500 10,500 P S Adj $000 $000 $000 2,400 800 (2,160) (720) (115) (38) ––––– 42 Total $000 3,200 (2,880) (153) ––––– 167 (W1) Non­controlling interest 25% × $42,000 = $10,500 104 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 6 Test your understanding 2 Zebedee consolidated income statement for the year ended 31 December 20X9 $000 1,696 (558) ––––– 1,138 (240) (210) ––––– 688 (156) ––––– 532 Sales revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Distribution costs Administrative expenses Operating profit Taxation Profit after tax Amount attributable to: Equity holders of the parent (532 – NCI) Non­controlling interests (W3) 478.4 53.6 Workings Consolidation schedule Z X Adj Total $000 $000 $000 $000 Turnover 1,260 Cost of sales (420) (210) PURP (W2) 520 (12) (84) 1,696 84 (558) Distribution costs (180) (60) (240) Administrative expenses (120) (90) (210) Tax (130) (26) (156) ––– ––––– 134 532 Profit after tax KAPLAN PUBLISHING 105 Consolidated income statement (W1) Group structure (W2) Unrealised profit in inventory $000 84 (56) ––– 28 ––– Selling price Cost Total profit The profit mark­up is therefore one third of the selling price 28 –– 84 = 1 –– 3 Since closing inventory at selling price is $36,000 the unrealised profit is 1 –– 3 x $36,000 = $12,000 (W3) Non­controlling interest NCI share of subsidiary’s profit after tax 40% × $134,000 106 $000 53.6 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 6 Test your understanding 3 Smiths consolidated income statement for the year ended 31 December 20X7 $000 880 (484) ––––– 396 (143) ––––– 253 (3) ––––– 250 (82) ––––– 168 Sales revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Operating costs Profit from operations Interest payable Profit before tax Tax Profit for the year Attributable to Non­controlling interest (W3) Group (168 – 19) 19 149 Workings Consolidation schedule Sales revenue Cost of sales PURP (W4) Operating costs Finance cost Income taxes Profit after tax KAPLAN PUBLISHING S $000 600 (360) (93) (50) F $000 300 (140) (4) (45) (3) (32) –––– 76 Adj $000 (20) 20 (5) G’will Total $000 880 (484) (143) (3) (82) –––– 168 107 Consolidated income statement (W1) Group structure (W2) Unrealised profit (80% × 20,000) × 33/133 = 4 Seller = subsidiary (W3) Non­controlling interest NCI share of subsidiary’s PAT from consolidation schedule 25% × 76 = 19 108 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 7 Associates Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • • define an associate • prepare a consolidated statement of financial position to include a single subsidiary and an associate • prepare a consolidated income statement to include a single subsidiary and an associate. explain the principles and reasoning for the use of equity accounting 109 Associates 1 IAS 28 Investments in associates Definition of an associate IAS 28 defines an associate as: An entity over which the investor has significant influence and that is neither a subsidiary nor an interest in joint venture. Significant influence is the power to participate in the financial and operating policy decisions of the investee but is not control or joint control over those policies. Significant influence is assumed with a shareholding of 20% to 50%. 110 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 7 Principles of equity accounting and reasoning behind it Equity accounting is a method of accounting that brings an associate investment into the parent company’s financial statements initially at cost. The carrying amount of the investment is then adjusted in each period by the group share of the profit of the associate less any impairment losses. The investment in the associate is therefore stated at: • • • cost plus group share of retained post­acquisition profits; less amounts written off (i.e. impairment losses). The effect of this is that the consolidated statement of financial position includes: • 100% of the assets and liabilities of the parent and subsidiary company on a line by line basis • an ‘investments in associates’ line within non­current assets which includes the group share of the assets and liabilities of any associate. The consolidated income statement includes: • 100% of the income and expenses of the parent and subsidiary company on a line by line basis • one line ‘share of profit of associates’ which includes the group share of any associate’s profit after tax. Note that in order to equity account, the parent company must already be producing consolidated financial statements (i.e. it must already have at least one subsidiary). Expandable text ­ IAS 28 Investments in Associates 2 Associates in the consolidated statement of financial position Preparing the CSFP including an associate The CSFP is prepared on a normal line­by­line basis following the acquisition method for the parent and subsidiary. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 111 Associates The associate is included as a non­current asset investment calculated as: Cost of investment Share of post acquisition profits Less: impairment losses $000 X X (X) ___ X ___ The group share of the associate’s post acquisition profits or losses and the impairment of goodwill will also be included in the group retained earnings calculation. 01; $000 Parents share of associates net assets at reporting date (W2) Carrying Goodwill/Premium (W3) X X —— X —— Standard workings The calculations for an associate (A) can be incorporated into standard CSFP workings as follows. (W1) Group structure 112 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 7 (W2) Net assets of S Share capital Retained earnings At date of acquisition At the reporting date $ X X ___ X ___ $ X X ___ X ___ At date of acquisition $ X X ___ X ___ At the reporting date $ X X ___ X ___ Net assets of A Share capital Retained earnings W3 Goodwill – S Proportion of net assets (old method) Purchase consideration For: Parents share of subs net assets at acquisition Goodwill on acquisition Less: Impairment Carrying Goodwill x (x) — x (x) — x — or; KAPLAN PUBLISHING 113 Associates Fair value method (new method) Purchase Consideration For: Parents share of subs net assets at acquisition Goodwill ­ Parents share F.V of NCI @ acquisition Less: NCI % of subs net assets at acquisition Goodwill ­ NCI share Total Goodwill on acquisition Less impairment Carrying Goodwill W4 Non Controlling Interest (old method) Parents share of subs net assets at reporting date or; Non­ controlling interest (new method) Parents share of subs net assets at reporting date NCI share of Goodwill $000 $000 (x) — x x (x) — x — x (x) — x — x x x — x — (W5) Group retained earning $ Preserve (100%) S – group share of post­acquisition reserves A – group share of post­acquisition reserves Less: Impairment losses to date (S + A) (W3) 114 X X X X — X — KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 7 (W6) Investment in associated company $ X X X — X — Cost of investment Post­acquisition profits (W5) Less impairment or: Parents share of Assets NA @ reporting date Carrying Goodwill X X — X — Illustration 1 ­ Associates in the SCFP Below are the statements of financial position of three companies as at 31 December 20X9. Non­current assets: Tangible assets Investments 672,000 shares in LaaLaa 168,000 shares in Po Current assets: Inventory Receivables Cash KAPLAN PUBLISHING Dipsy $000 LaaLaa $000 Po $000 1,120 980 840 644 224 ––––––– 1,988 ­ ­ ––––––– 980 ­ ­ ––––––– 840 380 190 35 ––––––– 605 ––––––– 2,593 ––––––– 640 310 58 ––––––– 1,008 ––––––– 1,988 ––––––– 190 100 46 ––––––– 336 ––––––– 1,176 ––––––– 115 Associates Equity and liabilities Capital and reserves $1 ordinary shares Retained earnings Current liabilities: Trade payables Taxation 1,120 1,232 ––––––– 2,352 840 602 ––––––– 1,442 560 448 ––––––– 1,008 150 91 ––––––– 241 ––––––– 2,593 ––––––– 480 66 ––––––– 546 ––––––– 1,988 ––––––– 136 32 ––––––– 168 ––––––– 1,176 ––––––– You are also given the following information: (1) Dipsy acquired its shares in LaaLaa on 1 January 20X9 when LaaLaa had retained losses of $56,000. (2) Dipsy acquired its shares in Po on 1 January 20X9 when Po had retained earnings of $140,000. (3) An impairment test at the year end shows that goodwill for LaaLaa remains unimpaired and the investment in Po by $2,800. (4) The Dipsy Group values the non­controlling interest at full value. The fair value on 1 January 20X9 was $157,000. Prepare the consolidated statement of financial position for the year ended 31 December 20X9 for Dipsy and its subsidiary, incorporating its associated company in accordance with IAS 28. Expandable text­ Solution Fair values and the associate If the fair value of the associate’s net assets at acquisition are materially different from their book value the net assets should be adjusted in the same way as for a subsidiary. 116 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 7 Balances with the associate Generally the associate is considered to be outside the group. Therefore balances between group companies and the associate will remain in the consolidated statement of financial position. If a group company trades with the associate, the resulting payables and receivables will remain in the consolidated statement of financial position. Unrealised profit in inventory Adjustment must be made for unrealised profit in inventory as follows. (1) Determine the value of closing inventory which is the result of a sale to or from the associate. (2) Use mark­up/margin to calculate the profit earned by the selling company. (3) Make the required adjustments. These will depend upon who the seller is: Parent company selling to associate — the profit element is included in the parent company’s accounts. Dr Group retained earnings Cr Investment in associate Associate selling to parent company— the profit element is included in the associate company’s accounts. Dr Group retained earnings Cr Group inventory 3 Associates in the consolidated income statement Equity accounting The equity method of accounting requires that the consolidated income statement: • • does not include dividends from the associate instead includes group share of the associate’s profit after tax less any impairment of the associate in the year. Expandable Text ­ Proforma consolidated income statement KAPLAN PUBLISHING 117 Associates Trading with the associate Generally the associate is considered to be outside the group. Therefore any sales or purchases between group companies and the associate are not normally eliminated and will remain part of the consolidated figures in the income statement. It is normal practice to instead adjust for the unrealised profit in inventory. The following illustration will explain this in more detail. Illustration 2 – Associates in the consolidated income statement Below are the income statements of the Barbie group and its associated companies, as at 31 December 20X8. Sales revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Operating expenses Profit before tax Tax Profit after tax Barbie $000 385 (185) ___ 200 (50) ___ 150 (50) ___ 100 Ken $000 100 (60) ___ 40 (15) ___ 25 (12) ___ 13 Shelly $000 60 (20) ___ 40 (10) ___ 30 (10) ___ 20 You are also given the following information. (1) Barbie acquired 60,000 ordinary shares in Shelly for $80,000 when that company had a credit balance on its retained earnings of $50,000 a number of years ago. Shelly has 200,000 $1 ordinary shares. (2) Barbie acquired 45,000 ordinary shares in Ken , a number of years ago, for $70,000 when retained earnings were $20,000. Ken has 50,000 $1 ordinary shares. (3) During the year Shelly sold goods to Barbie for $28,000. None of these goods were in inventory at the year end 118 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 7 (4) Goodwill and the investment in the associate were impaired for the first time during the year as follows: Shelly $2,000 Ken $3,000 Impairment of the subsidiary’s goodwill should be charged to operating expenses. Prepare the consolidated income statement for Barbie including the results of its associated company. Expandable text ­ Solution Dividends from associates Dividends from associates are excluded from the consolidated income statement; the group share of the associate’s profit is included instead. Test your understanding 1 The following are the summarised accounts of Alecia (A), Devina (D) and Gertrude (G) for the year ended 31 December 20X4. Income statement A Sales revenue Operating costs Operating profit Interest payable Dividend income from D Dividend income from G Dividend income from other sources Profit before tax Tax Profit for the financial year KAPLAN PUBLISHING $ 573,600 (300,000) _______ 273,600 (20,000) 14,400 4,000 10,000 _______ 282,000 (72,000) _______ 210,000 _______ D G $ $ 314,000 150,000 (200,000) (90,000) _______ _______ 114,000 60,000 (14,000) (8,000) _______ 100,000 (30,000) _______ 70,000 _______ _______ 52,000 (16,000) _______ 36,000 _______ 119 Associates Statements of financial position Investment in D Ltd (60%) Investment in G Ltd (25%) Other assets Ordinary shares Retained earnings Current liabilities A $ 60,000 50,000 300,000 _______ 410,000 _______ D $ G $ 120,000 _______ 120,000 _______ 100,000 _______ 100,000 _______ $ 20,000 330,000 60,000 _______ 410,000 _______ $ 30,000 66,000 24,000 _______ 120,000 _______ $ 10,000 70,000 20,000 _______ 100,000 _______ The shares in Devina and Gertrude were acquired on 1 January 20X4, when the balances of gthe retained earnings accounts were: Devina $20,000 Gertrude $50,000 Goodwill in the subsidiary has suffered an impairment of 20% of its value, and the associate has suffered an impairment of $7,000. Subsidiary goodwill impairment is recognised in operating costs and impairment of the associate is charged against associate profits. Alecia has accounted for the dividends from subsidiary and associate. The Alecia group values the non­controlling interest at its proportionate share of the fair value of the subsidiary's identifiable net assets. Prepare the consolidated income statement for the year ended 31 December 20X4 and consolidated statement of financial position as at 31 December 20X4. 120 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 7 Chapter summary KAPLAN PUBLISHING 121 Associates Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 Alecia: consolidated statement of financial position as at 31 December 20X4 Goodwill (W3) Investment in associate (W6) Other assets (300 + 120) Share capital Retained earnings (W5) Non­controlling interest (W4) Current liabilities (60 + 24) $000 24 48 420 ––– 492 ––– 20 349.6 38.4 84 ––– 492 ––– Alecia: consolidated income statement for the year ended 31 December 20X4 Sales revenue (573.6 + 314) Operating costs (300 + 200 + 6) Operating profit Interest payable (20 + 14) Investment income Share of profits of associate (25% × 36) – 7 Profit before tax Tax (72 + 30) Profit for the year Attributable profit NCI (W4) Profit attributable to members of Alecia 122 $000 887.6 (506) ––– 381.6 (34) 10 2 ––– 359.6 (102) ––– 257.6 28 229.6 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 7 (W1) Group structure (W2) Net assets: Devina Share capital Retained earnings Net assets: Gertrude Share capital Retained earnings At date of acquisition At reporting date $ $ 30,000 30,000 20,000 66,000 –––––– –––––– 50,000 96,000 At date of acquisition At reporting date $ $ 10,000 10,000 50,000 70,000 –––––– –––––– 60,000 80,000 (W3) Goodwill – Devina $000 Cost of Investment $000 60,000 For: 60% net assets @ acquisition (60% × $50,000 (W2) ) (30,000) ——— Goodwill 30000 Less: impairment (20% × $30,000) (6,000) ——— 24,000 ——— KAPLAN PUBLISHING 123 Associates W4) Non­controlling interest Income statement SFP NCI share of Devina’s profit after tax (40% × 70,000) NCI share of Devina’s net assets at reporting date (40% × 96,000) $ 28,000 $38,400 (W5) Group reserves c/f Alecia (100%) Devina – group share of post acquisition retained earnings 60% × $(66,000 – 20,000) Gertrude – group share of post acquisition retained earnings 25% × $(70,000 – 50,000) Less impairment $ 330,000 27,600 5,000 (13,000) –––––– 349,600 –––––– (W6) Investment in associate Cost of investment Post acquisition profits (W6) Less impairment 124 $ 50,000 5,000 (7,000) –––––– 48,000 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 8 Tangible non­current assets Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • • • define the cost of a non­current asset • • • • distinguish between capital and revenue expenditure • • • • • account for revaluation of non­current assets • apply the provisions of IAS 20 in relation to accounting for government grants • • define investment properties • apply the requirements of IAS 40 for investment properties. calculate the initial cost measurement of a non­current asset calculate the initial cost measurement of a self­constructed non­ current asset identify the subsequent expenditure that may be capitalised explain the treatment of borrowing costs explain the requirements of IAS 16 in relation to the revaluation of non­current assets account for gains and losses on disposal of non­current assets calculate depreciation based on the cost model calculate depreciation based on the revaluation model calculate depreciation on assets that have two or more significant parts (complex assets) discuss why the treatment of investment properties should differ from other properties 125 Tangible non-current assets 1 IAS 16 Property, plant and equipment Property, plant and equipment Property, plant and equipment are tangible assets held by an entity for more than one accounting period for use in the production or supply of goods or services, for rental to others, or for administrative purposes. Recognition An item of property, plant and equipment should be recognised as an asset when: 126 • it is probable that future economic benefits associated with the asset will flow to the entity; and • the cost of the asset can be measured reliably. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 8 Initial measurement An item of property, plant and equipment should initially be measured at its cost: • • include all costs involved in bringing the asset into working condition • revenue costs should be written off as incurred. include in this initial cost capital costs such as the cost of site preparation, delivery costs, installation costs Expandable text ­ Construction costs Expandable text ­ Illustration: initial measurement Expandable text ­ Further illustration: initial measurement Subsequent expenditure Subsequent expenditure on property, plant and equipment should only be capitalised if it results in the total economic benefits expected from the asset to increase above those expected on original recognition, e.g. the cost of an extension to a building should be capitalised (capital expenditure) as economic benefits will increase with greater space. All other subsequent expenditure should be recognised in the income statement, because it merely maintains the economic benefits originally expected e.g. the cost of general repairs should be written off immediately (revenue expenditure). Expandable Text­ Illustration: subsequent expenditure Test your understanding 1 In each of the following cases justify whether or not the expenditure should be capitalised: (a) A new engine is fitted to a machine which will increase its production capacity from 100,000 units a year to 140,000 units a year. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 127 Tangible non-current assets (b) Replacement of rotting windows in the head office. (c) Replacement of an aircraft engine every five years. 2 Depreciation Definitions Depreciable amount is the cost of an asset, or other amount substituted for cost in the financial statements, less its residual value. Depreciation is the systematic allocation of the depreciable amount of an asset over its useful life. Expandable Text ­Illustration: depreciable amount Commencement of depreciation Depreciation must be charged from the date the asset is available for use, i.e. it is capable of operating in the manner intended by management. This may be earlier than the date it is actually brought into use, for example when staff need to be trained to use it. Depreciation is continued even if the asset is idle. Change in method of depreciation The depreciation method used should reflect as fairly as possible the pattern in which the asset’s economic benefits are consumed by the entity. Possible methods include: • • • straight line reducing balance machine hours. A change from one method of providing depreciation to another: • is permissible only on the grounds that the new method will give a fairer presentation of the results and of the financial position • • does not constitute a change of accounting policy is a change in accounting estimate. The carrying amount should be written off over the remaining useful life, commencing with the period in which the change is made. 128 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 8 Review of useful lives and residual values Useful life and residual value should be reviewed at the end of each reporting period and revised if expectations are significantly different from previous estimates. The carrying amount of the asset at the date of revision less any residual value should be depreciated over the revised remaining useful life. Expandable text ­ Revision of useful lives Illustration 1 – Depreciation Revision of useful life An asset was purchased for $100,000 on 1 January 20X5 and straight­ line depreciation of $20,000 pa is being charged (five­year life, no residual value). The annual review of asset lives is undertaken and for this particular asset, the remaining useful life as at 1 January 20X7 is eight years. The financial statements for the year ended 31 December 20X7 are being prepared. What is the depreciation charge for the year ended 31 December 20X7? Expandable text ­ Solution Separate components A complex asset is an asset that may be thought of as having separate components within a single asset, e.g. an engine within a piece of plant. Each separate part of the asset should be depreciated over their useful life. Major inspection or overhaul costs Inspection and overhaul costs are generally expensed as they are incurred. They are, however, capitalised as a non­current asset to the extent that they satisfy the IAS 16 rules for separate components. Where this is the case they are then depreciated over their useful lives. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 129 Tangible non-current assets Illustration 2 – Depreciation Overhaul costs An entity purchases an aircraft that has an expected useful life of 20 years with no residual value. The aircraft requires substantial overhaul at the end of years 5, 10 and 15. The aircraft cost $25 million and $5 million of this figure is estimated to be attributable to the economic benefits that are restored by the overhauls. Calculate the annual depreciation charge for the years 1­5 and years 6­ 10. Expandable text ­ Solution Expandable Text­ Further illustration :overhaul costs 3 Revaluation of non­current assets IAS 16 treatments IAS 16 allows a choice of accounting treatment for property, plant and equipment: • • the cost model the revaluation model. The cost model Property, plant and equipment should be valued at cost less accumulated depreciation. The revaluation model Property, plant and equipment may be carried at a revalued amount less any subsequent accumulated depreciation. If the revaluation alternative is adopted, two conditions must be complied with: • 130 Revaluations must subsequently be made with sufficient regularity to ensure that the carrying amount does not differ materially from the fair value at each reporting date. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 8 • When an item of property, plant and equipment is revalued, the entire class of assets to which the item belongs must be revalued. Accounting for a revaluation Steps: (1) Restate asset from cost to valuation. (2) Remove any existing accumulated depreciation provision. (3) Include increase in carrying value in revaluation reserve (part of other components of equity within the statement of financial position). Journal: $ Dr Dr Cr Non­current assets cost/valuation (revalued amount – cost) Accumulated depreciation (eliminate all of existing provision) Revaluation reserve (valuation less previous CV) $ X X X Recognising revaluation gains and losses Revaluation gains are recorded in the revaluation reserve and reported as a component of other comprehensive income either within the statement of comprehensive income or in a separate statement. Revaluation losses which represent an impairment are recognised in the income statement. Expandable text ­ The revaluation model KAPLAN PUBLISHING 131 Tangible non-current assets Illustration 3 – Revaluation of non­current assets Recognition of revaluation gain A company revalues its buildings and decides to incorporate the revaluation into its financial statements. Extract from the statement of financial position at 31 December 20X7: Buildings: Cost Depreciation $000 1,200 (144) ––––– 1,056 ––––– The building is revalued at 1 January 20X8 at $1,400,000. Its useful life is 40 years at that date. Show the relevant extracts from the final accounts at 31 December 20X8. Expandable text ­ Solution Depreciation of revalued asset Once an asset has been revalued the following treatment is required. 132 • Depreciation must be charged, based on valuation less residual value, over remaining useful life. • • The whole charge must go to the income statement for the year. An annual reserves transfer may be made (revaluation reserve to retained earnings) for extra depreciation on the revalued amount compared to cost. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 8 Journals Dr Cr Income statement depreciation charge Accumulated depreciation X X Revaluation reserve (depreciation on valuation – depreciation on original cost) Retained earnings X And: Dr Cr X Expandable text ­ Depreciation of revalued asset Test your understanding 2 A company revalued its land and buildings at the start of the year to $10 million ($4 million for the land). The property cost $5 million ($1 million for the land) ten years prior to the revaluation. The total expected useful life of 50 years is unchanged. The company's policy is to make an annual transfer of realised amounts to retained earnings. Show the effects of the above on the financial statements for the year. Disposal of revalued non­current assets The profit or loss on disposal of a revalued non­current asset should be calculated as the difference between the net sale proceeds and the carrying amount. It should be accounted for in the income statement of the period in which the disposal occurs. The remainder of the revaluation reserve relating to this asset should now be transferred to retained earnings. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 133 Tangible non-current assets Illustration 4 – Revaluation of non­current assets Disposal of revalued non­current assets A property costing $750,000 was purchased on 1 January 20X4 and is being depreciated over its useful life of 10 years. It has no residual value. At 31 December 20X4 the property was valued at $810,000. There was no change to its useful life. On 31 December 20X6 the property was sold for $900,000. What is the profit or loss on disposal? Expandable text ­ Solution Expandable text ­ Key disclosures 4 IAS 20 Accounting for government grants and disclosure of government assistance Introduction Governments often provide money or incentives to companies to export or promote local employment. Government grants could be: • • revenue grants, e.g. money towards wages capital grants, e.g. money towards purchase of non­current assets. General principles IAS 20 follows two general principles when determining the treatment of grants: Prudence: grants should not be recognised until the conditions for receipt have been complied with and there is reasonable assurance the grant will be received. Accruals: grants should be matched with the expenditure towards which they were intended to contribute. 134 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 8 Expandable text ­ IAS 20 definitions Revenue grants The recognition of the grant will depend upon the circumstances. • If the grant is paid when evidence is produced that certain expenditure has been incurred, the grant should be matched with that expenditure. • If the grant is paid on a different basis, e.g. achievement of a non­ financial objective, such as the creation of a specified number of new jobs, the grant should be matched with the identifiable costs of achieving that objective. Presentation of revenue grants IAS 20 allows such grants to either: • • be presented as a credit in the income statement, or deducted from the related expense. Expandable text Capital grants IAS 20 permits two treatments: • Write off the grant against the cost of the non­current asset and depreciate the reduced cost. • Treat the grant as a deferred credit and transfer a portion to revenue each year, so offsetting the higher depreciation charge on the original cost. Expandable text KAPLAN PUBLISHING 135 Tangible non-current assets Illustration 5 – IAS 20 Accounting for government grants Capital grants An entity opens a new factory and receives a government grant of $15,000 in respect of capital equipment costing $100,000. It depreciates all plant and machinery at 20% pa straight­line. Show the statement of financial position extracts in respect of the grant in the first year under both methods. Expandable text ­ Solution Test your understanding 3 Europe buys a building for a total cost of $200,000. It receives a European Union grant of $60,000 towards the cost and pays the net of $140,000 by cheque. The useful life of the building is estimated at 50 years. The deferred income method is to be used for the grant. Show the movement in tangible non­current assets and deferred grant income in the first year. Repayment of grants In some cases grants may need to be repaid if the conditions of the grant are breached. If there is an obligation to repay the grant and the repayment is probable, then it should be provided for in accordance with the requirements of IAS 37 (see chapter 15). Expandable text ­ Government assistance Expandable text ­ IAS 20 disclosure requirements 136 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 8 5 IAS 23 Borrowing costs IAS 23 treatment IAS 23 Borrowing costs regulates the extent to which entities are allowed to capitalise borrowing costs incurred on money borrowed to finance the acquisition of certain assets. • Borrowing costs must be capitalised as part of the cost of an asset, if that asset is one which necessarily takes a substantial time to get ready for its intended use or sale. The rate of interest to be taken Where borrowings are made specifically to acquire a qualifying asset: • Borrowing costs which may be capitalised are those actually incurred, less any investment income on the temporary investment of the borrowings. Where funds for the project are taken from general borrowings: • The weighted average cost of general borrowings is taken. This excludes borrowings with specific functions. Commencement of capitalisation Capitalisation of borrowing costs should commence when all of the following conditions are met: • • • expenditure for the asset is being incurred. borrowing costs are being incurred. activities that are necessary to prepare the asset for its intended use or sale are in progress. Cessation of capitalisation Capitalisation of borrowing costs should cease when either: • substantially all the activities necessary to prepare the qualifying asset for its intended use or sale are complete, or • construction is suspended, e.g. due to industrial disputes. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 137 Tangible non-current assets Illustration 6 – IAS 23 Borrowing costs On 1 January 20X5, Sainsco began to construct a supermarket which had an estimated useful life of 40 years. It purchased a leasehold interest in the site for $25 million. The construction of the building cost $9 million and the fixtures and fittings cost $6 million. The construction of the supermarket was completed on 30 September 20X5 and it was brought into use on 1 January 20X6. Sainsco borrowed $40 million on 1 January 20X5 in order to finance this project. The loan carried interest at 10% pa. It was repaid on 30 June 20X6. Calculate the total amount to be included at cost in property, plant and equipment in respect of the development at 31 December 20X5. Expandable text ­ Solution Disclosures The disclosures required by IAS 23 are: • • • the accounting policy adopted for borrowing costs the amount of borrowing costs capitalised during the period the capitalisation rate used. Test your understanding 4 A retailer, Lewis John constructed a new store at a cost of $50 million over six months from 1 January to 30 June 20X9. To assist the financing of the project the company raised a $40 million 10% loan on 1 January. The loan was repaid on 30 September. The store did not open until the following year. Calculate the initial cost valuation of the store. 6 IAS 40 Investment properties IAS 40 Definition Investment property is land or a building held to earn rentals, or for capital appreciation or both, rather than for use in the entity or for sale in the ordinary course of business. 138 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 8 Owner­occupied property is excluded from the definition of investment property. Accounting treatment Investment properties should initially be measured at cost. IAS 40 then gives a choice between following: • • a cost model a fair value model. Once the model is chosen it should be used for all investment properties Expandable text Cost model Under the cost model the asset should be accounted for in line with the cost model laid out in IAS 16. • The property will be shown in the statement of financial position at cost less accumulated depreciation. Fair value model Under the fair value model: • • • the asset is revalued to fair value at the end of each year the gain or loss is shown directly in the income statement no depreciation is charged on the asset. Fair value is normally established by reference to current prices on an active market for properties of in the same location and condition. Expandable text ­ Establishing fair value KAPLAN PUBLISHING 139 Tangible non-current assets Illustration 7 – IAS 40 Investment properties Celine, a manufacturing company, purchases a property for $1 million on 1 January 20X1 for its investment potential. The land element of the cost is believed to be $400,000, and the buildings element is expected to have a useful life of 50 years. At 31 December 20X1, local property indices suggest that the fair value of the property has risen to $1.1 million. Show how the property would be presented in the financial statements as at 31 December 20X1 if Celine adopts: (a) the cost model (b) the fair value model. Expandable text ­ Solution 140 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 8 Chapter summary KAPLAN PUBLISHING 141 Tangible non-current assets Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 (a) This expenditure enhances the economic benefits of the machine by increasing its productivity and therefore would be capitalised subsequent expenditure. (b) It would be difficult to argue that the replacement of the windows enhanced the economic benefits of the head office and therefore this would be treated as revenue expenditure and written off to the income statement as incurred. (c) The engine of an aircraft is likely to be a separate component asset of the aircraft as its economic life will be substantially less than that of the aircraft itself. The engine will be depreciated over a five year period and the cost of the replacement engine will then be capitalised every five years. Test your understanding 2 PPE Note Land and buildings (CV) B/f (5m ­ (10/50 x 4m)) Revaluation (β) Valuation Depreciation (6m/40years) C/f $000 4,200 5,800 ––––– 10,000 (150) ––––– 9,850 ––––– Other comprehensive income ­ extract Gain on property revaluation Statement of changes in equity B/f Comprehensive income for year Transfer to retained earnings (150 – 4m/50) C/f 142 $000 5,800 Revaluation surplus $000 0 5,800 (70) ––––– 5,730 ––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 8 Test your understanding 3 Building $ Cost B/f Addition Nil 200,000 ––––––– 200,000 ––––––– C/f Depreciation B/f Charge (200,000/50) Nil 4,000 ––––––– 4,000 ––––––– 196,000 ––––––– C/f CV Cf Grant $ Nil 60,000 (1,200) ––––––– 58,800 ––––––– B/f Granted Income (60,000/50) C/f Test your understanding 4 Interest to be capitalised = $40m × 10% × 6/12 = $2m. Initial cost: KAPLAN PUBLISHING $50m + $2m = $52m. 143 Tangible non-current assets 144 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 9 Intangible assets Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • explain the nature of internally­generated and purchased intangibles • explain the accounting treatment of internally­generated and purchased intangibles • • • distinguish between goodwill and other intangible assets • • • explain the subsequent accounting treatment of goodwill • • explain how this difference should be accounted for • explain the accounting requirements of IAS 38 for research expenditure and development expenditure • account for research expenditure and development expenditure. describe the criteria for the initial recognition of intangible assets describe the criteria for the initial measurement of intangible assets explain the principle of impairment tests in relation to goodwill explain why the value of the purchase consideration for an investment may be less than the value of the acquired net assets define research expenditure and development expenditure according to IAS 38 145 Intangible assets 1 Intangible assets Introduction Many businesses invest significant amounts with the intention of obtaining future value on areas such as: • • • • • • scientific/technical knowledge design of new processes and systems licences and quotas intellectual property, e.g. patents and copyrights market knowledge, e.g. customer lists, relationships and loyalty trade marks. All of these expenses may result in future benefits to the business, but not all can be recognised as assets. Objective of IAS 38 Intangible assets The objective of IAS 38 is to prescribe the specific criteria that must be met before an intangible asset can be recognised in the accounts. Definition An intangible asset is an identifiable non­monetary asset without physical substance. To meet the definition the asset must be identifiable, i.e. separable from the rest of the business or arising from legal rights. 146 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 9 It must also meet the normal definition of an asset: • controlled by the entity as a result of past events (normally by enforceable legal rights) • a resource from which future economic benefits are expected to flow (either from revenue or cost saving). Recognition To be recognised in the financial statements, an intangible asset must: • • meet the definition of an intangible asset, and meet the recognition criteria of the framework: – it is probable that future economic benefits attributable to the asset will flow to the entity – the cost of the asset can be measured reliably. If these criteria are met, the asset should be initially recognised at cost. Internally­generated intangibles The following internally­generated items may never be recognised: • • • • • goodwill brands mastheads publishing titles customer lists. Expandable text ­ Purchased and internally generated intangibles Test your understanding 1 How should the following intangible assets be treated in the financial statements? • • KAPLAN PUBLISHING A publishing title acquired as part of a subsidiary company. A licence purchased in order to market a new product. 147 Intangible assets Measurement after initial recognition There is a choice between: • • the cost model the revaluation model. The cost model • The intangible asset should be carried at cost less amortisation and any impairment losses. • This model is more commonly used in practice. The revaluation model • The intangible asset may be revalued to a carrying value of fair value less subsequent amortisation and impairment losses. • Fair value should be determined by reference to an active market. Features of an active market are that: – the items traded within the market are homogeneous – willing buyers and sellers can normally be found at any time – prices are available to the public. In practice such markets are rare. Expandable text ­ Revaluation model Amortisation An intangible asset with a finite useful life must be amortised over that life, normally using the straight­line method with a zero residual value. An intangible asset with an indefinite useful life: • • should not be amortised should be tested for impairment annually, and more often if there is an actual indication of possible impairment. Expandable text ­ Amortisation 148 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 9 Expandable text ­ Impairment losses Test your understanding 2 What is the accounting treatment of a recognised intangible asset with an indefinite useful life? Key disclosures The financial statements should disclose the following for each class of intangible assets, distinguishing between internally­generated intangible assets and other intangible assets: • • • whether the useful lives are finite or indefinite the useful lives or the amortisation rates used for assets with finite lives the amortisation methods used for assets with finite lives. 2 Goodwill The nature of goodwill Goodwill is the difference between the value of a business as a whole and the aggregate of the fair values of its separable net assets. Separable net assets are those assets (and liabilities) which can be identified and sold off separately without necessarily disposing of the business as a whole. They include identifiable intangibles such as patents, licences and trade marks. Fair value is the amount at which an asset or liability could be exchanged in an arm’s length transaction between informed and willing parties, other than in a forced or liquidation sale. Goodwill may exist because of any combination of a number of possible factors: • • • • reputation for quality or service technical expertise possession of favourable contracts good management and staff. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 149 Intangible assets Purchased and non­purchased goodwill Purchased goodwill: • • arises when one business acquires another as a going concern • will be recognised in the financial statements as its value at a particular point in time is certain. includes goodwill arising on the consolidation of a subsidiary or associated company Non­purchased goodwill: • • • is also known as inherent goodwill has no identifiable value is not recognised in the financial statements. IFRS 3 revised Business combinations IFRS 3 revised governs accounting for all business combinations and deals with the accounting treatment of goodwill. Goodwill is defined in IFRS 3 as an asset representing the future economic benefits arising from assets acquired in a business combination that are not individually identified and separately recognised. Goodwill is calculated at the acquisition date as: Fair value of consideration paid (shares issued plus cash paid plus direct costs) Non­controlling interest (valued either at fair value or as a proportion of net assets) Fair value of net assets of acquiree $ X X ___ X (X) ___ X Accounting treatment of goodwill Purchased goodwill: • • • 150 should be capitalised as an intangible non­current asset should not be amortised must be tested for impairment annually in accordance with IAS 36, or more frequently if circumstances indicate that it might be impaired. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 9 Expandable text ­ Purchased and non­purchased goodwill Test your understanding 3 An entity acquires 75% of the share capital of another entity, JKL. The consideration for the purchase was shares with a fair value of $800,000 and cash of $200,000. There were direct costs involved in the takeover of $20,000 .The non­controlling interest is valued using the proportion of net assets method.The carrying amounts and fair values of JKL assets and liabilities at the date of acquisition were as follows: Tangible non­current assets Current assets Current liabilities Carrying value $000 700 400 (200) ––––– 900 Fair value $000 950 350 (200) ––––– 1,100 What is the amount of goodwill be recognised on acquisition? Expandable text ­ Bargain purchases Test your understanding 4 What are the main characteristics of goodwill which distinguish it from other intangible assets? State your reasons. 3 Research and development expenditure Definitions Research is original and planned investigation undertaken with the prospect of gaining new scientific knowledge and understanding. Development is the application of research findings or other knowledge to a plan or design for the production of new or substantially improved materials, devices, products, processes, systems or services before the start of commercial production or use. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 151 Intangible assets Accounting treatment Research expenditure: write off as incurred to the income statement Development expenditure: recognise as an intangible asset if, and only if, an entity can demonstrate all of the following: • the technical feasibility of completing the intangible asset so that it will be available for use or sale • • • its intention to complete the intangible asset and use or sell it • the availability of adequate technical, financial and other resources to complete the development and to use or sell the intangible asset • its ability to reliably measure the expenditure attributable to the intangible asset during its development. its ability to use or sell the intangible asset how the intangible asset will generate probable future economic benefits. Among other things, the entity should demonstrate the existence of a market for the output of the intangible asset or the intangible asset itself or, if it is to be used internally, the usefulness of the intangible asset Expandable text Test your understanding 5 An entity has incurred the following expenditure during the current year: (a) $100,000 spent on the design of a new product ­ it is anticipated that this design will be taken forward over the next two year period to be developed and tested with a view to production in three years time. (b) $500,000 spent on the testing of a new production system which has been designed internally and which will be in operation during the following accounting year. This new system should reduce the costs of production by 20%. How should each of these costs be treated in the financial statements of the entity? 152 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 9 Amortisation Development expenditure should be amortised over its useful life. Illustration 1 – Research and development expenditure Amortisation of development expenditure Improve has deferred development expenditure of $600,000 relating to the development of New Miracle Brand X. It is expected that the demand for the product will stay at a high level for the next three years. Annual sales of 400,000, 300,000 and 200,000 units respectively are expected over this period. Brand X sells for $10. How should the development expenditure be amortised? Expandable text ­ Solution Disclosure The key disclosures required for development costs are: • • • the useful lives or the amortisation rates used for assets with finite lives the amortisation methods used for assets with finite lives the gross carrying amount and the accumulated amortisation (aggregated with accumulated impairment losses) at the beginning and end of the period. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 153 Intangible assets Test your understanding 6 D&E are both development projects. Both projects are anticipated to be successful. They have clearly­defined parameters. The project expenditure is carefully controlled. The prototypes proved successful. The budgets show sales well in excess of total costs. Finance is readily available. Project D has commenced production and the revenues have started to flow in. Project Project D E Costs accumulated to 1.1.X5 (and meeting capitalisation criteria) Costs incurred during the year Total anticipated net revenues Net revenues during the year $000 400 $000 350 600 250 30,000 15,000 6,000 nil The company has also invested $340,000 in development project F but the tests are at present inconclusive. Describe with reasons the accounting for the above issues. 154 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 9 Chapter summary KAPLAN PUBLISHING 155 Intangible assets Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 • The answer depends on whether the asset can be valued reliably. If this is possible, the title will be recognised at its fair value, otherwise it will be treated as part of goodwill on acquisition of the subsidiary. • As the licence has been purchased separately from a business, it should be capitalised at cost. Test your understanding 2 An intangible asset with an indefinite useful life: • • should not be amortised should be tested for impairment annually, and more often if there is an actual indication of possible impairment. Test your understanding 3 $000 Fair value of consideration Shares Cash 800 200 ––––– 1,000 Non­controlling interest (1,100 x 25%) 275 ––––– 1,275 (1,100) Net assets of acquiree Goodwill 175 ––––– Note: IFRS 3 revised requires acquisition costs to be expensed as incurred. They do not form part of the cost of acquisition. 156 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 9 Test your understanding 4 Characteristics • It is a ‘balancing figure’. Goodwill itself is not valued but a comparison is made between the fair value of the whole business and the fair value of the separable net assets of the business. It cannot be valued on its own. • • Goodwill cannot be disposed of as a separate asset. • The value of goodwill is volatile – it can only be given a numerical value at the time of acquisition of the whole business. The factors contributing to the value of goodwill cannot be valued, e.g. how can one value the benefit of an experienced workforce? Test your understanding 5 (a) These are research costs as they are only in the early design stage and therefore should be written off as part of profit and loss for the period. (b) These would appear to be development stage costs as the new production system is due to be in place fairly soon and will produce economic benefits in the shape of reduced costs. Therefore these should be capitalised as development costs. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 157 Intangible assets Test your understanding 6 As tests are inconclusive in project F, its costs must be expensed to the income statement. Projects D and E are both examples of development spend which meets the capitalisation critera and as such the relevant costs are shown as assets on the statement of financial position. Project D has commenced production and so requires amortisation. Development expenditure B/f Capitalised Amortised (6/30 × 1,000) C/f Intangible non­current assets (Note) Development expenditure as at 1.1.X5 Costs deferred Released to the Income statement as at 31.12.X5 158 D 400 600 (200) –––– 800 E 350 250 Nil –––– 600 Total 750 850 (200) –––– 1,400 $000 750 850 (200) ––––– 1,400 ––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 10 Impairment of assets Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • • • • define an impairment loss • allocate an impairment loss to the assets of a CGU. list the circumstances which may indicate impairments to assets describe a cash generating unit (CGU) explain the basis on which impairment losses should be allocated 159 Impairment of assets 1 Impairment of individual assets Objective of IAS 36 impairment of assets The objective is to set rules to ensure that the assets of an entity are carried at no more than their recoverable amount (i.e. value to the business). Expandable text ­ Excluded assets Impairment An asset is impaired if its recoverable amount is below the value currently shown on the statement of financial position – the asset’s current carrying value (CV). Recoverable amount is taken as the higher of: • • 160 fair value less costs to sell (net selling price), and value in use. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 10 An impairment exists if: Expandable text ­ Measurement of recoverable amount Illustration 1 – Impairment of individual assets Recoverable amount A company owns a car that was involved in an accident at the year end. It is barely useable, so the value in use is estimated at $1,000. However, the car is a classic and there is a demand for the parts. This results in a net realisable value of $3,000. The opening carrying value was $8,000 and the car was estimated to have a life of eight years from the start of the year. Identify the recoverable amount of the car. Expandable text ­ Solution Test your understanding 1 The following information relates to three assets: Carrying value Net realisable value Value in use A $000 100 110 120 B $000 150 125 130 C $000 120 100 90 What is the recoverable amount of each asset? KAPLAN PUBLISHING 161 Impairment of assets Calculate the impairment loss for each of the three assets. Expandable Text­ Illustration : recoverable amount Indications of impairment IAS 36 requires that at each reporting date, an entity must assess whether there are indications of impairment. Indications may be derived from within the entity itself (internal sources) or the external market (external sources). External sources of information • The asset’s market value has declined more than expected. • Changes in the technological, market, economic or legal environment have had an adverse effect on the entity. • Interest rates have changed, thus increasing the discount rate used in calculating the asset’s value in use. Internal sources of information • There is evidence of obsolescence of or damage to the asset. • • Changes in the way the asset is used have occurred or are imminent. Evidence is available from internal reporting indicating that the economic performance of an asset is, or will be, worse than expected. Expandable text ­ Annual impairment reviews Recognition and measurement of an impairment Where there is an indication of impairment, an impairment review should be carried out: • • • the recoverable amount should be calculated the asset should be written down to recoverable amount and the impairment loss should be immediately recognised in the income statement. The only exception to this is if the impairment reverses a previous gain taken to the revaluation reserve. 162 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 10 In this case, the impairment will be taken first to the revaluation reserve (and so disclosed as other comprehensive income) until the revaluation gain is reversed and then to the income statement. Test your understanding 2 An entity owns a property which was originally purchased for $300,000. The property has been revalued to $500,000 with the revaluation of $200,000 being recognised as other comprehensive income and recorded in the revaluation reserve. The property has a current carrying value of $460,000 but the recoverable amount of the property has just been estimated at only $200,000. What is the amount of impairment and how should this be treated in the financial statements? Expandable text ­ Reversal of impairment losses 2 Cash generating units (CGUs) What is a CGU? When assessing the impairment of assets it will not always be possible to base the impairment review on individual assets. • The value in use calculation will be impossible on a single asset because the asset does not generate distinguishable cash flows. • In this case, the impairment calculation should be based on a CGU. Definition of a CGU A CGU is defined as the smallest identifiable group of assets which generates cash inflows independent of those of other assets. Expandable text ­ Illustration ­ CGUs Expandable text ­ Goodwill and CGUs KAPLAN PUBLISHING 163 Impairment of assets The impairment calculation The impairment calculation is done by: • • assuming the cash generating unit is one asset comparing the carrying value of the CGU to the recoverable amount of the CGU. As previously, an impairment exists where the carrying value exceeds the recoverable amount. Impairment of a CGU If a CGU is impaired the assets must be written down in a strict order: (1) any obviously impaired asset (2) goodwill allocated to the CGU (both recognised goodwill and , where the proportion of net assets method is used to value the NCI, notional goodwill attributed to the NCI) (3) other assets (pro rata according to carrying value). Note: No individual asset should be written down below recoverable amount. Test your understanding 3 A company runs a unit that suffers a massive drop in income due to the failure of its technology on 1 January 20X8. The following carrying values were recorded in the books immediately prior to the impairment: Goodwill Technology Brands Land Buildings Other net assets 164 $m 20 5 10 50 30 40 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 10 The recoverable value of the unit is estimated at $85 million. The technology is worthless, following its complete failure. The other net assets include inventory, receivables and payables. It is considered that the book value of other net assets is a reasonable representation of its net realisable value. Show the impact of the impairment on 1 January. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 165 Impairment of assets Chapter summary 166 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 10 Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 The recoverable amounts for each asset are as follows: A: $120,000 B: $130,000 C: $100,000 The impairment loss for each asset is as follows: A: Nil B: $20,000 C: $20,000 Test your understanding 2 Impairment = $460,000 – 200,000 = $260,000 Of this $200,000 is debited to the revaluation reserve to reverse the previous upwards revaluation (and recorded as other comprehensive income) and the remaining $60,000 is charged to the income statement. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 167 Impairment of assets Test your understanding 3 • • • Carrying value is $155 million. Recoverable value is $85 million. Therefore an impairment of $70 million is required. Carrying value Goodwill Impairment Impaired value 20 (20) 0 5 (5) 0 Brands 10 (5) 5 Land 50 (25) 25 Buildings 30 (15) 15 Other 40 (0) 40 CGU 155 (70) 85 Technology Working Total impairment: Allocated – Goodwill – Technology Remaining Prorate based on carrying value: Brands Land Buildings 168 $m 70 (20) (5) ––– 45 45 × 10/(10 + 50 + 30) = 45 × 50/(10 + 50 + 30) = 45 × 30/(10 + 50 + 30) = 5 25 15 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 11 Inventories and construction contracts Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • explain the principles of IAS 2 with regard to the valuation of inventory • apply the principles of IAS 2 with regard to the valuation of inventory • • define a construction contract • explain the acceptable methods of determining the stage (%) of completion of a construction contract • prepare financial statement extracts for construction contracts. explain how accounting concepts affect the recognition of profit on construction contracts 169 Inventories and construction contracts 1 Accounting for inventory IAS 2 inventory valuation Inventories are valued at the lower of cost and net realisable value (NRV). Definition of cost Cost is the cost of bringing items of inventory to their present location and condition (including cost of purchase and costs of conversion). Expandable text ­ Definition of cost Expandable text ­ Definition of NRV Expandable text ­ Inventory valuation methods Expandable text ­ Disclosure requirements 170 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 11 Test your understanding 1 Value the following items of inventory. (a) Materials costing $12,000 bought for processing and assembly for a profitable special order. Since buying these items, the cost price has fallen to $10,000. (b) Equipment constructed for a customer for an agreed price of $18,000. This has recently been completed at a cost of $16,800. It has now been discovered that, in order to meet certain regulations, conversion with an extra cost of $4,200 will be required. The customer has accepted partial responsibility and agreed to meet half the extra cost. 2 IAS 11 Construction contracts Definition of a construction contract A construction contract is a contract specifically negotiated for the construction of an asset or a combination of assets that are closely interrelated or interdependent in terms of their design technology and function or their ultimate purpose or use. Accounting problem of construction contracts Construction contracts cause special problems as they are often of such a length that they span more than one accounting period. Therefore, some prescribed method of recording turnover, cost of sales and profit over the life of the contract is needed. Expandable text ­ Illustration :construction contracts Expandable text ­ Contract revenue and costs Recognition of contract revenue and expenses Recognition depends upon whether the outcome of a contract can be measured reliably KAPLAN PUBLISHING 171 Inventories and construction contracts Where the outcome of a contract can be estimated reliably If the expected outcome is a profit: • revenue and costs should be recognised according to the stage of completion of the contract. If the expected outcome is a loss: • the whole loss to completion should be recognised immediately. Where the outcome of a construction contract cannot be estimated reliably • Revenue should be recognised only to the extent of contract costs incurred that it is probable will be recoverable. • Contract costs should be recognised as an expense in the period in which they are incurred. An expected loss on such a construction contract should be recognised as an expense immediately. Test your understanding 2 The following information relates to a construction contract: Estimated contract revenue Costs to date Estimated costs to complete Estimated stage of completion $800,000 $320,000 $280,000 60% (a) What amounts of revenue, costs and profit should be recognised in the income statement? (b) Take the same contract but now assume that the business is not able to reliably estimate the outcome of the contract although it is believed that all costs incurred will be recoverable from the customer. What amounts should be recognised for revenue, costs and profit in the income statement? Expandable text ­ Reliable estimate of contract outcome 172 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 11 Summary of recognition rules Expandable text Determining the stage of completion of a contract IAS 11 indicates several ways in which the percentage of completion of a contract may be arrived at: • the proportion that contract costs incurred for work performed to date bear to the estimated total contract costs (Costs to date/ Total costs) × 100% = % complete • surveys of work performed (Work certified/Contract price) × 100% = % complete • completion of a physical proportion of the contract work (given as a percentage). Presentation in financial statements Income statement The following will appear in the income statement for construction contracts: • • • revenue costs profit or loss. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 173 Inventories and construction contracts Calculated according to the rules given above. Statement of financial position The following figures may appear in the statement of financial position: • • gross amount due from customers – asset gross amount due to customers – liability. The calculation (which may result in an asset or liability) is: $ X X (X) (X) ––– X –––– Costs incurred Add: recognised profit Less: recognised losses Less: progress billings Gross amounts due to/from customers Expandable text ­ Asset and Liability Expandable text ­ Disclosure requirements Illustration 1 – IAS 11 Construction contracts Softfloor House Limited make café bars. The projects generally take a number of months to complete. The company has three contracts in progress at the year ended 30 April. A B C $000 $000 $000 Costs incurred to date 200 90 600 Costs to complete 200 110 200 Contract price 600 300 750 40 70 630 Progress billings Softfloor calculates the percentage of completion by using the costs incurred compared to the total costs. 174 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 11 Calculate the effects of the above contracts upon the financial statements. Expandable text ­ Solution Test your understanding 3 Hardfloor House fits out nightclubs. The projects generally take a number of months to complete. The company has three contracts in progress at the year ended 30 April: Costs incurred to date Costs to complete Contract price Work certified to date Received J $000 320 40 416 312 250 K $000 540 90 684 456 350 L $000 260 120 300 200 230 Hardfloor accrues profit on its construction contracts using the percentage of completion derived from the sales earned as work certified compared to the total sales value. Calculate the effects of the above contracts upon the financial statements. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 175 Inventories and construction contracts Chapter summary 176 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 11 Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 (a) Value at $12,000. $10,000 is irrelevant. The rule is lower of cost or NRV, not lower of cost or replacement cost. Since the special order is known to be profitable, the NRV will be above cost. (b) Value at NRV, i.e. $15,900, as this is below cost (NRV = contract price, $18,000 – company’s share of modification cost, $2,100). Test your understanding 2 (a) Revenue ($800,000 × 60%) Costs ((320,000 + 280,000) × 60%) Profit (b) Revenue (same as costs ) Costs Profit KAPLAN PUBLISHING $480,000 $360,000 ––––– $120,000 $320,000 $320,000 ––––– Nil 177 Inventories and construction contracts Test your understanding 3 (1) Total profit Revenue Total costs Total profit J $000 416 (360) –––– 56 –––– (2) Attributable profit Contract % complete calculated as: Work certified –––––––––––––– Contract price J 312/416 = 75% K 456/684 = 66.67% L 200/300 = 66.67% 3. L $000 300 (380) –––– (80) –––– Profit/loss 75% × $56,000 = $42,000 66.67% × $54,000 = $36,000 Recognise loss in full, i.e. $80,000 Income statement Sales (work certified) Costs (balancing figure) Gross profit 178 K $000 684 (630) –––– 54 –––– A B C Total $000 $000 $000 $000 312 456 200 968 (270) (420) (280) (970) –––– –––– –––– –––– 42 36 (80) (2) –––– –––– –––– –––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 11 4. Statement of financial position Costs incurred Profits recognised Loss recognised Less: progress payments Balance Total asset (112 + 226): Total liability: A B C $000 $000 $000 320 540 260 42 36 – – – (80) (250) (350) (230) –––– –––– –––– 112 226 (50) $338,000 $50,000 Total asset: $338,000 Total liability: $50,000 KAPLAN PUBLISHING 179 Inventories and construction contracts 180 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 12 Financial assets and financial liabilities Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • explain the need for an accounting standard on financial instruments • define financial instruments in terms of financial assets and financial liabilities • • distinguish between the four categories of financial instruments • explain how held­to­maturity financial assets should be measured and how any gains/losses from subsequent measurement should be treated in the financial statements • explain how available­for­sale financial assets should be measured and how any gains/losses from subsequent measurement should be treated in the financial statements • explain how loans and receivables should be measured and how any gains/losses from subsequent measurement should be treated in the financial statements • • distinguish between debt and equity capital • account for the issue of redeemable preference shares and payment of preference share dividends • account for the issue of debt instruments with no conversion rights and the payment of interest. explain how fair value through profit and loss financial instruments should be measured and how any gains/losses from subsequent measurement should be treated in the financial statements account for the issue of equity shares and the payment of equity dividends 181 Financial assets and financial liabilities 1 Financial instruments Introduction A financial instrument is any contract that gives rise to a financial asset of one entity and a financial liability or equity instrument of another entity. Expandable text ­ Need for accounting standards Financial assets A financial asset is any asset that is: • • cash • a contractual right to exchange financial assets/liabilities with another entity under conditions that are potentially favourable • • a contract that will or may be settled in the entity’s own equity instrument a contractual right to receive cash or another financial asset from another entity an equity instrument of another entity. Examples of financial assets include: • • • 182 trade receivables options investment in equity shares. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 12 Financial liabilities A financial liability is any liability that is a contractual obligation: • • to deliver cash or another financial asset to another entity, or • that will or may be settled in the entity’s own equity instruments. to exchange financial assets/liabilities with another entity under conditions that are potentially unfavourable, or Examples of financial liabilities include: • • • trade payables debenture loans redeemable preference shares. Test your understanding 1 Identify which of the following are financial instruments: (a) inventories (b) investment in ordinary shares (c) prepayments for goods or services (d) liability for income taxes (e) a share option (an entity’s obligation to issue its own shares). Expandable text ­ Classification, recognition and derecognition Expandable text ­ Fair value through profit or loss financial Expandable text ­ Held­to­maturity financial assets Expandable text ­ Available­for­sale financial assets Expandable text ­ Loans and receivables KAPLAN PUBLISHING 183 Financial assets and financial liabilities Test your understanding 2 (1) A company invests $5,000 in 10% debentures. The debentures are repayable at a premium after 3 years. The effective rate of interest is 12%. What amounts will be shown in the income statement and Statement of Financial Position for the financial asset for years 1­3? (2) A company invested in 10,000 shares of a listed company in November 2007 at a cost of $4.20 per share. At 31 December 2007 the shares have a market value of $4.90. The company are planning on selling these shares in April 2008. Prepare extracts from the income statement for the year ended 31 December 2007 and a Statement of Financial Position as at that date. (3) A company invested in 20,000 shares of a listed company in October 2007 at a cost of $3.80 per share. At 31 December 2007 the shares have a market value of $3.40. The company are not planning on selling these shares in the short term. Prepare extracts from the income statement for the year ended 31 December 2007 and a Statement of Financial Position as at that date. Expandable text ­ Impairment of financial assets Expandable text ­ Measurement of financial liabilities Test your understanding 3 (1) A company issues 5% loan notes at their nominal value of $20,000. The loan notes are repayable at par after 4 years. What amount will be recorded as a financial liability when the loan notes are issued? What amounts will be shown in the income statement and Statement of Financial Position for years 1 ­4? 184 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 12 (2) A company issues 0% loan notes at their nominal value of $40,000. The loan notes are repayable at a premium of $11,800 after 3 years. The effective rate of interest is 9%. What amount will be recorded as a financial liability when the loan notes are issued? What amounts will be shown in the income statement and Statement of Financial Position for years 1­3? (3) A company issues 5% redeemable preference shares at their nominal value of $10,000. The shares are redeemable at a premium of $1,760 after 5 years. The effective rate of interest is 8%. What amounts will be shown in the income statement and Statement of Financial Position for years 1­5? (4) A company issues 4% loan notes with a nominal value of $20,000. The loan notes are issued at a discount of 2.5% and $534 of issue costs are incurred. The loan notes will be repayable at a premium of 10% after 5 years. The effective rate of interest is 7%. What amount will be recorded as a financial liability when the loan notes are issued? What amounts will be shown in the income statement and Statement of Financial Position for years 1­5? (5) A company issues 3% bonds with a nominal value of $150,000. The loan notes are issued at a discount of 10% and issue costs of $11,455 are incurred. The loan notes will be repayable at a premium of $10,000 after 4 years. The effective rate of interest is 10%. What amount will be recorded as a financial liability when the loan notes are issued? What amounts will be shown in the income statement and Statement of Financial Position for years 1­4? Exandable text ­ Illustration: Measurement of financial liabilities KAPLAN PUBLISHING 185 Financial assets and financial liabilities 2 Equity and liabilities Introduction IAS 32 requires the classification of a financial liability, or its component parts, as a liability or as equity according to the substance of the contractual arrangement. An equity instrument is any contract that evidences a residual interest in the assets of an entity after deducting all of its liabilities. Expandable text ­ Classification as liability or equity Compound instruments A compound instrument is one which has both a liability and an equity component. For example, a convertible bond: • the value of a convertible bond consists of a liability component – the bond – and • an equity component – the value of the right to convert in due course to equity. The two elements must be separately recognised in the statement of financial position: • • the liability element the equity element. The economic effect of issuing convertible bonds is substantially the same as the simultaneous issue of a debt instrument with an early settlement provision and warrants to purchase shares. 186 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 12 Illustration 1 – Equity and liabilities Compound instruments Convert issues a convertible loan that attracts interest of 2%. The market rate is 8%, being the interest rate for an equivalent debt without the conversion option. The loan of $5 million is repayable in full after three years or convertible to equity. Discount factors are as follows: Year 1 2 3 Discount factor at 8% 0.923 0.857 0.794 Required: Split the loan between debt and equity at inception and calculate the finance change for each year until conversion/redemption. Test your understanding 4 (1) A company issues 2% convertible bonds at their nominal value of $36,000. The bonds are convertible at any time up to maturity into 120 ordinary shares for each $100 of bond. Alternatively the bonds will be redeemed at par after 3 years. Similar non­convertible bonds would carry an interest rate of 9%. The present value of $1 payable at the end of year, based on rates of 2% and 9% are as follows: End of year 1 2 3 2% 0.98 0.96 0.94 9% 0.92 0.84 0.77 What amounts will be shown as a financial liability and as equity when the convertible bonds are issued? What amounts will be shown in the income statement and Statement of Financial Position for years 1­3? KAPLAN PUBLISHING 187 Financial assets and financial liabilities (2) A company issues 4% convertible bonds at their nominal value of $5 million. Each bond is convertible at any time up to maturity into 400 ordinary shares. Alternatively the bonds will be redeemed at par after 3 years. The market rate applicable to non­convertible bonds is 6%. The present value of $1 payable at the end of year, based on rates of 4% and 6% are as follows: End of year 1 2 3 4% 0.96 0.92 0.89 6% 0.94 0.89 0.84 What amounts will be shown as a financial liability and as equity when the convertible bonds are issued? What amounts will be shown in the income statement and Statement of Financial Position for years 1­3? Expandable text ­ Solution Exandable text ­ Further illustration Preference shares If preference shares are irredeemable: • they are classified as equity. If preference shares are redeemable: • 188 they are classified as a financial liability. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 12 Test your understanding 5 On 1 October 20X4, a company issued 50,000 redeemable preference shares with a par value of $100 each to investors at $55. The shares are redeemable at par on 30 September 20X9 and have a coupon rate of 2%. The effective rate of interest is 15.62%. How would these redeemable preference shares appear in the financial statements for the years ending 30 September 20X5 and 30 September 20X6? Expandable text Test your understanding 6 Why are redeemable preference shares treated as liabilities? Expandable text ­ Preference share dividends Interest and dividends The accounting treatment of interest and dividends depends upon the accounting treatment of the underlying instrument itself: • • equity dividends declared are reported directly in equity dividends on redeemable preference shares classified as a liability are an expense in the income statement. Offsetting financial assets and financial liabilities In common with all IFRS rules on offsetting, a financial asset and a financial liability may only be offset in very limited circumstances. The net amount may only be presented in the statement of financial position when the entity: • • has a legally enforceable right to set off the amounts, and intends either to settle on a net basis or to realise the asset and settle the liability simultaneously. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 189 Financial assets and financial liabilities Chapter summary 190 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 12 Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 (a) Inventory (or any other physical asset such as non­current assets) is not a financial instrument since there is no present contractual right to receive cash or other financial instruments. (b) An investment in ordinary shares is a financial asset since it is an equity instrument of another entity. (c) Prepayments for goods or services are not financial instruments since the future economic benefit will be the receipt of goods or services rather than a financial asset. (d) A liability for income taxes is not a financial instrument since the obligation is statutory rather than contractual. (e) A share option is a financial instrument since a contractual obligation does exist to deliver an equity instrument. Note, however, that an option to buy or sell an asset other than a financial instrument (e.g. a commodity) would not qualify as a financial instrument. Test your understanding 2 (1) When the loan notes are issued: Dr Bank $20,000 Cr Loan $20,000 notes Income statement Finance costs 1 2 3 4 (1,000) (1,000) (1,000) (1,000) Statement of Financial Position Non­current liabilities Current liabilities KAPLAN PUBLISHING 1 2 20,000 20,000 3 4 20,000 0 191 Financial assets and financial liabilities Workings Year 1 2 3 4 Opening 20,000 20,000 20,000 20,000 Finance costs 5% 1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000 Cash paid 5% (1,000) (1,000) (1,000) (1,000) (20,000)* Closing 20,000 20,000 20,000 0 *The loan notes are repaid at par i.e $20,000 at the end of year 4 (2) When the loan notes are issued: Dr $40,000 Bank Cr Loan $40,000 notes Income Statement Finance Costs 1 2 3 (3,600) (3,924) (4,276) Statement of Financial Position Non­current liabilities Current liabilities 1 43,600 2 3 47,524 0 Workings Year 1 2 3 Opening 40,000 43,600 47,524 Finance costs 9% 3,600 3,924 4,276 Cash paid 0% (0) (0) (0) (51,800) Closing 43,600 47,524 0 The loan notes are repaid at par i.e. $40,000, plus a premium of $11,800 at the end of year 3 192 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 12 (3) Finance costs 1 2 3 4 5 (800) (824) (850) (878) (908) Statement of Financial Position 1 10,300 Non­current liabilities Current liabilities 2 10,624 3 10,974 4 5 11.352 0 Workings Year 1 2 3 4 5 Opening 10,000 10,300 10,624 10,974 11,352 Finance costs 8% 800 824 850 878 908 Cash paid 5% (500) (500) (500) (500) (500) (11,760) Closing 10.300 10,624 10,974 11,352 0 (4) When the loan notes are issued: Dr Bank $18,966 Cr loan notes $18,966 Working Nominal value Discount 2.5% Issue costs 20,000 (500) (534) _____ 18,966 Income statement Finance cost KAPLAN PUBLISHING 1 (1,328) 2 (1,365) 3 (1,404) 4 1,446) 5 (1,491) 193 Financial assets and financial liabilities Statement of Financial Position 1 19,494 Non­current liabilities Current liabilities 2 20,059 3 20,663 4 5 21,309 0 Workings Year 1 2 3 4 5 Opening 18,966 19,494 20,059 20,663 21,309 Finance costs 7% 1,328 1,365 1,404 1,446 1,491 Cash paid 4% (800) (800) (800) (800) (800) (22,000) Closing 19,494 20,059 20,663 21,309 0 (5) When the loan notes are issued: Dr $123,545 Bank Cr $123,545 Loan notes Working Nominal value 10% discount Issue costs 150,000 (15,000) (11,455) _______ 123,545 Income statement Finance costs 194 1 (12,355) 2 (13,140) 3 (14,004) 4 (14,956) KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 12 Statement of Financial Position 1 131,400 Non­current liabilities Current liabilities 2 140,040 3 4 149,544 0 Workings Year 1 2 3 4 Opening 123,545 131,400 140,040 149,544 Finance costs 10% 12,355 13,140 14,004 14,956 Cash paid 3% (4,500) (4,500) (4,500) (4,500) (160,000) Closing 131,400 140,040 149,544 0 Test your understanding 3 (1) When the convertible bonds are issed: Dr Bank $36,000 Cr Financial Liability $29,542 Cr Equity $6,458 Year 1 2 3 Cash flow 720 720 36,720 Discount factor 9% 0.92 0.84 0.77 Present value 662.4 604.8 28,274.4 _________ 29,541.6 _________ cash flow= 2% x 36,000 = 720 Income Statement Finance costs KAPLAN PUBLISHING 1 (2,659) 2 (2,833) 3 (3,023) 195 Financial assets and financial liabilities Statement of Financial Position Equity Equity option Non­current liabilities Current liabilities 1 2 3 6,458 31,481 6,458 6,458 33,594 0 Workings Year 1 2 3 Opening 29,542 31,481 33,594 Finance costs 9% 2,659 2,833 3,023 Cash paid 2% (720) (720) (720) (36,000) Closing 31,481 33,594 0 (2) When the convertible bonds are issued: Dr Bank $5,000,000 Cr Financial Liability $4,734,000 Cr Equity $266,000 Year 1 2 3 Cash flow 200,000 200,000 5,200,000 Discount factor 0.94 0.89 0.84 Present Value 188,000 178,000 4,368,000 __________ 4,734,000 __________ Cash flow = 4% x 5,000,000 = $200,000 Income statement Finance costs 196 1 (284,040) 2 (289,082) 3 (294,428) KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 12 Statement of Financial Position Equity Equity option Non­current liabilities Current liabilities 1 2 3 266,000 4,818,040 266,000 266,000 4,907,122 0 Workings Year Opening 1 4,734,000 2 4,818,040 3 4,907,122 Finance costs 6% 284,040 289,082 294,428 Cash paid 4% (200,000) (200,000) (200,000) (5,000,000) Closing 4,818,040 4,907,122 0 Test your understanding 4 (1) Assumed Held to maturity Investment Income 1 600 2 612 3 625 Statement of Financial Position 1 2 3 5,100 5,212 0 Non­current assests Investments Working Year 1 2 3 KAPLAN PUBLISHING Opening Investment Income 12% Cash received 10% Closing 5,000 600 (500) 5,100 5,100 612 (500) 5,212 5,212 625 (500) (5,837) 0 197 Financial assets and financial liabilities (2) This is a fair value through profit or loss asset as it is held for sale in the short term. It must therefore be revalued at the year end with changes in value being recognised in the income statement. Income statement Investment Income (10,000 × (4.90­4.20)) 7,000 Statement of Financial Position Current Assets Investments (10,000 × 4.90) 49,000 (3) This is an available for sale investment. It cannot be classified as held to maturity or loans and receivables as it does not have fixed or determinable payments. Income statement Investment Income 0 Statement of Financial Position Non­current Assets Investments (20,000 × 3.40) Equity Retained earnings (b/f–8,000 + PAT – Div's 198 68,000 X KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 12 There is a loss of $8,000 on the shares i.e. 20,000 × (3.80–3.40). This will be recorded within reserves. Test your understanding 5 Proceeds of issue = 50,000 × $55 Annual payment Period ended 30 Sept 20X5 20X6 = $2,750,000 = 50,000 × $100 × 2% = $100,000 Opening Finance costs Cash paid Closing balance @ 15.62% @ 2% balance $000 $000 $000 $000 2,750 430 (100) 3,080 3,080 481 (100) 3,461 Year ended 30 September 20X5: SFP liability value for preference shares $3,080,000 Interest charged in income statement $430,000 Year ended 30 September 20X6: SFP liability value for preference shares $3,461,000 Interest charged in income statement $481,000 Test your understanding 6 When a preference share provides for mandatory redemption by the issuer for a fixed or determinable amount at a fixed or determinable future date, or gives the holder the right to require the issuer to redeem the share at or after a particular date for a fixed or determinable amount, the instrument meets the definition of a financial liability and is classified as such. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 199 Financial assets and financial liabilities 200 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 13 Leases Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • explain why recording the legal form of a finance lease can be misleading to users making reference to the commercial substance of such leases • • define a finance lease and an operating lease • • • account for finance lease assets in the records of the lessee determine whether a lease is a finance lease or an operating lease account for operating lease assets in the records of the lessee explain the effect on the financial statements of a finance lease being incorrectly treated as an operating lease. 201 Leases 1 Finance leases and operating leases What is a leasing agreement? A leasing agreement is an agreement whereby one party, the lessee, pays lease rentals to another party, the lessor in order to gain the use of an asset over a period of time. IAS 17 Leases defines a lease as an agreement whereby the lessor conveys to the lessee, in return for a payment or series of payments, the right to use an asset for an agreed period of time. Types of lease There are two types of lease: • • 202 a finance lease an operating lease. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 13 A finance lease is a lease that transfers substantially all the risks and rewards incidental to ownership of an asset to the lessee. An operating lease is any lease other than a finance lease. Classification of leases To decide whether a lease is finance or operating, the first step is to assess whether the risks and rewards of ownership have transferred to the lessee. If this is inconclusive, IAS 17 provides additional guidance. Risks and rewards Risks and rewards of ownership include: Risks • lessee carries out repairs and maintenance • • lessee insures asset • lessee runs the risk of technological obsolescence Rewards • lessee has right to use asset for most or all of its useful life lessee runs the risk of losses from idle capacity IAS 17 guidance IAS 17 provides guidance as to the classification of leases as finance leases or operating leases. It gives the following list of situations in which a lease would normally be classified as a finance lease: • The lease transfers ownership of the asset to the lessee by the end of the lease term (thus hire­purchase transactions qualify). • The lessee has the option to buy the asset at a price expected to be lower than fair value at the time the option is exercised. • The lease term is for the major part of the economic life of the asset even if title is not transferred. • At the beginning of the lease, the present value of the minimum lease payments is approximately equal to the fair value of the asset. • The leased assets are of a specialised nature so that only the lessee can use them without major modification. • If the lease gives the lessee the right to cancel the lease, the lessor’s losses associated with the cancellation are borne by the lessee. • Gains or losses from fluctuations in fair value are borne by the lessee. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 203 Leases • The lessee has the ability to continue the lease for a secondary period at a rent below the market rent. Test your understanding 1 A company has entered into a four­year lease for a machine, with lease rentals of $150,000 payable annually in advance, and with an optional secondary period of three years at rentals of 80%, 60% and 40% of the annual rental in the primary period. It is agreed that these rentals represent a fair commercial rate. The machine has a useful life of eight years and a cash value of $600,000. Would this lease agreement be a finance lease or an operating lease? 2 Substance over form The meaning of substance over form In many types of transactions there is a difference between the commercial substance and the legal form: • • Commercial substance reflects the financial reality of the transaction. Legal form is the legal reality of the transaction. Accounts are generally required to reflect commercial substance rather than legal form. Expandable text ­ Substance over form Accounting treatment of the commercial substance of a lease As the commercial substance of finance leases is that the lessee is the effective owner of the asset the required accounting treatment is to: • record the asset as a non­current asset in the lessee’s statement of financial position • record a liability for the lease payments payable to the lessor. Expandable text ­ Leases and the definition of an asset 204 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 13 3 Accounting for finance leases Initial recording At the start of the lease: • the fair value (or, if lower, the present value of the MLPs) should be included as a non­current asset, subject to depreciation • the same amount (being the obligation to pay rentals) should be included as a loan, i.e. a liability. In practice, the fair value of the asset or its cash price will often be a sufficiently close approximation to the present value of the MLPs and therefore can be used instead. Depreciation The non­current asset should be depreciated over the shorter of: • • the useful life of the asset (as in IAS 16) the lease term. The lease term is essentially the period over which the lessee has the use of the asset. It includes: • • the primary (non­cancellable) period any secondary periods during which the lessee has the option to continue to lease the asset, provided that it is reasonably certain at the outset that this option will be exercised. Payment of rentals and allocation of finance charge Each individual rental payment should be split between: • • finance charge (an expense in the income statement) repayment of obligation to pay rentals (a reduction in the liability). The finance charge should be allocated to each accounting period so as to produce a constant periodic rate of interest on the remaining balance of the liability. There are two main methods of allocating the finance charge each period: • • actuarial method sum of the digits method. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 205 Leases The examiner has confirmed that he will not examiner the sum of digits method of allocating the finance charge. Therefore we will concentrate on the actuarial method. Firstly, however, for simplicity and illustration purposes, the following example assumes that the finance charge is allocated on a straight line. This method is not acceptable within the examination or in practice unless amounts are immaterial. Illustration 1 ­ Accounting for finance leases Payment of rentals and allocation of finance charge An entity leases an asset with three annual payments in arrears of $200 each. The fair value of the asset is $450. The asset has a useful life of three years. In this simple example the finance charge is to be allocated on the straight­line basis. Solution $ 600 (450) –––– 150 Lease payments (3 × $200) Fair value Total finance charge On the straight­line basis this will be allocated to the income statement at $50 ($150/3 years) pa. The payables balance for the lease can be calculated using a standard table: Year 1 2 3 206 Balance b/f $ 450 300 150 Interest $ 50 50 50 Cash $ (200) (200) (200) Balance c/f $ 300 150 0 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 13 The financial statements at the end of year 1 will show the following amounts: Income statement Finance charge Depreciation (450/3 years) Statement of financial position Non­current asset (450 – 150) Current liabilities: payable (200 – 50) Non­current liabilities: payables $ 50 150 300 150 150 At the end of year one, the payable table shows a carried forward balance of $300. This must be split between a current and non­current amount. The easiest way to do this is to: (1) identify the non­current liability as being the figure immediately after the last repayment of the following year (in this case $150) (2) calculate the current liability as being the total liability less the non­ current liability. This method of splitting the liability will work whether payments are made in advance or arrears. The actuarial method The actuarial method allocates interest to each period: • • at a constant rate on the outstanding amount using the interest rate implicit in the lease (you will be given this figure). Illustration 2 – Accounting for finance leases Actuarial method of allocating finance charge A company has two options. It can buy an asset for cash at a cost of $5,710 or it can lease it by way of a finance lease. The terms of the lease are as follows. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 207 Leases (1) Primary period is for four years from 1 January 20X2 with a rental of $2,000 pa payable on 31 December each year. (2) The lessee has the right to continue to lease the asset after the end of the primary period for an indefinite period, subject only to a nominal rent. (3) The lessee is required to pay all repair, maintenance and insurance costs as they arise. (4) The interest rate implicit in the lease is 15%. The lessee estimates the useful life of the asset to be eight years. Depreciation is provided on a straight­line basis. What figures will be shown in the financial statements in each of the years ended 31 December 20X2­20X9 assuming the finance lease option is taken. Expandable text ­ Solution Test your understanding 2 P Limited entered into a four­year lease on 1 January 20X3 for a machine with a fair value of $69,738. Rentals are $20,000 pa payable in advance. P Limited is responsible for insurance and maintenance costs. The rate of interest implicit in the lease is 10%. Show the allocation of the finance charges over the lease term on an actuarial basis and calculate the non­current liability for finance leases at 31 December 20X3. Summary of accounting entries (1) At the inception of the lease: Dr Non­current assets: Cost Cr Lease payable with the present value of the minimum lease payments/fair value of the leased asset. (2) At the end of each period of the lease: Dr Depreciation expense (income statement) 208 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 13 Cr Non­current assets: accumulated depreciation with the depreciation charge for the period. (3) As each rental is paid: Dr Lease creditor Cr Cash with the rental paid. Dr Interest expense (income statement) Cr Lease creditor with the finance charge. Expandable text ­ Disclosure: finance leases Test your understanding 3 On 1 January 20X7 Jones plc acquired the use of a major piece of heavy agricultural plant, the Vinnie, under a finance lease. The machinery has a useful life of eight years with nil residual value. The cost of the Vinnie would be $600,000 if it were bought for cash. The lease term for the Vinnie is an eight years, with lease rentals of $110,000 payable annually in advance. The interest rate implicit in the lease is 12.8%. Show the amounts to be included in the statement of financial position of Jones Ltd at 31 December 20X7 and the amounts to appear in the income statement for that year. 4 Accounting for operating leases Accounting treatment Operating lease assets are very different in nature from finance lease assets as the risks and rewards of ownership are not transferred to the lessee. Therefore the accounting treatment is also very different. • An asset is not recognised in the statement of financial position. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 209 Leases • Instead, rentals under operating leases are charged to the income statement on a straight­line basis over the term of the lease, unless another systematic and rational basis is more appropriate. • Any difference between amounts charged and amounts paid will be prepayments or accruals. Test your understanding 4 A company is leasing an asset under an operating lease. The initial deposit is $1,000 on 1 January of year 1 followed by 3 annual payments in arrears of $1,000 each on 31 December of years 1, 2 and 3. What is the charge to the income statement and any amount to appear in the statement of financial position at the end of year 1 of the lease? Expandable text ­ Disclosure: operating leases 5 Finance lease or operating lease? Significance The significance of the accounting treatment of leased assets is heightened by the difference between the accounting treatment of finance leases and that of operating leases: Finance lease Operating lease Asset capitalised No asset Liability recognised No liability Finance charge Full rental charge Depreciation charge No depreciation Finance lease treated as an operating lease If a finance lease asset is incorrectly treated as an operating lease it will have the following effects on the financial statements: • • • 210 assets understated and so ROCE overstated liabilities understated and so gearing understated little effect on income statement. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 13 Expandable text ­ Effect of incorrect classification Test your understanding 5 Wrighty acquired use of plant over three years by way of a lease. Instalments of $700,000, are paid six­monthly in arrears on 30 June and 31 December. Delivery of the plant was on 1 January 20X0 so the first payment of $700,000 was on 30 June 20X0. The present value of minimum lease payment is $3,000,000. The interest implicit in the above is 10% per six months. The plant would normally be expected to last three years. Wrighty is required to insure the plant and cannot return it to the lessor without severe penalties. (a) Describe whether the above lease should be classified as an operating or finance lease. (b) Calculate the effect of the above on the income statement and statement of financial position for the year ended 31 December 20X0. (c) Why might Wrighty deliberately choose to report the lease as an operating lease? KAPLAN PUBLISHING 211 Leases Chapter summary 212 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 13 Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 The contracted lease term is only for half of the useful life of the machine and there is no strong likelihood that the company will exercise the option in four years' time, because the option is priced at fair value, not a discount. Thus the risks and rewards of ownership have not passed to the lessee and this lease should be treated as an operating lease. Test your understanding 2 Year 20X3 20X4 20X5 20X6 Capital b/f $ 69,738 54,712 38,183 20,000 Lease Capital Finance Capital at payment outstanding charge at year end 10% $ $ $ $ (20,000) 49,738 4,974 54,712 (20,000) 34,712 3,471 38,183 (20,000) 18,183 1,818 20,000 (20,000) – – – Non­current liability at 31 December 20X3 Amounts due under finance lease (54,712 – 20,000) KAPLAN PUBLISHING $ 34,712 213 Leases Test your understanding 3 Statement of financial position $ Non­current assets Leased property under finance leases: Cost Depreciation 600,000 ÷ 8 Current liabilities Current obligations under finance leases (W) Non­current liabilities Non­current obligation under finance leases (W) Income statement Depreciation on plant held under finance leases Finance charges on finance leases (W) 600,000 75,000 110,000 442,720 75,000 62,720 Workings Lease table Year Capital b/f $ 20X7 600,000 20X8 552,720 Lease payment Capital outstanding $ (110,000) (110,000) $ 490,000 442,720 Finance charge at 12.8% $ 62,720 56,668 Capital at year end $ 552,720 499,388 For leases with annual payments in advance the current liability is the full amount of the next payment due and the non­current liability is the remainder of the capital at the year end. Test your understanding 4 Income statement Statement of financial position 214 = $1,333 ($4,000/3 years) = Payment $2,000 – charge $1,333 = Prepayment of $667 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 13 Test your understanding 5 (a) Risks and rewards of ownership of the machine are with Wrighty, therefore this is a finance lease. (b) Period Capitalb/f Interest (10%) Payment Capital c/f $000 $000 $000 $000 1 3,000 300 (700) 2,600 2 2,600 260 (700) 2,160 3 2,160 216 (700) 1,676 4 1,676 168 (700) 1,144 Income statement for year ended 31 December 20X0 $000 Depreciation (1/3 × $3m) 1,000 Finance charge (300 + 260) $560 Statement of financial position at 31 December 20X0 $000 Non­current assets (2/3 × $3m) 2,000 Current liabilities Obligations under finance leases (2,160 – 1,144) 1,016 Non­current liabilities Obligations under finance leases 1,144 (c) In order to avoid showing the liability within the financial statements and so achieve ‘off balance sheet finance’. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 215 Leases 216 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 14 Substance over form Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • explain and demonstrate the importance of recording the commercial substance rather than the legal form of transactions • • list examples of previous abuses in this area • apply the principle of substance over form to recognition and derecognition of assets and liabilities • • • • • account for goods sold on sale or return/consignment stock describe the features which may indicate that the substance of transactions differs from their legal form account for sale and repurchase account for sale and leaseback account for factoring of receivables demonstrate the role of the principle of substance over form for recognising sales revenue. 217 Substance over form 1 Reporting the substance of transactions Introduction IAS 1 requires that financial statements: • • must represent faithfully the transactions that have been carried out must reflect the economic substance of events and transactions and not merely their legal form. Examples of accounts reflecting economic or commercial substance which we have already met are: • • the production of consolidated accounts (chapter 4) the capitalisation of a finance lease (chapter 13). Expandable text ­ The historical problem Expandable Text ­ Illustration 218 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 14 Determining the substance of a transaction Common features of transactions whose substance is not readily apparent are: • the legal title to an asset may be separated from the principal benefits and risks associated with the asset (such as is the case with finance leases) • a transaction may be linked with other transactions which means that the commercial effect of the individual transaction cannot be understood without an understanding of all of the transactions • options may be included in a transaction where the terms of the option make it highly likely that the option will be exercised. Identifying assets and liabilities Key to determining the substance of a transaction is to identify whether assets and liabilities arise subsequent to that transaction by considering: • • who enjoys the benefits of any asset who is exposed to the principal risks of any asset. Assets are defined in the Framework as resources controlled by the entity as a result of past events and from which future economic benefits are expected to flow to the entity. Liabilities are defined in the Framework as present obligations of the entity arising from past events, the settlement of which is expected to result in an outflow of resources from the entity. Expandable text Recognition and derecognition of assets and liabilities Assets and liabilities should be recognised in the statement of financial position where: • it is probable that any future economic benefit associated with the item will flow to or from the entity, and • the item has a cost or value that can be measured with reliability. When either of these criteria are not met the item should be derecognised. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 219 Substance over form Disclosure Disclosure of a transaction should be sufficiently detailed to enable the user of the financial statements to evaluate the financial position, performance and changes in financial position of the entity. Expandable text 2 Examples where substance and form may differ Introduction Examples of areas where substance and form may differ include: • • • • consignment inventory and goods on sale­or­return sale and repurchase agreements sale and leaseback agreements factoring of receivables. Consignment inventory Consignment inventory is inventory which: • • is legally owned by one party is held by another party, on terms which give the holder the right to sell the inventory in the normal course of business or, at the holder’s option, to return it to the legal owner. This type of arrangement is common in the motor trade. Accounting for consignment inventory 220 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 14 Key question: In which company’s statement of financial position should the car appear as inventory between 1 May 20X9 and 30 June 20X9? Factors to consider are: • • Who bears the risks of the inventory? Who has the benefits or rewards of the inventory? Whoever bears the risks of the inventory should recognise it in the statement of financial position. Expandable text Expandable Text­ Illustration: Consignment inventory Test your understanding 1 Carmart, a car dealer, obtains stock from Zippy, its manufacturer, on a consignment basis. The purchase price is set at delivery and is calculated to include an element of finance. Usually, Carmart pays Zippy for the car the day after Carmart sells to a customer. However, if the car remains unsold after six months then Carmart is obliged to purchase the car. There is no right of return. Further, Carmart is responsible for insurance and maintenance from delivery. Describe how Carmart should account for the above transactions. Sale and repurchase agreements Introduction Sale and repurchase agreements are situations where an asset is sold by one party to another. The terms of the sale provide for the seller to repurchase the asset in certain circumstances at some point in the future. Sale and repurchase agreements are common in property developments and in maturing whisky stocks. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 221 Substance over form Accounting for sale and repurchase agreements Key question: Is the commercial effect of the transaction that of a sale or of a secured loan? Factors to consider, whether • the seller will secure access to all future benefits inherent in the asset, often through call options (a right to buy). • the buyer will secure adequate return on the purchase and appropriate protection against loss in value of the asset bought, often through put options (a right to sell). Expandable text Exandable text ­ Illustration: Sale and repurchase Test your understanding 2 Xavier sells its head office, which cost $10 million, to Yorrick, a bank, for $10 million on 1 January. Xavier has the option to repurchase the property on 31 December, four years later at $12 million. Xavier will continue to use the property as normal throughout the period and so is responsible for the maintenance and insurance. The head office was valued at transfer on 1 January at $18 million and is expected to rise in value throughout the four­year period. Giving reasons, show how Xavier should record the above during the first year following transfer. 222 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 14 Sale and leaseback Introduction A sale and repurchase agreement can be in the form of a sale and leaseback. The agreement may be: • • a sale and finance leaseback a sale and operating leaseback. Accounting for sale and leaseback Sale and finance leaseback: • • no sale is recorded the forwarded funds are treated as a loan secured on the leased asset. Sale and operating leaseback: • a sale is normally recorded. Expandable text Exandable text ­ Illustration: Sale and leaseback Factoring of receivables Introduction Factoring of receivables is where a company transfers its receivables balances to another organisation (a factor) for management and collection and receives an advance on the value of those receivables in return. Accounting for the factoring of receivables Key question: Is the seller in substance receiving a loan on the security of his receivables, or are the receipts an actual sale of those receivable balances? KAPLAN PUBLISHING 223 Substance over form Factors to consider: • who bears the risk (of slow payment and irrecoverable debts). Expandable text Exandable text ­ Illustration: Factoring of receivables Test your understanding 3 An entity has an outstanding receivables balance with a major customer amounting to $12 million and this was factored to FinanceCo on 1 September 20X7. The terms of the factoring were: FinanceCo will pay 80% of the gross receivable outstanding account to the entity immediately. • The balance will be paid (less the charges below) when the debt is collected in full. Any amount of the debt outstanding after four months will be transferred back to the entity at its full book value. • FinanceCo will charge 1.0% per month of the net amount owing from the entity at the beginning of each month. FinanceCo had not collected any of the factored receivable amount by the year­end. • the entity debited the cash from FinanceCo to its bank account and removed the receivable from its accounts. It has prudently charged the difference as an administration cost. What are the correct accounting entries for this arrangement? 3 IAS 18 Revenue What is revenue? Revenue is the gross inflow of economic benefits during the period arising in the course of the ordinary activities of an entity. Revenue is measured by the fair value of the consideration received or receivable. Expandable text ­ Measurement of revenue 224 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 14 Traditional approaches to revenue recognition Traditionally, two conditions must be met before revenue can be recognised: • The revenue must be earned, i.e. the activities undertaken to create the revenue must be substantially completed. • The revenue must be realised, i.e. an event has occurred which significantly increases the likelihood of conversion into cash. This also means that the revenue must be capable of being verifiably measured. In most cases, realisation is deemed to occur on the date of sale. Thus, the date of the sale transaction is the moment that the revenue is recognised in the financial statements. Exandable text ­ Illustration: Traditional approach Revenue from the sale of goods According to IAS 18 Revenue, the following conditions must be satisfied before the revenue from the sale of goods should be recognised. • The seller has transferred the significant risks and rewards of ownership to the buyer. • The seller does not retain continuing managerial involvement to the degree usually associated with ownership and does not have effective control over the goods sold. • • The amount of revenue can be measured reliably. • The costs incurred or to be incurred in respect of the transaction can be measured reliably. It is probable that the economic benefits associated with the transaction will flow to the seller. Expandable text Revenue from services Revenue from services should be recognised, according to the stage of completion at the reporting date, when all the following conditions are met. • The amount of revenue can be measured reliably. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 225 Substance over form • It is probable that the economic benefits associated with the transaction will flow to the entity. • The stage of completion of the transaction at the reporting date can be measured reliably. • The costs incurred for the transaction and the costs to complete the transaction can be measured reliably. If these conditions are not met, revenue should be recognised only to the extent of the expenses recognised that are recoverable. Illustration 1 ­ Revenue from services Revenue from services On 1 July 20X3, Company A signs a contract with a customer under which Company A delivers an 'off­the­shelf' IT system on that date and then provides support services for the next three years. The contract price is $740,000. The cost of the support services is estimated at $60,000 pa and Company A normally makes a profit margin of 25% on such work. Company A makes up financial statements to 31 December each year. What revenue should be recognised in the financial statements for the year ended 31 December 20X3? Expandable text ­ Solution Test your understanding 4 A company is a retailer of washing machines. The company sells 100 washing machines for $500 each during the first week of the year. Each deal includes one year’s free credit, valued at $25 per machine and a three­year free parts warranty valued at $10 per machine per year. Describe how the above revenue would be recognised in the year of sale. 226 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 14 Chapter summary KAPLAN PUBLISHING 227 Substance over form Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 • Dealer faces the risk of slow movement as it is obliged to purchase the car and has no right of return. • • • Dealer insures and maintains the cars. Dealer faces risk of theft. Dealer can sell the cars to the public. Recognise the cars on dealer’s statement of financial position at delivery. Test your understanding 2 • • • • Xavier faces the risk of falling property prices. Xavier continues to insure and maintain the property. Xavier will benefit from a rising property price. Xavier has the benefit of use of the property. Xavier should continue to recognise the head office as an asset in the statement of financial position. This is a secured loan with effective interest of $2 million ($12 million – $10 million) over the four­year period. 228 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 14 Test your understanding 3 As the entity still bears the risk of slow payment and irrecoverable debts, the substance of the factoring is that of a loan on which finance charges will be made. The receivable should not have been derecognised nor should all of the difference between the gross receivable and the amount received from the factor have been treated as an administration cost. The required adjustments can be summarised as follows: Receivables Loan from factor Administration $(12,000 – 9,600) Finance costs: accrued interest ($9.6 million 1.0%) Accruals Dr Cr $000 $000 12,000 9,600 2,400 96 96 –––––– –––––– 12,096 12,096 –––––– –––––– Test your understanding 4 Washing machine revenue 100 × (500 – 30 – 25) Warranty revenue (100 × $10) Interest income (100 × $25) KAPLAN PUBLISHING $ 44,500 1,000 2,500 229 Substance over form 230 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 15 Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • • • • • • • • explain why an accounting standard on provisions is necessary • • • • identify and account for warranties/guarantees distinguish between legal and constructive obligations explain in what circumstances a provision may be made explain in what circumstances a provision may not be made show how provisions are accounted for explain how provisions should be measured define contingent liabilities and contingent assets explain the accounting treatment of contingent liabilities and contingent assets identify and account for onerous contracts identify and account for environmental and similar provisions identify and account for provisions for future repairs and refurbishments. 231 Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets 1 Provisions The problem Until the issue of IAS 37 Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets, there was no accounting standard covering the general topic of provisions. This led to various problems. • Provisions were often recognised as a result of an intention to make expenditure, rather than an obligation to do so. • Several items could be aggregated into one large provision that was reported as an exceptional item (the ‘big bath’). • Inadequate disclosure meant that in some cases it was difficult to ascertain the significance of the provisions and any movements in the year. Expandable Text ­ Illustration Expandable text ­ The historical problem of provisioning 232 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 15 Objective of IAS 37 The objective of IAS 37 Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets is to ensure that: • appropriate recognition criteria and measurement bases are applied to provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets • sufficient information is disclosed in the notes to the financial statements to enable users to understand their nature, timing and amount. What is a provision? A provision is a liability of uncertain timing or amount. A liability is a present obligation of the entity arising from past events, the settlement of which is expected to result in an outflow from the entity of resources embodying economic benefits. Recognition of a provision A provision should be recognised when: • an entity has a present obligation (legal or constructive) as a result of a past event • it is probable that an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation, and • a reliable estimate can be made of the amount of the obligation. If any one of these conditions is not met, no provision may be recognised. Expandable text ­ Recognition Obligations A provision may be necessary as a result of • • a legal or a constructive obligation. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 233 Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets Legal obligation A legal obligation is an obligation that derives from: • • • a contract legislation other operation of law. Constructive obligation A constructive obligation is an obligation that derives from an entity’s actions where: • by an established pattern of past practice, published policies or a sufficiently specific current statement, the entity has indicated to other parties that it will accept certain responsibilities, and • as a result, the entity has created a valid expectation on the part of those other parties that it will discharge those responsibilities. Test your understanding 1 A retail store has a policy of refunding purchases by dissatisfied customers, even though it is under no legal obligation to do so. Its policy of making refunds is generally known. Should a provision be made at the year end? Measuring provisions The amount recognised as a provision should be: • • a realistic estimate • discounted whenever the effect of this is material. a prudent estimate of the expenditure needed to settle the obligation existing at the reporting date Expandable text ­ Measurement 234 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 15 Methods of measuring uncertainties Methods of measuring uncertainties include: • weighting the cost of all probable outcomes according to their probabilities (‘expected value’) • considering a range of possible outcomes. Illustration 1 Expected values An entity sells goods with a warranty covering customers for the cost of repairs of any defects that are discovered within the first two months after purchase. Past experience suggests that 88% of the goods sold will have no defects, 7% will have minor defects and 5% will have major defects. If minor defects were detected in all products sold, the cost of repairs would be $24,000; if major defects were detected in all products sold, the cost would be $200,000. What amount of provision should be made? Expandable text ­ Solution Illustration 2 Best estimate An entity has to rectify a serious fault in an item of plant that it has constructed for a customer. The most likely outcome is that the repair will succeed at the first attempt at a cost of $400,000, but there is a significant chance that a further attempt will be necessary, increasing the total cost to $500,000. What amount of provision should be recognised? Expandable text ­ Solution Expandable text ­ Disclosure Expandable text ­ Specific scenarios: warranty provisions KAPLAN PUBLISHING 235 Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets Exandable text­ Illustration: warranty provisions Expandable text ­ Further illustration: warranty provisions Expandable text ­ Specific scenarios: guarantees Exandable text ­ Illustration: Guarantees Future operating losses No provision may be made for future operating losses because they arise in the future and therefore do not meet the criterion of a liability. Onerous contracts An onerous contract is a contract in which the unavoidable costs of meeting the obligations under the contract exceed the economic benefits expected to be received under it. Expandable text ­ Onerous lease Illustration 3 – Specific scenarios : onerous contract A company has ten years left to run on the lease of a property that is currently unoccupied. The present value of the future rentals at the reporting date is $50,000. Subletting possibilities are limited but the directors feel that likely future subletting rentals could have a present value of $10,000. What is the accounting treatment? Expandable text ­ Solution 236 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 15 Test your understanding 2 During December 20X8 a division of a company moved from Buckingham to Sunderland in order to take advantage of regional development grants. It holds its main premises in Buckingham under an operating lease, which runs until 31 March 20Y1. Annual rentals under the lease are $10 million. The company is unable to cancel the lease, but it has let some of the premises to a charitable organisation at a nominal rent. The company is attempting to rent the remainder of the premises at a commercial rent, but the directors have been advised that the chances of achieving this are less than 50%. What is the accounting treatment required? Environmental provisions A provision will be made for future environmental costs if there is either a legal or constructive obligation to carry out the work This will be discounted to present value at a pre­tax market rate. Illustration 4 – Specific scenarios : Environmental provision Environmental provision Rowsley is a company that carries out many different activities. It is proud of its reputation as a ‘caring’ organisation and has adopted various ethical policies towards its employees and the wider community in which it operates. As part of its annual financial statements, the company publishes details of its environmental policies, which include setting performance targets for activities such as recycling, controlling emissions of noxious substances and limiting use of non­renewable resources. The company has an overseas operation that is involved in mining precious metals. These activities cause significant damage to the environment, including deforestation. The company expects to abandon the mine in eight years' time. The mine is situated in a country where there is no environmental legislation obliging companies to rectify environmental damage and it is very unlikely that any such legislation will be enacted within the next eight years. It has been estimated that the cost of cleaning the site and re­planting the trees will be $25 million if the replanting were successful at the first attempt, but it will probably be necessary to make a further attempt, which will increase the cost by a further $5 million. Should a provision for costs of cleaning the site be made? KAPLAN PUBLISHING 237 Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets Expandable text ­ Solution Test your understanding 3 Laws have been passed that require an entity to fit certain health and safety features in its factories by 30 June 20X2. At 31 December 20X1 (the reporting date) the entity has not yet fitted the health and safety features. How should this be accounted for in the financial statements? Restructuring provisions A restructuring is a programme that is planned and controlled by management, and materially changes either: • • the scope of a business undertaken by an entity, or the manner in which that business is conducted. A provision may only be made if: • • a detailed, formal and approved plan exists the plan has been announced to those affected. The provision should: • • include direct expenditure arising from restructuring exclude costs associated with ongoing activities. Expandable text Illustration 5 – Specific scenarios : Restructuring provisions Restructuring provisions On 14 June 20X5 a decision was made by the board of an entity to close down a division. The decision was not communicated at that time to any of those affected and no other steps were taken to implement the decision by the year end of 30 June 20X5. The division was closed in September 20X5. 238 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 15 Should a provision be made at 30 June 20X5 for the cost of closing down the division? Expandable text ­ Solution Exandable text ­ Illustration: Restructuring provisions Expandable text ­ Future repairs and refurbishments Expandable text ­ Reorganisations 2 Contingent liabilities and contingent assets Expandable text ­ Objective of IAS 37 Contingent liabilities A contingent liability is: • a possible obligation that arises from past events and whose existence will be confirmed only by the occurrence or non­occurrence of one or more uncertain future events not wholly within the control of the entity, or • a present obligation that arises from past events but is not recognised because: – it is not probable that an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation, or – the amount of the obligation cannot be measured with sufficient reliability. Contingent assets A contingent asset is a possible asset that arises from past events and whose existence will be confirmed only by the occurrence or non­occurrence of one or more uncertain future events not wholly within the control of the entity. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 239 Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets Exandable text ­ Contingencies example Accounting for contingent liabilities Contingent liabilities: • • should not be recognised in the statement of financial position itself should be disclosed in a note unless the possibility of a transfer of economic benefits is remote. Accounting for contingent assets Contingent assets should not generally be recognised, but if the possibility of inflows of economic benefits is probable, they should be disclosed. If a gain is virtually certain, it falls within the definition of an asset and should be recognised as such, not as a contingent asset. Summary The accounting treatment can be summarised in a table: Degree of probability of an outflow/inflow of resources Liability Asset Virtually certain Provide Recognise Probable Provide Disclose by note Possible Disclose by note No disclosure Remote No disclosure No disclosure Expandable text ­ Reimbursements Disclosure of contingencies The principal disclosure requirements regarding contingencies are: • • • 240 the nature of the contingency the uncertainties expected to affect the ultimate outcome an estimate of the potential financial effect. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 15 Test your understanding 4 During the year to 31 March 20X9, a customer started legal proceedings against a company, claiming that one of the food products that it manufactures had caused several members of his family to become seriously ill. The company’s lawyers have advised that this action will probably not succeed. Should the company disclose this in its financial statements? 3 IAS 10 Events after the reporting period Events after the reporting period Events after the reporting period are those events, both favourable and unfavourable, which occur between the reporting date and the date on which the financial statements are approved for issue by the board of directors. Adjusting and non­adjusting events Adjusting events are events after the reporting date which provide additional evidence of conditions existing at the reporting date. Non­adjusting events are events after the reporting date which concern conditions that arose after the reporting date. Adjusting events Examples of adjusting events include: • irrecoverable debts arising after the reporting date, which may help to quantify the allowance for receivables as at the reporting date • • allowances for inventories due to evidence of net realisable value • the discovery of fraud or errors. amounts received or receivable in respect of insurance claims which were being negotiated at the reporting date Non­adjusting events Examples of non­adjusting events include: • • a major business combination after the reporting date the destruction of a major production plant by a fire after the reporting date KAPLAN PUBLISHING 241 Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets • abnormally large changes after the reporting date in asset prices or foreign exchange rates. Accounting for adjusting and non­adjusting events Adjusting events require the adjustment of amounts recognised in the financial statements. Non­adjusting events should be disclosed by note if they are of such importance that non­disclosure would affect the ability of the users of the financial statements to make proper evaluations and decisions. The note should disclose the nature of the event and an estimate of the financial effect, or a statement that such an estimate cannot be made. Expandable text ­ Non­adjusting events Illustration 6 – IAS 10 Events after the reporting period Shortly after the reporting date a major credit customer of a company went into liquidation because of heavy trading losses and it is expected that little or none of the $12,500 debt will be recoverable. $10,000 of the debt relates to sales made prior to the year end; $2,500 relates to sales made in the first two days of the new financial year. In the 20X1 financial statements the whole debt has been written off, but one of the directors has pointed out that, as the liquidation is an event after the reporting date, the debt should not in fact be written off but disclosure should be made by note to this year’s financial statements, and the debt written off in the 20X2 financial statements. Advise whether the director is correct. Expandable text ­ Solution Proposed dividends Equity dividends proposed before but declared after the reporting date may not be included as liabilities at the reporting date. The liability arises at the declaration date so they are non­adjusting events after the reporting date and must be disclosed by note as required by IAS 1. 242 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 15 Chapter summary KAPLAN PUBLISHING 243 Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 • • • • The policy is well known and creates a valid expectation. There is a constructive obligation. It is probable some refunds will be made. These can be measured using expected values. Conclusion: A provision is required. Test your understanding 2 244 • The lease contract appears to be an onerous contract as defined by IAS 37 (i.e. the unavoidable costs of meeting the obligations under it exceed the economic benefits expected to be received under it). • Because the company has signed the lease contract, there is a clear legal obligation and the company will have to transfer economic benefits (pay the lease rentals) in settlement. • Therefore the company should recognise a provision for the remaining lease payments. • The company may recognise a corresponding asset in relation to the nominal rentals currently being received, if these are virtually certain to continue. (In practice, it is unlikely that this amount is material.) • As the chances of renting the premises at a commercial rent are less than 50%, no further potential rent receivable may be taken into account. • The financial statements should disclose the carrying amount of the provision at the reporting date, a description of the nature of the obligation and the expected timing of the lease payments, and the amount of any expected rentals receivable from subletting. If an asset is recognised in respect of any rentals receivable, this should also be disclosed. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 15 Test your understanding 3 Present obligation? No. The obligating event would be either the fitting of the health and safety features (which has not happened) or the illegal operation of the factory without the features (which has not happened because the features are not yet legally required). Conclusion: Do not recognise a provision. Test your understanding 4 • • Legal advice is that the claim is unlikely to succeed. • • There is, however, a contingent liability. KAPLAN PUBLISHING It is unlikely that the company has a present obligation to compensate the customer and therefore no provision should be recognised. Unless the possibility of a transfer of economic benefits is remote, the financial statements should disclose a brief description of the nature of the contingent liability, an estimate of its financial effect and an indication of the uncertainties relating to the amount or timing of any outflow. 245 Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets 246 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 16 Taxation Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • • • account for income taxes in accordance with IAS 12 • • calculate deferred tax amounts record entries relating to income taxes in the accounting records explain the effect of taxable temporary differences on accounting and taxable profit record deferred tax in the financial statements. 247 Taxation 1 IAS 12 income taxes Expandable text ­ Current tax ­ general principles Expandable Text ­ Accounting entries for income tax Illustration 1 – IAS 12 Income taxes Under and over ­ provisions for tax Income tax provision at 31 May 20X5 Income tax paid on 28 February 20X6 Income tax charge at 30% for year ended 31 May 20X6 $ 316,000 263,000 383,500 Show the entries in the income tax account and the income statement for the year 31 May 20X6 248 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 16 Expandable text ­ Solution Test your understanding 1 Simple has estimated its income tax liability for the year ended 31 December 20X8 at $180,000, based on taxable profits of $600,000. The tax rate is 30%. Extract from the trial balance as at 31 December 20X8 Dr Cr $ $ Sales 1,500,000 Cost of sales, distribution and administration expenses 900,000 Income tax 3,000 Show the income statement for the year ended 31 December 20X8 and the liability for income taxes in the statement of financial position at that date. Expandable text ­ Sales tax Expandable text ­ Accounting for sales tax Expandable Text­ Illustration: sales tax Expandable text ­ Further illustration: sales tax KAPLAN PUBLISHING 249 Taxation 2 Deferred tax What is deferred tax? Deferred tax is: • the estimated future tax consequences of transactions and events recognised in the financial statements of the current and previous periods. Deferred taxation is a basis of allocating tax charges to particular accounting periods. The key to deferred taxation lies in the two quite different concepts of profit: • the accounting profit (or the reported profit), which is the figure of profit before tax, reported to the shareholders in the published accounts • the taxable profit, which is the figure of profit on which the taxation authorities base their tax calculations. Accounting profit and taxable profit The difference between accounting profit and taxable profit is caused by: • • permanent differences temporary differences. Permanent differences Permanent differences are: • one­off differences between accounting and taxable profits caused by certain items not being taxable/allowable • • differences which only impact on the tax computation of one period differences which have no deferred tax consequences whatever. An example of a permanent difference is client entertaining expenses. Temporary differences Temporary differences are differences between the carrying amount of an asset or liability in the statement of financial position and its tax base (the amount attributed to that asset or liability for tax purposes). 250 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 16 Examples of temporary differences include: • certain types of income and expenditure that are taxed on a cash, rather than on an accruals basis, e.g.certain provisions • the difference between the depreciation charged on a non­current asset that qualifies for tax allowances and the actual allowances (tax depreciation) given (the most common practical example of a temporary difference). For your examination non­current assets are the important examples of temporary differences. Expandable text ­ The accounting problem Illustration 2 – Deferred tax An entity has annual profits of $1,000 (before depreciation) and on 1 January, Year 1 has purchased a non­current asset for $400 which has a two­year useful life. Tax is at the rate of 30% and the company can claim a 100% tax depreciation on the non­current asset. Accounting profit – without deferred tax Profits Depreciation ($400/2) Profit before tax Tax – current (W1) Profit after tax Working 1 Taxable profit Profit (before depreciation) Tax depreciation Taxable profit Tax at 30% Year 1 Year 2 $ $ 1,000 1,000 (200) (200) –––– –––– 800 800 –––– –––– (180) (300) –––– –––– 620 500 1,000 (400) –––– 600 180 1,000 (–) –––– 1,000 300 Even though the same profit (before depreciation) was made each year there is a very different profit after tax figure due to the tax depreciation. This has meant that lower tax is paid in Year 1 but then higher tax in Year 2. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 251 Taxation Deferred tax can eliminate the effect of this timing difference and ensure that the tax charge is in direct relation to the reported profit. Show the effect on the income statement of accounting for the deferred taxation. Expandable text ­ Solution Expandable text ­ Reasons for recognising deferred tax Exandable text ­ Illustration : reasons for deferred tax Expandable text ­ IAS 12 and deferred tax Exandable text ­ Illustration : IAS 12 and deferred tax Test your understanding 2 As at 30 September, Grace has non­current assets with a carrying value of $1,100,000 but a tax written down value of $700,000. The brought forward balance on the deferred tax account is $300,000. Assume a tax rate of 30%. Compute the effect of deferred tax on the financial statements for the year end 30 September. Deferred tax liabilities IAS 12 requires: 252 • a deferred tax liability to be recognised for all taxable temporary differences, with minor exceptions • a taxable temporary difference arises where the carrying value of an asset is greater than its tax base KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 16 • • the liability to be calculated using full provision no discounting of the liability. Deferred tax assets IAS 12 requires that: • deferred tax assets should be recognised for all deductible temporary differences • a deductible temporary difference arises where the tax base of an asset exceeds its carrying value • to the extent that it is probable that taxable profit will be available against which the deductible temporary difference can be utilised • no discounting is permitted. Test your understanding 3 Richard of York is a Shakespearean costumier company. The following is an extract from the trial balance of the above at 31 December 20X5: Dr $ Sales Operating costs Dividends received Deferred tax Corporation tax (over­provision from prior year) Cr $ 100,000 55,000 8,000 19,000 4,000 A taxable temporary difference of $125,000 has accumulated at the year end. Income tax at 20% is estimated at $30,000. (a) Prepare the deferred tax note. (b) Prepare the income statement and tax note. Application to scenarios Revaluation of non­current assets Deferred tax should be recognised on revaluation gains even where there is no intention to sell the asset or rollover relief is available on the gain. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 253 Taxation The revaluation of non­current assets results in taxable temporary differences, and so a liability. This is charged as a component of other comprehensive income (alongside the revaluation gain itself). It is therefore disclosed either in the statement of comprehensive income or in a separate statement showing other comprehensive income. Tax losses Where unused tax losses are carried forward, a deferred tax asset can be recognised to the extent that taxable profits will be available in the future to set the losses against. If an entity does not expect to have taxable profits in the future it cannot recognise the asset in its own accounts. If, however, the entity is part of a group and may surrender tax losses to other group companies, a deferred tax asset may be recognised in the consolidated accounts. The asset is equal to the tax losses expected to be utilised multiplied by the tax rate. Disclosure requirements The main disclosures are: • the tax expense (income) should be presented on the face of the income statement • the major components of tax expense (income) should be disclosed separately in a note • • current and deferred tax charged / credited directly to equity • an explanation of the relationship between tax expense (income) and accounting profit in either or both of the following forms: – a numerical reconciliation between tax expense (income) and the product of accounting profit multiplied by the applicable tax rate(s), disclosing also the basis on which the applicable tax rate(s) is (are) computed. the amount of income tax relating to each component of other comprehensive income – a numerical reconciliation between the average effective tax rate and the applicable tax rate, disclosing also the basis on which the applicable tax rate is computed. Expandable text 254 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 16 Chapter summary KAPLAN PUBLISHING 255 Taxation Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 Income statement for the year ended 31 December 20X8 $ $ Revenue 1,500,000 Costs (900,000) ––––––– Profit before tax 600,000 Income tax: Income tax for the year 180,000 Over­provision in prior year (3,000) ––––––– 177,000 ––––––– Profit after tax 423,000 ––––––– SFP as at 31 December 20X8 $ Current liabilities Income tax 180,000 Test your understanding 2 Opening balance Decrease (balancing figure) Closing balance ((1,100 – 700) × 30%) $000 300 (180) –––– 120 –––– The double entry will be: Dr Deferred tax $180,000 Cr IS (tax charge) $180,000 256 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 16 Test your understanding 3 a. Deferred tax Opening balance Increase Closing balance (125,000 × 20%) $000 19 6 ––– 25 ––– b. Income statement Revenue Operating costs Operating profit Investment income Profit before tax Tax Profit after tax $000 100 (55) ––– 45 8 ––– 53 (32) ––– 21 ––– Tax Income tax Over­provision in previous year Deferred tax KAPLAN PUBLISHING $000 30 (4) 6 ––– 32 ––– 257 Taxation 258 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 17 Reporting financial performance Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • describe the structure (format) and content of financial statements presented under International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) • prepare an entity’s financial statements in accordance with the prescribed structure and content • explain the importance of identifying and reporting the results of continuing and discontinued operations • • • • • define non­current assets held for sale • explain the contents and purpose of the statement of changes in equity • • describe a statement of changes in equity account for non­current assets held for sale define discontinued operations account for discontinued operations identify circumstances where separate disclosure of material items of income and expense is required prepare a statement of changes in equity. 259 Reporting financial performance 1 Income statement, statement showing other comprehensive income and statement of changes in equity Income statement and statement showing other comprehensive income The IAS 1 requirements for an income statement and statement of other comprehensive income were considered in detail in an earlier chapter. 260 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 17 Illustration 1 – Income statement & statement showing other XYZ Group Income statement for the year ended 31 December 20X2 Revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Distribution costs Administrative expenses Profit from operations Finance costs Profit before tax Income tax expense Net profit for the period $ X (X) ––––– X ––––– (X) (X) ––––– X (X) ––––– X (X) ––––– X ––––– XYZ Group Other comprehensive income for the year ended 31 December 20X2 Profit for the year Other comprehensive income Gain on property revaluation Income tax relating to components of other comprehensive income Other comprehensive income for the year, net of tax Total comprehensive income for the year $ X X (X) ––––– X ––––– X ––––– Exceptional items Exceptional items is the name often given to material items of income and expense of such size, nature or incidence that disclosure is necessary in order to explain the performance of the entity. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 261 Reporting financial performance The accounting treatment is to: • • include the item in the standard income statement line disclose the nature and amount in notes. In some cases it may be more appropriate to show the item separately on the face of the income statement. Examples include: • • • • • • • write down of inventories to net realisable value (NRV) write down of property, plant and equipment to recoverable amount restructuring gains/losses on disposal of non­current assets discontinued operations litigation settlements reversals of provisions. Statement of changes in equity The statement of changes in equity provides a summary of transactions with owners, such as share issues and dividends. Non­owner changes in equity (such as revaluation gains) are reported in aggregate, but not presented separately. Illustration 2 – Statement of changes in equity XYZ Group Statement of changes in equity for the year ended 31 December 20X2 Balance at 31 December 20X1 Change in accounting policy Restated balance 262 Share Share Revaluation Retained Total capital premium surplus earnings equity $ $ $ $ $ X X X X X –– X –– –– X –– –– X –– (X) (X) –– X –– –– X –– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 17 Total comprehensive income for the year Dividends Issue of share capital Balance at 31 December 20X2 X X X –– X –– X –– X X X (X) (X) X –– X –– X Notes • The statement technically covers two years, so that comparative figures are available. In an examination question it is likely that only one year’s figures would be required. • Adjustments to the opening figures for changes in accounting policy appear first. The correction of a prior period error would appear in the same position. Test your understanding 1 St Martin had the following opening capital and reserves as at 1 October 20X5. Called­up share capital Revaluation reserve Retained earnings $000 200 450 560 _____ 1,210 _____ The profit after tax was $135,000 for the year to 30 September 20X6, out of which a total of $40,000 dividends were paid. During the year the head office was revalued at $340,000 above its carrying value and this is to be incorporated into the accounts. Further, the company issued 100,000 $1 ordinary shares at $5 each. A prior period adjustment is required following the change of an accounting policy. Retained earnings at 1 October 20X5 must be adjusted downwards by $45,000. Draft the statement of changes in equity. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 263 Reporting financial performance 2 IFRS 5 Non­current assets held for sale and discontinued operations Objective The objectives of IFRS 5 are to set out: • requirements for the classification, measurement and presentation of non­current assets held for sale, in particular requiring that such assets should be presented separately on the face of the statement of financial position • updated rules for the presentation of discontinued operations, in particular requiring that the results of discontinued operations should be presented separately in the income statement. Classification as held for sale A non­current asset should be classified as ‘held for sale’ if its carrying amount will be recovered principally through a sale transaction rather than through continuing use. For this to be the case, the following conditions must apply: • • the asset must be available for immediate sale in its present condition the sale must be highly probable, meaning that: – management are committed to a plan to sell the asset – there is an active programme to locate a buyer, and – the asset is being actively marketed • the sale is expected to be completed within 12 months of its classification as held for sale • it is unlikely that the plan will be significantly changed or will be withdrawn. Expandable text Measurement of non­current assets held for sale Non­current assets that qualify as held for sale should be measured at the lower of: • 264 their carrying amount and KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 17 • fair value less costs to sell. Held for sale non­current assets should be: • • presented separately on the face of the statement of financial position not depreciated. Expandable text Expandable text ­ Statement of financial position proforma Illustration 3 – Measurement of Non­current assets held for sale On 1 January 20X1, Michelle Co bought a chicken­processing machine for $20,000. It has an expected useful life of 10 years and a nil residual value. On 31 December 20X2, after two years of using the asset, Michelle Co decides to sell the machine and starts actions to locate a buyer. The machines are in short supply, so Michelle Co is confident that the machine will be sold fairly quickly. Its current market value is $15,000 and it will cost $500 to dismantle the machine and make it available to the purchaser. At what value should the machine be stated in Michelle Co’s statement of financial position at 31 December 20X2? Expandable text ­ Solution Expandable Text ­Further illustration Discontinued operations A discontinued operation is a component of an entity that has either been disposed of, or is classified as held for sale, and: • represents a separate major line of business or geographical area of operations • is part of a single co­ordinated plan to dispose of a separate major line of business or geographical area of operations, or • is a subsidiary acquired exclusively with a view to resale. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 265 Reporting financial performance Discontinued operations are required to be shown separately in order to help users to predict future performance, i.e. based upon continuing operations. Presentation in the income statement An entity must disclose a single amount on the face of the income statement, comprising the total of: • • the post­tax profit or loss of discontinued operations, and the post­tax gain or loss recognised on the measurement to fair value less costs to sell, or on the disposal, of the assets constituting the discontinued operation. An analysis of this single amount must be presented, either in the notes or on the face of the income statement. The analysis must disclose: • the revenue, expenses and pre­tax profit or loss of discontinued operations • • the related income tax expense • the related income tax expense. the gain or loss recognised on the measurement to fair value less costs to sell, or on the disposal, of the assets constituting the discontinued operation Illustration 4 – Discontinued operations Income statement presentation 20X2 $ Continuing operations: Revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Distribution costs Administration expenses Profit from operations Finance costs 266 X (X) –– X (X) (X) –– X (X) –– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 17 Profit before tax Income tax expenses X (X) –– X Profit for the period from continuing operations Discontinued operations: Profit for the period from discontinued operations* X –– X –– Total profit for the period *The analysis of this single amount would be given in the notes. Alternatively the analysis could be given on the face of the income statement, with separate columns for continuing operations, discontinued operations, and total. An alternative method of presenting discontinued operations in the income statement: X Co Income statement for the year ended 31 October 20X4 Continuing Acquired Discontinued Total operations operations operations $000 $000 $000 $000 550 50 175 775 (415) (40) (165) (620) ––– ––– ––– ––– Gross profit 135 10 10 155 Distribution costs (35) (4) (8) (47) Administrative expenses (50) (7) (57) Sales revenue Cost of sales ––– ––– ––– ––– Profit on operations 50 6 (5) 51 Profit on sale of properties 22 KAPLAN PUBLISHING 22 267 Reporting financial performance Loss on sale of discontinued operations ––– Profit before interest 72 ––– 6 (15) (10) (10) ––– ––– 63 Finance cost (18) ––– Profit before taxation 45 Income tax expense (16) ––– Profit for the year 29 Test your understanding 2 St. Valentine produced cards and sold roses. However, half way through the year ended 31 March 20X6, the rose business was closed and the assets sold off, incurring losses on the disposal of non­current assets of $76,000 and redundancy costs of $37,000. The directors reorganised the continuing business at a cost of $98,000. Trading results may be summarised as follows: Turnover Cost of sales Administration Distribution 268 Cards Roses $000 650 320 120 60 $000 320 150 110 90 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 17 Other trading information is as follows: Interest payable Tax Totals $000 17 31 Draft the income statement for the year ended 31 March 20X6. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 269 Reporting financial performance Chapter summary 270 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 17 Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 Statement of changes in equity Share Share Revaluation Retained Total capital premium surplus earnings equity Opening $000 $000 $000 200 0 450 Prior period adj. $000 $000 560 1,210 (45) (45) –––– –––– Restated 515 1,165 Dividends (40) Share issue 100 400 (40) 500 (100,000 (100,000 × $1) × $4) Total comprehensive 340 135 475 income for the year Closing KAPLAN PUBLISHING –––– –––– –––– 300 400 790 –––– –––– –––– –––– ––––– 610 2100 –––– ––––– 271 Reporting financial performance Test your understanding 2 Income statement for St Valentine for the year ended 31 March 20X6 $000 Continuing operations: Revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Administration costs Distribution costs Operating profit Reorganisation costs Finance costs Profit before tax Income taxes Profit for period from continuing operations Discontinued operations: Loss for period from discontinued operations Loss for period from total operations 272 650 (320) ––– 330 (120) (60) ––– 150 (98) ––– 52 (17) ––– 35 (31) ––– 4 (143) ––– (139) ––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 17 In the notes to the accounts disclose analysis of the discontinued operations figure: Revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Administration costs Distribution costs Operating loss Loss on disposal Redundancy costs Overall loss KAPLAN PUBLISHING $000 320 (150) ––– 170 (110) ( 90) ––– (30) ( 76) ( 37) ––– (143) ––– 273 Reporting financial performance 274 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 18 Earnings per share Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • • • • • • • • • define basic earnings per share (EPS) • explain the limitations of EPS as a performance measure. calculate EPS with a bonus issue during the year calculate EPS with an issue at full market value during the year calculate EPS with a rights issue during the year explain the relevance of diluted EPS (DEPS) calculate DEPS involving convertible debt calculate DEPS involving share options (warrants) explain the importance of EPS as a stock market indicator explain why the trend in EPS may be a more accurate indicator of performance than a company’s profit trend 275 Earnings per share 1 Introduction Earnings per share (EPS) is widely regarded as the most important indicator of a company’s performance. It is important that users of the financial statements: • • are able to compare the EPS of different entities and are able to compare the EPS of the same entity in different accounting periods. IAS 33 achieves comparability by: 276 • • defining earnings • requiring standard presentation and disclosures. prescribing methods for determining the number of shares to be included in the calculation of EPS KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 18 Expandable text ­The scope of IAS 33 Basic EPS The basic EPS calculation is simply: Earnings ––––––––– Shares This should be expressed as cents per share to 1 decimal place. • Earnings: group profit after tax, less non­controlling interests and irredeemable preference share dividends. • Shares: weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the period. Expandable text Expandable text ­ IAS 33 definitions Issue of shares at full market price Earnings should be apportioned over the weighted average equity share capital (i.e. taking account of the date any new shares are issued during the year). Expandable Text­ Illustration :calculation of EPS Test your understanding 1 Gerard's earnings for the year ended 31 December 20X4 are $2,208,000. On 1 January 20X4, the issued share capital of Gerard was 9,200,000 6% preference shares of $1 each and 8,280,000 ordinary shares of $1 each. The company issued 3,312,000 shares at full market value on 30 June 20X4. Calculate the EPS for Gerard for 20X4 KAPLAN PUBLISHING 277 Earnings per share Bonus issue A bonus issue (or capitalisation issue or scrip issue): • • does not provide additional resources to the issuer means that the shareholder owns the same proportion of the business before and after the issue. In the calculation of EPS: • the bonus shares are deemed to have been issued at the start of the year • comparative figures are restated to allow for the proportional increase in share capital caused by the bonus issue. Expandable text Exandable text ­Illustration: Bonus issue Test your understanding 2 Dorabella had the following capital and reserves on 1 April 20X1: Share capital ($1 ordinary shares) Share premium Revaluation reserve Retained earnings Shareholders’ funds $000 7,000 900 500 9,000 –––––– 17,400 Dorabella makes a bonus issue, of one share for every seven held, on 31 August 20X2. 278 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 18 Dorabella plc’s results are as follows: Profit after tax and NCI 20X3 $000 1,150 –––––– 20X2 $000 750 –––––– Calculate EPS for the year ending 31 March 20X3, together with the comparative EPS for 20X2 that would be presented in the 20X3 accounts. Rights issue Rights issues present special problems: • • they contribute additional resources they are normally priced below full market price. Therefore they combine the characteristics of issues at full market price and bonus issues. Determining the weighted average capital, therefore, involves two steps as follows: (1) adjust for bonus element in rights issue, by multiplying capital in issue before the rights issue by the following fraction: Actual cum rights price –––––––––––––––––––– Theoretical ex rights price (2) calculate the weighted average capital in the issue as above. Expandable Text­ Illustration : Rights issue KAPLAN PUBLISHING 279 Earnings per share Test your understanding 3 On 31 December 20X1, the issued share capital consisted of 4,000,000 ordinary shares of 25c each, and the shares were quoted at $1. On 1 July 20X2 the company made a rights issue in the proportion of 1 for 4 at 50c per share. Its trading results for the last two years were as follows: Year ended 31 December Profit after tax 20X1 20X2 $ $ 320,000 425,000 Show the calculation of basic EPS to be presented in the financial statements for the year ended 31 December 20X2 (including the comparative figure). 2 Diluted earnings per share (DEPS) Introduction Equity share capital may change in the future owing to circumstances which exist now – known as dilution. The provision of a diluted EPS figure attempts to alert shareholders to the potential impact on EPS. Examples of dilutive factors are: • • • the conversion terms for convertible bonds the conversion terms for convertible preference shares the exercise price for options and the subscription price for warrants. Basic principles of calculation To deal with potential ordinary shares, adjust basic earnings and number of shares assuming convertibles, options, etc. had converted to equity shares on the first day of the accounting period, or on the date of issue, if later. DEPS is calculated as follows: Earnings + notional extra earnings ––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––– Number of shares + notional extra shares 280 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 18 Expandable text ­ Importance of DEPS Convertibles The principles of convertible bonds and convertible preference shares are similar and will be dealt with together. If the convertible bonds/preference shares had been converted: • the interest/dividend would be saved therefore earnings would be higher • the number of shares would increase. Exandable text ­ Illustration: DEPS Test your understanding 4 A company had 8.28 million shares in issue at the start of the year and made no new issue of shares during the year ended 31 December 20X4, but on that date it had in issue $2,300,000 10% convertible loan stock 20X6­20X9. Assume a corporation tax rate of 30%.The earnings for the year were $2,208,000. This loan stock will be convertible into ordinary $1 shares as follows. 20X6 90 $1 shares for $100 nominal value loan stock 20X7 85 $1 shares for $100 nominal value loan stock 20X8 80 $1 shares for $100 nominal value loan stock 20X9 75 $1 shares for $100 nominal value loan stock Calculate the fully DEPS for the year ended 31 December 20X4. Options and warrants to subscribe for shares An option or warrant gives the holder the right to buy shares at some time in the future at a predetermined price. Cash does enter the entity at the time the option is exercised, and the DEPS calculation must allow for this. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 281 Earnings per share The total number of shares issued on the exercise of the option or warrant is split into two: • the number of shares that would have been issued if the cash received had been used to buy shares at fair value (using the average price of the shares during the period) • the remainder, which are treated like a bonus issue (i.e. as having been issued for no consideration). The number of shares issued for no consideration is added to the number of shares when calculating the DEPS. Exandable text ­ Illustration: Options Test your understanding 5 A company had 8.28 million shares in issue at the start of the year and made no issue of shares during the year ended 31 December 20X4, but on that date there were outstanding options to purchase 920,000 ordinary $1 shares at $1.70 per share. The average fair value of ordinary shares was $1.80. Earnings for the year ended 31 December 20X4 were $2,208,000. Calculate the fully DEPS for the year ended 31 December 20X4. Expandable text ­ Disclosure of EPS 3 The importance of EPS Price earnings ratio The figure EPS is used to compute the major stock market indicator of performance, the price earnings ratio (P/E ratio). The calculation is as follows: P/E ratio = 282 Market value of share –––––––– EPS KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 18 Trend in EPS Although EPS is based on profit on ordinary activities after taxation, the trend in EPS may be a more accurate performance indicator than the trend in profit, EPS: • measures performance from the perspective of investors and potential investors • shows the amount of earnings available to each ordinary shareholder, so that it indicates the potential return on individual investments. Expandable text Importance of DEPS DEPS is important for the following reasons: • it shows what the current year’s EPS would be if all the dilutive potential ordinary shares in issue had been converted • • it can be used to assess trends in past performance in theory, it serves as a warning to equity shareholders that the return on their investment may fall in future periods. Limitations of EPS Although EPS is believed to have a real influence on the market price of shares, it has several important limitations as a performance measure: • It does not take account of inflation. Apparent growth in earnings may not be real. • It is based on historic information and therefore it does not necessarily have predictive value. • An entity’s earnings are affected by the choice of its accounting policies. Therefore it may not always be appropriate to compare the EPS of different companies. • DEPS is only an additional measure of past performance despite looking at future potential shares. Expandable text KAPLAN PUBLISHING 283 Earnings per share Test your understanding 6 On 1 January the issued share capital of Pillbox was 12 million preference shares of $1 each and 10 million ordinary shares of $1 each. Assume where appropriate that the income tax rate is 30%. The earnings for the year ended 31 December were $5,950,000. Calculate the EPS separately in respect of the year ended 31 December for each of the following circumstances (a)­(f), on the basis that: (a) there was no change in the issued share capital of the company during the year ended 31 December (b) the company made a bonus issue on 1 October of one ordinary share for every four shares in issue at 30 September (c) the company issued 1 share for every 10 on 1 August at full market value of $4 (d) the company made a rights issue of $1 ordinary shares on 1 October in the proportion of 1 of every 3 shares held, at a price of $3. The middle market price for the shares on the last day of quotation cum rights was $4 per share (e) the company made no new issue of shares during the year ended 31 December, but on that date it had in issue $2,600,000 10% convertible bonds. These bonds will be convertible into ordinary $1 shares as follows: 20X6 20X7 20X8 20X9 (f) 284 90 85 80 75 $1 shares for $100 nominal value bonds $1 shares for $100 nominal value bonds $1 shares for $100 nominal value bonds $1 shares for $100 nominal value bonds the company made no issue of shares during the year ended 31 December, but on that date there were outstanding options to purchase 74,000 ordinary $1 shares at $2.50 per share. Share price during the year was $4. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 18 Chapter summary KAPLAN PUBLISHING 285 Earnings per share Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 Issue at full market price Date Actual number of Fraction of Total shares year 1 January 20X4 8,280,000 6/12 4,140,000 11,592,000 (W1) 30 June 20X4 6/12 5,796,000 ––––––– Number of shares in EPS 9,936,000 calculation ––––––– (W1) New number of shares Original number New issue New number 8,280,000 3,312,000 ––––––––– 11,592,000 The earnings per share for 20X4 would now be calculated as: $2,208,000 ––––––––––––––––––––––––––––– 9,936,000 = 22.2c Test your understanding 2 The number of shares to be used in the EPS calculation for both years is 7,000,000 + 1,000,000 = 8,000,000. The EPS for 20X2 is 750,000 / 8,000,000 × 100 c = 9.4c The EPS for 20X3 is 1,150,000 / 8,000,000 × 100 c = 14.4c Alternatively adjust last year’s EPS 20X2 750,000/7,000,000 × 7/8 = 9.4c. 286 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 18 Test your understanding 3 20X2 EPS EPS = $425,000 –––––––– 4,722,222 = 9c per share 20X1 EPS Applying correction factor to calculate adjusted comparative figure of EPS: 8c × Theoretical ex rights price –––––––––––––––––––– Actual cum rights price 90c = 8c × –––– = 7.2c per share 100c W1 Current year weighted average number of shares Number of shares 1 July 20X1 to 31 December 20X1 (as adjusted): 4,000,000 × Actual cum rights price –––––––––––––––––––– Theoretical cum rights price 100 4,000,000 × ––– 90 KAPLAN PUBLISHING × 6 months –––– 12 months 6 × –– = 2,222,222 shares 12 287 Earnings per share Number of shares 1 January 20X2 to 30 June 20X2 (actual): 6 ––– 12 × 5,000,000 = 2,500,000 shares Total adjusted shares for year 4,722,222 W2 Theoretical ex rights price Because the rights issue contains a bonus element, the past EPS figures should be adjusted by the factor: Theoretical ex rights price –––––––––––––––––––– Actual cum rights price Prior to rights issue Taking up rights 4 shares 1 share –– 5 –– worth 4 × $1 = cost 50c = $ 4.00 0.50 –––– 4.50 –––– i.e. theoretical ex rights price of each share is $4.50 ÷ 5 = 90c W3 Prior year EPS Last year, reported EPS were $320,000 ÷ 4,000,000 = 8c 288 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 18 Test your understanding 4 If this loan stock was converted to shares the impact on earnings would be as follows. $ Basic earnings Add notional interest saved ($2,300,000 × 10%) Less tax relief $230,000 × 30% $ 2,208,000 230,000 (69,000) –––––– 161,000 ––––––––– 2,369,000 ––––––––– Revised earnings Number of shares if loan converted Basic number of shares Notional extra shares under the most dilution possible 2,300,000 × 8,280,000 90 ––– 100 2,070,000 ––––––––– Revised number of shares DEPS = KAPLAN PUBLISHING 10,350,000 ––––––––– $2,369,000 ––––––––– 10,350,000 = 22.9c 289 Earnings per share Test your understanding 5 $ 2,208,000 ––––––––– Earnings Number of shares Basic Options (W1) 8,280,000 51,111 ––––––––– 8,331,111 ––––––––– $2,208,000 The DEPS is therefore ––––––––––– 8,331,111 (W1) Number of shares at option price Options = = At fair value: Number issued free 290 = 920,000 × $1,564,000 $1,564,000 ––––––––– $1.80 920,000 – 868,889 = 26.5c $1.70 = 868,889 = 51,111 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 18 Test your understanding 6 (a) EPS (basic) = 59.5c Earnings $(6.95m – 500,000 – 500,000) Shares EPS (b) EPS (basic) = 47.6c Earnings Shares (10m × 5/4) EPS (c) EPS (basic) = 57.1c Earnings Shares EPS Pre (7/12 ×10m) Post (5/12 ×10m ×11/10) (d) EPS (basic) = 52.5c Earnings Shares EPS Pre (9/12 × 10m × 4.00/3.75) Post (3/12 × 10m × 4/3) Actual cum rights price TERP (1@300 +3@400)/4 (e) EPS (basic) = 59.5c EPS (fully diluted) = 49.7c Earnings (5.95m + (10% × 2.6m × 70%)) Shares (10m + (90/100 × 2.6m)) EPS KAPLAN PUBLISHING 000 $5,950 10,000 –––––– 59.5c –––––– 000 $5,950 12,500 –––––– 47.6c –––––– 000 $5,950 10,416 –––––– 57.1c –––––– $5,833 $4,583 000 $5,950 11,333 –––––– 52.5c –––––– $8,000 $3,333 $400 $375 000 $6,132 12,340 –––––– 49.7c –––––– 291 Earnings per share (f) EPS (basic) = 59.5c EPS (fully diluted) = 59.3c Earnings Shares (10m + (150/400× 74) EPS 292 000 $5,950 10,028 –––––– 59.3c –––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 19 Interpretation of financial statements Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • list the problems of using historic information to predict future performance and trends • explain how financial statements may be manipulated to produce a desired effect (creative accounting, window dressing) • recognise how related party relationships have the potential to mislead users • explain why figures in the statement of financial position may not be representative of average values throughout the period • • define and compute relevant financial ratios • analyse and interpret ratios to give an assessment of an entity’s performance and financial position in comparison with an entity’s previous period financial statements • analyse and interpret ratios to give an assessment of an entity’s performance and financial position in comparison with another similar entity for the same period • analyse and interpret ratios to give an assessment of an entity’s performance and financial position in comparison with industry average ratios • interpret an entity’s financial statements to give advice from the perspective of different stakeholders • explain how the interpretation of current value based financial statements would differ from those using historical cost based accounts explain what aspects of performance specific ratios are intended to assess 293 Interpretation of financial statements 294 • explain the limitations in the use of ratio analysis for assessing corporate performance • explain the effect that changes in accounting policies or the use of different accounting policies between entities can have on the ability to interpret performance • indicate other information, including non­financial information, that may be of relevance to the assessment of an entity’s performance • explain the different approaches that may be required when assessing the performance of specialised not­for­profit and public sector organisations. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 19 1 Interpreting financial information Introduction Financial statements on their own are of limited use. In this chapter we will consider how to interpret them and gain additional useful information from them. Users of financial statements When interpreting financial statements it is important to ascertain who are the users of accounts and what information they need: • shareholders and potential investors – primarily concerned with receiving an adequate return on their investment, but it must at least provide security and liquidity • • suppliers and lenders – concerned with the security of their debt or loan management – concerned with the trend and level of profits, since this is the main measure of their success. Other potential users include: • • • • • bank managers financial institutions employees professional advisors to investors financial journalists and commentators. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 295 Interpretation of financial statements Ratio analysis A number of ratios can be calculated to help interpret the financial statements. In an examination question you will not have time to calculate all of the ratios presented in this chapter so you must make a choice: • • • choose those relevant to the situation choose those relevant to the party you are analysing for make use of any additional information given in question to help your choice. Expandable text Commenting on ratios Ratios are of limited use on their own, thus most of the marks in an examination question will be available for sensible, well­explained and accurate comments on the key ratios. If you doubt that you have anything to say, the following points should serve as a useful checklist: • • • • What does the ratio literally mean? What does a change in the ratio mean? What is the norm? What are the limitations of the ratio? 2 Profitability ratios Gross profit margin Gross profit margin or percentage is: Gross profit –––––––––––– Sales revenue 296 x 100% KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 19 This is the margin that the company makes on its sales, and would be expected to remain reasonably constant. Since the ratio is affected by only a small number of variables, a change may be traced to a change in: • selling prices – normally deliberate though sometimes unavoidable, e.g. because of increased competition • • • • sales mix – often deliberate purchase cost – including carriage or discounts production cost – materials, labour or production overheads inventory – errors in counting, valuing or cut­off, inventory shortages. Expandable text ­ Comparison of gross profit margins Net profit margin The net profit margin or operating profit margin is calculated as: PBIT –––––––––––– Sales revenue x 100% Any changes in net profit margin should be considered further: • • • Are they in line with changes in gross profit margin? • Look for individual cost categories that have increased/decreased significantly. Are they in line with changes in sales revenue? As many costs are fixed they need not necessarily increase/decrease with a change in revenue. Expandable text KAPLAN PUBLISHING 297 Interpretation of financial statements ROCE Profit –––––––––––– Capital employed ROCE = x 100% Profit is measured as: • • operating (trading) profit, or the PBIT, i.e. the profit before taking account of any returns paid to the providers of long­term finance. Capital employed is measured as: • equity, plus interest­bearing finance, less cash balances, i.e. the long­ term finance supporting the business. ROCE for the current year should be compared to: • • • • the prior year ROCE a target ROCE the cost of borrowing other companies’ ROCE in the same industry. Expandable text Net asset turnover The net asset turnover is: Sales revenue –––––––––––– Capital employed (net assets) 298 = times pa KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 19 It measures management’s efficiency in generating revenue from the net assets at its disposal: • the higher, the more efficient. Note that this can be further subdivided into: • non­current asset turnover (by making non­current assets the denominator) and • working capital turnover (by making net current assets the denominator). Relationship between ratios ROCE can be subdivided into profit margin and asset turnover. Profit margin PBIT –––––––––––– Sales revenue × Asset turnover × Sales revenue –––––––––––– Capital employed = ROCE = PBIT –––––––––––– Capital employed Profit margin is often seen as an indication of the quality of products or services supplied (top­of­range products usually have higher margins). Asset turnover is often seen as a measure of how intensively the assets are worked. A trade­off may exist between margin and asset turnover. • Low­margin businesses (e.g. food retailers) usually have a high asset turnover. • Capital­intensive manufacturing industries usually have relatively low asset turnover but higher margins (e.g. electrical equipment manufacturers). Two completely different strategies can achieve the same ROCE. • Sell goods at a high profit margin with sales volume remaining low (e.g. designer dress shop). • Sell goods at a low profit margin with very high sales volume (e.g. discount clothes store). KAPLAN PUBLISHING 299 Interpretation of financial statements 3 Liquidity and working capital ratios Working capital ratios There are two ratios used to measure overall working capital: • • the current ratio the quick or acid test ratio. Current ratio Current or working capital ratio: Current assets –––––––––––– Current liabilities :1 The current ratio measures the adequacy of current assets to meet the liabilities as they fall due. A high or increasing figure may appear safe but should be regarded with suspicion as it may be due to: • high levels of inventory and receivables (check working capital management ratios) • high cash levels which could be put to better use (e.g. by investing in non­current assets). Expandable text Quick ratio Quick ratio (also known as the liquidity and acid test) ratio: Quick ratio = 300 Current assets – Inventory –––––––––––– Current liabilities :1 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 19 The quick ratio is also known as the acid test ratio because by eliminating inventory from current assets it provides the acid test of whether the company has sufficient liquid resources (receivables and cash) to settle its liabilities. Expandable text Inventory turnover Inventory turnover is defined as: Cost of sales –––––––––––– Inventories = times pa This is normally expressed as a multiple, say 10 times pa. An alternative is to express the inventory turnover as so many days' inventory: Inventory –––––––––––– Cost of sales × 365 days An increasing number of days (or a diminishing multiple) implies that inventory is turning over less quickly which is regarded as a bad sign as it may indicate: • • • lack of demand for the goods poor inventory control an increase in costs (storage, obsolescence, insurance, damage). However, it may not necessarily be bad where management are: • buying inventory in larger quantities to take advantage of trade discounts, or • increasing inventory levels to avoid stockouts. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 301 Interpretation of financial statements Expandable text Receivables collection period This is normally expressed as a number of days: Trade receivables –––––––––––– Credit sales × 365 days The collection period should be compared with: • • the stated credit policy previous period figures. Increasing accounts receivables collection period is usually a bad sign suggesting lack of proper credit control which may lead to irrecoverable debts. It may, however, be due to: • • a deliberate policy to attract more trade, or a major new customer being allowed different terms. Falling receivables days is usually a good sign, though it could indicae that the company is suffering a cash shortage. Expandable text Payables payment period This is usually expressed as: Trade payables –––––––––––– Credit purchases 302 × 365 days KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 19 This represents the credit period taken by the company from its suppliers. The ratio is always compared to previous years: • A long credit period may be good as it represents a source of free finance. • A long credit period may indicate that the company is unable to pay more quickly because of liquidity problems. If the credit period is long: • the company may develop a poor reputation as a slow payer and may not be able to find new suppliers • • existing suppliers may decide to discontinue supplies the company may be losing out on worthwhile cash discounts. In most sets of financial statements (in practice and in examinations) the figure for purchases will not be available therefore cost of sales is normally used as an approximation in the calculation of the accounts payable payment period. 4 Long­term financial stability Introduction The main points to consider when assessing the longer­term financial position are: • • gearing overtrading. Gearing Gearing ratios indicate: • • the degree of risk attached to the company and the sensitivity of earnings and dividends to changes in profitability and activity level. Preference share capital is usually counted as part of debt rather than equity since it carries the right to a fixed rate of dividend which is payable before the ordinary shareholders have any right to a dividend. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 303 Interpretation of financial statements High and low gearing In highly geared businesses: • • • a large proportion of fixed­return capital is used there is a greater risk of insolvency returns to shareholders will grow proportionately more if profits are growing. Low­geared businesses: • provide scope to increase borrowings when potentially profitable projects are available • can usually borrow more easily. Expandable text Measuring gearing There are two methods commonly used to express gearing as follows. Debt/equity ratio: Loans + Preference share capital –––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––– Ordinary share capital + Reserves + Non­controlling interest Percentage of capital employed represented by borrowings: Loans + Preference share capital ––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––– Ordinary share capital + Reserves + Non­controlling interest + Loans + Preference share capital 304 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 19 Interest cover Interest cover = PBIT –––––––––––– Interest payable Interest cover indicates the ability of a company to pay interest out of profits generated: • low interest cover indicates to shareholders that their dividends are at risk (because most profits are eaten up by interest payments) and • • the company may have difficulty financing its debts if its profits fall interest cover of less than two is usually considered unsatisfactory. Expandable text Overtrading Overtrading arises where a company expands its sales revenue fairly rapidly without securing additional long­term capital adequate for its needs. The symptoms of overtrading are: • • • • inventory increasing, possibly more than proportionately to revenue receivables increasing, possibly more than proportionately to revenue cash and liquid assets declining at a fairly alarming rate trade payables increasing rapidly. Expandable text KAPLAN PUBLISHING 305 Interpretation of financial statements Illustration 1 – Interpretation of accounts Statements of financial position and income statements for Ocean Motors are set out below. Statement of financial position for Ocean Motors 20X2 $000 $000 20X1 $000 $000 1,600 (200) –––– 1,450 (150) –––– Non­current assets: Land and buildings Cost Depreciation 1,400 Plant and machinery: Cost Depreciation 600 (120) –––– 1,300 400 (100) –––– 480 –––– 1,880 Current assets: Inventory Receivables Total assets Capital and reserves: Share capital – $1 ordinary shares Retained earnings 306 300 400 –––– 300 –––– 1,600 100 100 –––– 700 –––– 2,580 200 –––– 1,800 1,200 310 –––– 1,510 –––– 1,200 220 –––– 1,420 –––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 19 Current liabilities: Bank overdraft Payables and accruals Taxation liability 590 370 110 –––– 210 70 100 –––– 1,070 –––– 2,580 –––– 380 –––– 1,800 –––– Income statements for Ocean Motors Sales revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Administration and distribution expenses Net profit before tax Income tax expense Net profit after tax 20X2 $000 1,500 (700) –––– 800 (400) –––– 400 (200) –––– 200 20X1 $000 1,000 (300) –––– 700 (360) –––– 340 (170) –––– 170 The dividend for 20X1 was $100,000 and for 20X2 was $110,000. Calculate the following ratios for Ocean Motors and briefly comment upon what they indicate: Profitability ratios: • • • • KAPLAN PUBLISHING gross profit margin net profit margin ROCE net asset turnover. 307 Interpretation of financial statements Liquidity and working capital ratios: • • • • • current ratio quick ratio inventory turnover accounts receivable collection period accounts payable payment period IS. Expandable text ­ Solution Test your understanding 1 Two very small specialist manufacturers make the same product, although they do not compete as they operate in different parts of the same country. The financial statements of the two manufacturing companies are shown below: Income statements T $ Revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Selling expenses Administrative expenses Operating expenses Operating profit Interest payable Profit before tax Tax Profit after tax 308 Y $ 150,000 (60,000) –––––– 90,000 13,500 15,000 –––––– $ $ 700,000 (210,000) –––––– 490,000 84,000 35,000 –––––– (28,500) –––––– 61,500 (3,000) –––––– 58,500 (13,605) –––––– 44,895 –––––– (119,000) –––––– 371,000 (32,000) –––––– 339,000 (68,170) –––––– 270,830 –––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 19 T paid dividends of $20,000 during the year and Y paid dividends of $110,000 during the year. Statements of financial position Non­current assets: $ Property Machinery Current assets: Inventory Receivables Bank $ $ – 190,000 –––––– 190,000 12,000 37,500 500 –––––– $ 500,000 280,000 –––––– 780,000 26,250 105,000 22,000 –––––– 50,000 ––––––– 240,000 ––––––– 153,250 ––––––– 933,250 ––––––– 10,000 Nil 100,000 50,000 77,395 295,580 ––––––– 87,395 ––––––– 445,580 130,000 370,000 10,605 10,000 2,000 ––––––– 240,000 ––––––– 67,670 Nil 50,000 ––––––– 933,250 ––––––– Equity: Revaluation reserve Retained earnings Non­current liabilities: Loan Current liabilities: Trade payables Overdraft Tax KAPLAN PUBLISHING 309 Interpretation of financial statements For each company calculate the following ratios and briefly comment on your results: Profitability ratios: • • • • gross profit margin net profit margin ROCE asset turnover. Liquidity and working capital ratios: • • • • • current ratio quick ratio inventory turnover receivables collection period payables payment period. Gearing ratios: • • gearing ratio interest cover. 5 Investor ratios EPS The calculation of EPS was covered in an earlier chapter. Expandable text ­ Limitations of EPS P/E ratio P/E ratio = 310 Current share price –––––––––––– Latest EPS KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 19 • • Represents the market’s view of the future prospects of the share. High P/E suggests that high growth is expected. Expandable text Dividend yield Dividend yield = Dividend per share ––––––––––––––– Current share price • can be compared to the yields available on other investment possibilities • the lower the dividend yield, the more the market is expecting future growth in the dividend, and vice versa. Dividend cover Dividend cover = Profit after tax ––––––––––––––– Dividends • This is the relationship between available profits and the dividends payable out of the profits. • The higher the dividend cover, the more likely it is that the current dividend level can be sustained in the future. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 311 Interpretation of financial statements Illustration 2 – Investor ratios Given below are the income statements for Pacific Motors for the last two years. Income statements Sales revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Administration and distribution expenses Net profit before tax Income tax expense Net profit after tax 20X2 $000 1,500 (700) –––– 800 (400) –––– 400 (200) –––– 200 20X1 $000 1,000 (300) –––– 700 (360) –––– 340 (170) –––– 170 In 20X1 dividends were $100,000 and in 20X2 they were $110,000. The company is financed by 1,200,000 $1 ordinary shares and let us suppose that the market price of each share was $1.64 at 31 December 20X2 and $1.53 at 31 December 20X1. For each year calculate the following ratios and comment on them briefly: • • • • EPS P/E ratio dividend yield dividend cover. Expandable text ­ Solution 312 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 19 6 Limitations of financial statements and ratio analysis Historical cost accounts Ratios are a tool to assist analysis. • They help to focus attention systematically on important areas and summarise information in an understandable form. • They assist in identifying trends and relationships. However ratios are not predictive if they are based on historical information. • • • They ignore future action by management . They can be manipulated by window dressing or creative accounting. They may be distorted by differences in accounting policies. Expandable text ­ Window dressing Exandable text ­ Illustration: window dressing Change in accounting policies It is necessary to be able to assess the impact of accounting policies on the calculation of ratios. Comparison between businesses that follow different policies becomes a major issue if accounting standards give either choice or judgement to companies. Examples of standards giving choice and judgement include: Choice IFRS 3 Choise over method of valuing the non­controlling interest, and so choise to recognise partial or full goodwill. IAS 16 Choice over whether to revalue tangible non­current assets. Judgement IAS 16 Depreciation rate to use. IAS 38 Amortisation rate to use for intangible assets. IAS 2 The net realisable value of inventory. IAS 37 The likelihood of the pay­out on contingent liabilities and provisions. Expandable text KAPLAN PUBLISHING 313 Interpretation of financial statements Test your understanding 2 A company has revalued its non­current assets during the most recent accounting period. How will this affect the calculation of ROCE? Expandable text ­ Limitations of ratio analysis Test your understanding 3 What are the main limitations of financial ratio analysis? Additional information In practice and in examinations it is likely that the information available in the financial statements may not be enough to make a thorough analysis. You may require additional financial information such as: • • • • • budgeted figures other management information industry averages figures for a similar business figures for the business over a period of time. You may also require other non­financial information such as: • • • • • • market share key employee information sales mix information product range information the size of the order book the long­term plans of management. Test your understanding 4 Explain why trends in accounting ratios may provide a more useful insight into an entity’s financial performance and position than the latest financial statements taken on their own. 314 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 19 Specialised, not­for­profit and public sector organisations The main financial aim of specialised, not­for­profit and public sector organisations is not to achieve a profit or return on capital but to achieve value for money. Value for money is achieved by a combination of the three Es: • Effectiveness – success in achieving its objectives/providing its service. • • Efficiency – how well its resources are used. Economy – keeping cost of inputs low. As profit and return are not so meaningful, many ratios will have little importance in these organisations, for example: • • • ROCE gearing investor ratios in general. However such organisations must also keep control of income and costs therefore other ratios will still be important such as working capital ratios. As the main aim of these organisations is to achieve value for money, other, non­financial ratios take on added significance: • measures of effectiveness such as the time scale within which out­ patients are treated in a hospital • • measures of efficiency such as the pupil­to­teacher ratio in a school measures of economy such as the teaching time of cheaper classroom assistants in a school as opposed to more expensive qualified teachers. 7 Interpreting current cost and current purchasing power accounts Problems with historical cost accounts The figures used to prepare historical cost financial statements will tend to be out of date. This has the following effects: • assets will be understated: – this will overstate ROCE and understate gearing KAPLAN PUBLISHING 315 Interpretation of financial statements • profits will be overstated: – this will overstate ROCE and overstate EPS . Expandable text ­ Current cost and current purchasing power 8 Related parties Definition of a related party Two parties are considered to be related if one party has the ability to control the other party or exercise significant influence over the other party, or the parties are under common control. Distortion of financial statements A related party relationship can affect the financial position and operating results of an entity in a number of ways. • Transactions are entered into with a related party which may not have occurred without the relationship existing. • Transactions may be entered into on terms different to those with an unrelated party. • Transactions with third parties may be affected by the existence of the related party relationship. Expandable text Exandable text ­ Illustration: related parties 316 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 19 Chapter summary KAPLAN PUBLISHING 317 Interpretation of financial statements Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 Profitability ratios: Gross profit margin Net profit margin ROCE Asset turnover T 90/150 × 100 = 60% 61.5/150 × 100 = 41% 61.5/ (87.395 + 130) × 100 = 28.3% 150/(87.395 + 130) = 0.69 Y 490/700 × 100 = 70% 371/700 × 100 = 53% 371/(445.58 + 370) × 100 = 45.5% 700/(445.58 + 370) = 0.86 Comment Overall, from the profitability angle Y would appear to be the better company: • • Y has a higher gross profit margin. Y has a higher net profit margin. It must also be noted that Y is a much larger company that T and therefore may be benefiting from discounts from suppliers that are not available to T and economies of scale. • Y has a higher ROCE caused by the better net profit margin and higher asset turnover indicating a more efficient use of assets. Liquidity and working capital ratios: T Current ratio Quick ratio Inventory turnover Accounts receivable 318 50,000/22,605 = 2.21: 1 38,000/22,605 = 1.68 : 1 60,000/12,000 = 5 times 37,500/150,000 Y 153,250/117,670 = 1.30 : 1 127,000/117,670 1.08 : 1 210,000/26,250 8 times 105,000/700,000 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 19 Collection period Accounts payable payment period × 365 = 91 days 10,605/60,000 × 365 = 64 days × 365 = 55 days 67,670/210,000 × 365 = 118 days Comment Again, as with profitability, Y would appear to be the stronger company with regard to working capital control: • both companies have quite high current and quick ratios which may be the norm in this business but T’s do appear to be very high possibly indicating that best use is not being made of the assets of the company • T holds its inventory for considerably longer than Y which may indicate excessive capital being tied up in inventory holding • T’s accounts receivables collection period is seemingly long at 91 days and compared both with Y’s collection period of just 55 days and also T’s accounts payable payment period of just 64 days. T is paying its accounts payable considerably faster than it is receiving money from its trade receivables • Y’s accounts payable payment period does appear long at 118 days but this may be due to the negotiating power of a much larger business. Gearing ratios T Y Gearing can be measured in two ways: Compared to total capital 130,000/217,395 370,000/815,580 × 100 × 100 = 60% = 45% Compared to just equity capital 130,000/87,395 370,000/445,580 × 100 × 100 = 149% = 83% Interest cover 61,500/3,000 371,000/32,000 = 20.5 times 11.6 times Comment Both companies have fairly high levels of gearing and the following specifics could be noted: • KAPLAN PUBLISHING although the gearing levels appear quite high so does the interest cover in each company indicating that there is no problem with servicing the debt finance 319 Interpretation of financial statements • on the face of it T has a much higher interest cover than Y despite being more highly geared • however the interest rate that T appears to have paid is only 2.3% (3,000/130,000 × 100) which would indicate that T has only recently taken out the loan finance • Y’s effective interest rate is a much more realistic 8.6% (32,000/370,000 × 100). Test your understanding 2 Any upward revaluation of non­current assets causes a reduction in ROCE by: • • increasing the capital employed, and decreasing profits by a higher depreciation charge. Test your understanding 3 The chief limitations of the usefulness of ratio analysis are as follows: 320 • • no rules as to what is an ideal ratio • statement of financial position figures may not necessarily be representative • ratios based upon historical cost information ignore inflation and distort trends • • ratios only reflect monetary transactions no definitions of ratios in accounting standards so comparison could be misleading changes/differences in accounting policies affect ratios. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 19 Test your understanding 4 Comparative figures for several years provide information about the way in which the performance and financial position of a business has changed over a period. For example, if a company has low liquidity ratios for a particular year, this would normally indicate liquidity problems. However, if low liquidity ratios are viewed in the context of a steadily improving trend, the picture is very different: the company is able to survive at this level, is overcoming its problems and is unlikely to go into receivership in the near future. Trends in accounting ratios may provide information from which future performance can be predicted, particularly if the figures are very stable. The extent to which amounts and ratios are stable or volatile can reveal a great deal. Ratios which are very volatile, or sudden changes in trends, may indicate that the company will experience problems in the future, even if performance is apparently improving. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 321 Interpretation of financial statements 322 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 20 Statement of cash flows Chapter learning objectives Upon completion of this chapter you will be able to: • prepare a statement of cash flows for a single entity using the direct method in accordance with IAS 7 • prepare a statement of cash flows for a single entity using the indirect method in accordance with IAS 7 • compare the usefulness of cash flow information with that of an income statement • interpret a statement of cash flows to assess the performance and financial position of an entity • indicate other information, including non­financial information, that may be of relevance to the assessment of an entity’s performance 323 Statement of cash flows 1 IAS 7 Statement of cash flows Objective of the statement of cash flows The objective of IAS 7 Statement of cash flows is: • to ensure that all entities provide information about the historical changes in cash and cash equivalents by means of a statement of cash flows • to classify cash flows (i.e. inflows and outflows of cash and cash equivalents) during the period between those arising from operating, investing and financing activities. Expandable text Definitions Cash: cash on hand (including overdrafts) and on demand deposits. Cash equivalents: short­term, highly liquid investments that are readily convertible into known amounts of cash and are subject to an insignificant risk of changes in value. 324 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 20 Expandable text Proforma statement of cash flows $ Cash flows from operating activities: Net profit before tax Adjustments for: Interest expense Depreciation Profit on sale of non­current assets Provisions Government grants Investment income Operating profit before working capital changes Increase/decrease in inventories Increase/decrease in trade receivables Increase/decrease in trade payables Cash generated from operations Interest paid Income taxes paid Net cash from operating activities Cash flows from investing activities: Purchases of property, plant and equipment Proceeds of sale of property, plant and equipment Interest received Dividends received Net cash used in investing activities KAPLAN PUBLISHING $ X X X (X) (X) X (X) –––– X (X)/X (X)/X X/(X) –––– X (X) (X) –––– X (X) X X X –––– (X) 325 Statement of cash flows Cash flows from financing activities: Proceeds from issue of shares X Proceeds from long­term borrowings X Payment of finance lease liabilities (X) Dividends paid (X) –––– Net cash used in financing activities (X) Net increase in cash and cash equivalents X Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of the period X –––– Cash and cash equivalents at end of the period X –––– Analysis of cash and cash equivalents: This year Last year $ $ Cash on hand and balances with banks X X Short­term investments X X –––– –––– X X –––– –––– Cash and cash equivalents Indirect method The indirect method used above: • • • • begins with profit before tax from the income statement adjusts for interest to get back to profit from operations adjusts for non­cash items adjusts for increases and decreases in working capital. Calculation of net cash flow from operating activities There is a difference between profit and cash flow. 326 • • Profit before tax is computed using the accruals concept. • Adjustments are required to get from profit before tax back to cash flow. Net cash flow from operating activities only records the cash inflows and outflows arising out of trading. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 20 Expandable text ­ Adjustments to profit before tax Expandable text ­ Working capital changes Expandable text ­ Interest and income taxes Investing activities Investing cash flows include: • cash paid for property, plant and equipment and other non­current assets • cash received on the sale of property, plant and equipment and other non­current assets • • cash paid for investments in or loans to other entities dividends received on investments. Financing activities Financing cash flows comprise receipts or repayments of principal from or to external providers of finance including: • • receipts from issuing shares or other equity instruments • • repayments of amounts borrowed (other than overdrafts) receipts from issuing debentures, loans, notes and bonds and from other long­term and short­term borrowings (other than overdrafts, which are normally included in cash and cash equivalents) the capital element of finance lease rental payments. Expandable Text­ Illustration : statement of cash flows KAPLAN PUBLISHING 327 Statement of cash flows Test your understanding 1 The financial statements of Hollywood are given below. Statements of financial position at: 30 September 30 September Non­current tangible assets: Current assets: Inventory Trade receivables Interest receivable Investments Cash in bank Cash in hand Total assets Capital and reserves: Ordinary shares $0.50 each Share premium Revaluation reserve Retained profits 20X3 20X2 $000 $000 $000 $000 634 510 420 390 4 50 75 7 –––– 460 320 9 0 0 5 –––– 946 ––––– 1,580 ––––– 363 89 50 63 –––– 794 ––––– 1,304 ––––– 300 92 0 (70) –––– 565 322 Non­current liabilities: 10% loan notes 5% loan notes 0 329 –––– 40 349 –––– 329 328 389 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 20 Current liabilities: Bank overdraft Trade payables Income tax Accruals 0 550 100 36 –––– 70 400 90 33 –––– 686 –––– 1,580 –––– 593 –––– 1,304 –––– Income statement for the year to 30 September 20X3 $000 Revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Administrative expenses Distribution costs Profit from operations Income from investments Finance cost Profit before tax Income tax expense Net profit for the period KAPLAN PUBLISHING $000 2,900 (1,734) ––––– 1,166 342 520 ––––– (862) –––– 304 5 (19) –––– (14) –––– 290 (104) –––– 186 –––– 329 Statement of cash flows Hollywood ­ Other comprehensive income for the year ended 30 September 20X3 $000 186 Profit for the year Other comprehensive income Gain on property revaluation 50 ––– 236 ––– Total comprehensive income for the year Additional information: (1) On 1 October 20X2, Hollywood issued 60,000 $0.50 ordinary shares at a premium of 100%. The proceeds were used to finance the purchase and cancellation of all its 10% loan notes and some of its 5% loan notes, both at par. A bonus issue of one for ten shares held was made on 1 November 20X2; all shares in issue qualified for the bonus. (2) The current asset investment was a 30­day government bond. (3) Non­current tangible assets include certain properties which were revalued in the year. (4) Non­current tangible assets disposed of in the year had a carrying value of $75,000; cash received on disposal was $98,000. (5) Depreciation charged for the year was $87,000. (6) The accruals balance includes interest payable of $33,000 at 30 September 20X2 and $6,000 at 30 September 20X3. (7) Interim dividends paid during the year were $53,000. Prepare, for the year ended 30 September 20X3, a statement of cash flows using the indirect method and an analysis of cash and cash equivalents. Expandable text ­ Direct method Exandable text ­ Direct vs indirect method Expandable text ­ Advantages and disadvantages of each 330 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 20 2 Comparison of the statement of cash flows and income statement Advantages of the statement of cash flows • It may assist users of financial statements in making judgements on the amount, timing and degree of certainty of future cash flows. • It gives an indication of the relationship between profitability and cash­ generating ability, and thus of the quality of the profit earned. • Analysts and other users of financial information often, formally or informally, develop models to assess and compare the present value of the future cash flow of entities. Historical cash flow information could be useful to check the accuracy of past assessments. • A statement of cash flows in conjunction with a statement of financial position provides information on liquidity, viability and adaptability. The statement of financial position is often used to obtain information on liquidity, but the information is incomplete for this purpose as the statement of financial position is drawn up at a particular point in time. • Cash flows cannot be manipulated easily and are not affected by judgement or by accounting policies. Limitations of the statement of cash flows • Statements of cash flows are based on historical information and therefore do not provide complete information for assessing future cash flows. • There is some scope for manipulation of cash flows, e.g. a business may delay paying suppliers until after the year end. • Cash flow is necessary for survival in the short­term, but in order to survive in the long­term a business must be profitable. It is often necessary to sacrifice cash flow in the short­term in order to generate profits in the long­term (e.g. by investment in non­current assets). A huge cash balance is not a sign of good management if the cash could be invested elsewhere to generate profit. Expandable text 3 Interpretation of statements of cash flow The statement of cash flows should be reviewed after preparation. In particular, cash flows in the following areas should be reviewed: • • • cash generation from trading operations dividend and interest payments capital expenditure KAPLAN PUBLISHING 331 Statement of cash flows • • • financial investment management of financing net cash flow. Expandable text Illustration 1 – Interpretation of statements of cash flows Look at the answer to the cash flow for Hollywood – what can we see? Expandable text ­ Solution Expandable Text­ Additional illustration: interpretation 332 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 20 Chapter summary KAPLAN PUBLISHING 333 Statement of cash flows Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 Statement of cash flows for Hollywood for the year ended 30 September 20X3 $000 $000 Cash flows from operating activities: Profit before tax Adjustments for: Depreciation Profit on disposal of non­current asset (98 – 75) Income from investments Interest expense Operating profit before working capital changes Decreases in inventories Increase in trade receivables Increase in trade payables Increase in sundry accruals (W1) Cash generated from operations Interest paid (W2) Income taxes paid (W3) Net cash from operating activities Cash flows from investing activities: Purchase of tangible non­current assets (W4) Proceeds from sale of non­current assets Interest received (W5) Net cash used in investing activities 334 290 87 (23) (5) 19 ––– 368 40 (70) 150 30 ––– 518 (46) (94) ––– 378 (236) 98 10 ––– (128) KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 20 Cash flows from financing activities: Proceeds from issue of share capital (60 × $1) Redemption of 10% loan notes Redemption of 5% loan notes Dividends paid 60 (40) (20) (53) ––– Net cash used in financing activities Net increase in cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents at 1 October 20X2 (5 – 70) Cash and cash equivalents at 30 September 20X3 (50 + 75 + 7 – 0) (53) ––– 197 (65) ––– 132 ––– Tutorial note: IAS 7 alternatively permits ‘dividends paid’ to be presented as an operating cash flow, so that presentation would be equally acceptable. (ii) Analysis of cash and cash equivalents 30 Sept 20X3 30 Sept 20X2 $000 $000 Cash in bank 75 0 Cash in hand 7 5 Short­term investments 50 0 Bank overdraft (0) (70) –––– –––– Total cash and cash equivalents 132 (65) –––– –––– Workings (W1) Movement in sundry accruals excluding interest payable $000 Accruals c/f (36 – 6) 30 Accruals b/f (33 – 33) 0 –– Therefore ­ Increase in accruals 30 –– KAPLAN PUBLISHING 335 Statement of cash flows (W2) Interest paid $000 Paid (balancing figure) Balance c/f $000 46 Balance b/f 33 6 Income statement 19 ––– ––– 52 52 (W3) Income taxes paid $000 Therefore ­ Paid (bal fig) Bal c/f $000 94 Bal b/f 90 100 Income statement 104 ––– ––– 194 194 ––– ––– (W4) Tangible non­current assets at CV $000 Bal b/f Revaluation Therefore ­ Paid (bal fig) $000 510 Disposal 75 50 Depreciation 87 236 Bal c/f 634 ––– ––– 796 796 ––– ––– (W5) Interest received $000 336 $000 Balance b/f 9 Received (balancing figure) 10 Income statement 5 Bal c/f 4 ––– ––– 14 14 ––– ––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Questions & Answers 337 Questions & Answers Chapter 1: The regulatory framework There are no Questions in this Chapter. Chaptert 2: A conceptual framework There are no Questions in this Chapter. Chapter 3: Accounting concepts and policies Test your understanding 1 ­ Recost Question 1 For over 20 years the accounting profession in many countries has attempted to formulate a method of preparing financial statements that takes account of the effects of price increases (inflation). It seems that no proposed method of reflecting the effects of changing prices has gained international acceptance. The decision of the IASB, and the accounting standard setters in many countries, is that no form of accounting for price changes should be made compulsory, but entities are encouraged to present such information. There have been two main methods put forward by various accounting standard bodies for reporting the effects of price changes. One method is based on the movements in general price inflation and is referred to as a General (or Current) Purchasing Power Approach, the other method is based on specific price changes of goods and assets and is generally referred to as a Current Cost Approach. Some bodies have also suggested an approach which combines features of each method. Required: (a) Explain the limitations of (pure) historic cost accounts when used as a basis for assessing the performance of an entity. You should give an example of how each of three different user groups may be misled by such information. (10 marks) (b) Describe the advantages and criticisms of General Purchasing Power and Current Cost Accounting. (8 marks) (Total: 18 marks) 338 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Chapter 4: Principles of consolidated financial statements Test your understanding 2 ­ Hepburn and Salter Question 1 Hepburn has a subsidiary Salter. At the same date as Hepburn made the share exchange for Salter’s shares, it also acquired 6,000 ‘A’ shares in Woodbridge for a cash payment of $20,000. The share capital of Woodbridge is made up of: Equity voting A shares Equity non­voting B shares 10,000 14,000 All of Woodbridge’s equity shares are entitled to the same dividend rights; however during the year to 31 March 20X0 Woodbridge made substantial losses and did not pay any dividends. Hepburn has treated its investment in Woodbridge as an ordinary long­ term investment on the basis that: • • • it is only entitled to 25% of any dividends that Woodbridge may pay it does not have any directors on the Board of Woodbridge; and it does not exert any influence over the operating policies or management of Woodbridge. Required: Comment on the accounting treatment of Woodbridge by Hepburn’s directors and state how you believe the investment should be accounted for. (5 marks) KAPLAN PUBLISHING 339 Questions & Answers Chapter 5: Consolidated statement of financial position Test your understanding 3 ­ Hanford & Stopple Question 1 Hanford acquired six million of Stopple’s ordinary shares on 1 April 20X1 for an agreed consideration of $24.85 million. The consideration was settled by a share exchange of five new shares in Hanford for every three shares acquired in Stopple, and a cash payment of $4.85 million. The cash transaction has been recorded, but the share exchange has not. The draft statements of financial position of the two companies at 30 September 20X1 are: Hanford $000 $000 Assets Non­current assets Property, plant and equipment Investment in Stopple Current assets Inventory Accounts receivable Cash and bank 78,690 4,850 ––––– 83,540 7,450 12,960 nil ––––– Total assets Equity and liabilities Equity Ordinary shares of $1 each Reserves Share premium Retained earnings: At 1 October 20X0 For the year to 30 September 20X1 20,410 ––––– 103,950 ––––– 27,180 nil ––––– 27,180 4,310 4,330 520 ––––– 20,000 2,000 51,260 12,000 6,000 8,000 73,260 ––––– 93,260 9,160 ––––– 36,340 8,000 10,000 ––––– 340 Stopple $000 $000 ––––– 16,000 ––––– 24,000 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Non­current liabilities 8% Loan notes 20X4 Current liabilities Accounts payable and accruals Bank overdraft Provision for taxation Total equity and liabilities nil 6,000 5,920 4,160 1,700 3,070 nil 2,180 10,690 ––––– ––––– 103,950 ––––– 6,340 ––––– ––––– 36,340 ––––––– The following information is relevant: (i) The fair value of Stopple’s land at the date of acquisition was $4 million in excess of its carrying value. Stopple’s financial statements contain a note of a contingent asset for an insurance claim of $800,000 relating to some inventory that was damaged by a flood on 5 March 20X1. The insurance company is disputing the claim. Hanford has taken legal advice on the claim and believes that it is highly likely that the insurance company will settle it in full in the near future. The fair value of Stopple’s other net assets approximated to their carrying values. (ii) At the date of acquisition Hanford sold an item of plant that had cost $2 million to Stopple for $2.4 million. Stopple has charged depreciation of $240,000 on this plant since it was acquired. (iii) Hanford’s current account debit balance of $820,000 with Stopple does not agree with the corresponding balance in Stopple’s books. Investigations revealed that on 26 September 20X1 Hanford billed Stopple $200,000 for its share of central administration costs. Stopple has not yet recorded this invoice. Inter company current accounts are included in accounts receivable or payable as appropriate. (iv) It is group policy to value the non­controlling interest at its proportionate share of the fair value of the subsidiary's identifiable net assets. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 341 Questions & Answers Required: (a) Prepare the consolidated statement of financial position of Hanford at 30 September 20X1. (20 marks) (b) Suggest reasons why a parent company may not wish to consolidate a subsidiary company, and describe the circumstances in which non­consolidation of subsidiaries is permitted by International Accounting Standards. (5 marks) (Total: 25 marks) Chapter 6: Consolidated income statement Test your understanding 4 ­ Hepburn and Salter Question 1 On 1 October 19X9 Hepburn acquired 80% of the equity share capital of Salter by way of a share exchange. Hepburn issued five of its own shares for every two shares it acquired in Salter. The market value of Hepburn’s shares on 1 October 19X9 was $3 each. The share issue has not yet been recorded in Hepburn’s books. The summarised financial statements of both companies are: Income statements: Year to 31 March 20X0 Sales revenues Cost of sales Gross profit Operating expenses Debenture interest Profit before tax Income tax expense Profit for the year 342 Hepburn $000 1,200 (650) –––– 550 (120) nil –––– 430 (100) –––– 330 Salter $000 1,000 (660) –––– 340 (88) (12) –––– 240 (40) –––– 200 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Statements of financial position: as at 31 March 20X0 Hepburn $000 $000 Non­current assets Property, plant and equipment Investments Current assets Inventory Accounts receivable Bank 240 170 20 –––– Total assets Equity and liabilities Equity shares of $1 each Retained earnings Non­current liabilities 8% Debentures Current liabilities Trade accounts payable Taxation Salter $000 $000 620 660 20 –––– 640 10 –––– 670 430 –––– 1,070 –––– Total equity and liabilities 530 –––– 1,200 –––– 400 410 –––– 810 150 700 –––– 850 nil 150 210 50 –––– –––– 280 210 40 –––– 155 45 –––– 260 –––– 1,070 –––– –––– 200 –––– 1,200 –––– The following information is relevant: (i) The fair values of Salter’s assets were equal to their book values with the exception of its land, which had a fair value of $125,000 in excess of its book value at the date of acquisition. (ii) In the post acquisition period Hepburn sold goods to Salter at a price of $100,000, this was calculated to give a mark­up on cost of 25% to Hepburn. Salter had half of these goods in inventory at the year end. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 343 Questions & Answers (iii) The current accounts of the two companies disagreed due to a cash remittance of $20,000 to Hepburn on 26 March 20X0 not being received until after the year end. Before adjusting for this, Salter’s debit balance in Hepburn’s books was $56,000. (iv) It is group policy to value the non­controlling interest using the full method. The fair value of the non­controlling interest in Salter on 1 October 19X9 was $230,000. Required: Prepare a consolidated income statement and statement of financial position for Hepburn for the year to 31 March 20X0. (20 marks) Test your understanding 5 ­ Holding Question 2 Holding acquired 18 million of Subside’s equity shares on 1 January 20X9 at a cost of $174million. Holding’s accounting year end is 30 September; the year end of Subside prior to its acquisition had been 30 June. In order to facilitate the consolidation process Subside has changed its year end to 30 September and prepared its financial statements for the 15 months period to 30 September 20X9. The following are the income statements of both companies: Sales revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Operating expenses Interest payable Profit before tax Income tax expense Profit for the year 344 Holding 12 Subside 15 months months to 30 to 30 September September 20X9 20X9 $m $m 350 280 (200) (170) –––– –––– 150 110 (72) (35) (10) (5) –––– –––– 68 70 (22) (10) –––– –––– 46 60 –––– –––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 The share capital and reserves of Subside at 30 June 20X8 were: $m Equity shares of $1 each Reserves: Retained earnings Revaluation reserve 64 20 –––– $m 24 84 –––– 108 –––– The following information is relevant: (i) In the post acquisition period Holding sold goods to Subside at a price of $30 million. Holding had marked up the cost of these goods by 25%. One third of these goods were still held in inventory by Subside at 30 September 20X9. (ii) The revaluation reserve of Subside relates to a property carried at its fair value. It was last revalued on 30 June 20X8. At the date of acquisition the value of the property had increased by a further $4 million. (iii) The only other fair value adjustment that is required in respect of the acquisition is in relation to the plant and equipment of Subside. The details of this are: Book value at 30 June 20X8 $m Cost on 1 July 20X6 100 Depreciation (2 years) (40) ––– Carrying value 60 ––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING 345 Questions & Answers The plant is being depreciated over a five­year life using the straight­line method. This is in line with group policy. The cost of sales expense of Subside contains an amount of $25 million in respect of depreciation on the plant for the 15 months to 30 September 20X9. The replacement cost of the type of plant used by Subside has increased dramatically since it was acquired and Holding estimated that the fair value of Subside’s plant at the date of acquisition was $90 million. The estimate of its remaining life was unaltered. (iv) Subside’s business activities are not seasonal in nature and therefore it can be assumed that profits accrued evenly throughout the 15­month period to 30 September 20X9. Required: (a) Calculate the consolidated goodwill in respect of the acquisition of Subside, assuming that the non­controlling interest is valued at its proportionate share of the fair value of the subsidiary's net assets. (8 marks) (b) Prepare the consolidated income statement of Holding for the year to 30 September 20X9. (17 marks) (Total: 25 marks) Chapter 7: Associates Test your understanding 6 ­ Bacup, Townley and Rishworth Question 1 The summarised statements of financial position of Bacup, Townley and Rishworth as at 31 March 20X7 are as follows: Bacup Townley Rishworth $000 $000 $000 Non­current assets: Tangible assets Development expenditure Investments 346 3,820 – 1,600 ––––– 5,420 4,425 200 – ––––– 4,625 500 – – ––––– 500 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Current assets: Inventory Receivables Cash at bank Total assets Equity: Ordinary shares of 25 cents each Reserves: Share premium Retained earnings at 31 March 20X6 Retained for year Current liabilities: Trade payables Bank overdraft Taxation Total equity and liabilities 2,740 1,960 1,260 ––––– 5,960 ––––– 11,380 ––––– 1,280 980 – ––––– 2,260 ––––– 6,885 ––––– 250 164 86 ––––– 500 ––––– 1,000 ––––– 4,000 500 200 800 2,300 1,760 ––––– 8,860 ––––– 125 380 400 ––––– 1,405 ––––– 450 150 ––––– 800 ––––– 2,120 – 400 ––––– 2,520 ––––– 11,380 ––––– 3,070 2,260 150 ––––– 5,480 ––––– 6,885 ––––– 142 – 58 ––––– 200 ––––– 1,000 ––––– The following information is relevant: (i) Investments Bacup acquired 1.6 million shares in Townley on 1 April 20X6 paying 75 cents per share. On 1 October 20X6 Bacup acquired 40% of the share capital of Rishworth for $400,000. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 347 Questions & Answers (ii) Group accounting policies Development expenditure Development expenditure is to be written off as incurred as it does not meet the criteria for capitalisation in IAS 38. The development expenditure in the statement of financial position of Townley relates to a project that was commenced on 1 April 20X5. At the date of acquisition the value of the capitalised expenditure was $80,000. No development expenditure of Townley has yet been depreciated. (iii) Intra­group trading The inventory of Bacup includes goods at a transfer price of $200,000 purchased from Townley after the acquisition. The inventory of Rishworth includes goods at a transfer price of $125,000 purchased from Bacup. All transfers were at cost plus 25%. The receivables of Bacup include an amount owing from Townley of $250,000. This does not agree with the corresponding amount in the books of Townley due to a cash payment of $50,000 made on 29 March 20X7, which had not been received by Bacup at the year end. (iv) Share premium The share premium account of Townley arose prior to the acquisition by Bacup. (v) It is group policy to value the non­controlling interest at its proportionate share of the fair values of the subsidiary's identifiable net assets. Required: (a) A consolidated statement of financial position of the Bacup group as at 31 March 20X7. (18 marks) (b) Norden Manufacturing has been approached by Mr Long, a representative of Townley. Mr Long is negotiating for Norden to supply Townley with goods on six­month credit. Mr Long has pointed out that Townley is part of the Bacup group and provides the consolidated statement of financial position to support the credit request. 348 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Required: Briefly discuss the usefulness of the group statement of financial position for assessing the creditworthiness of Townley and describe the further investigations you would advise Norden Manufacturing to make. (7 marks) (Total: 25 marks) Test your understanding 7 ­ Harden Question 2 Harden acquired 800,000 of Solder’s $1 equity shares on 1 October 20X0 for $2.5 million. One year later, on 1 October 20X1, Harden acquired 200,000 $1 equity shares in Active for $800,000. The statements of financial position of the three companies at 30 September 20X2 are shown below: Harden $000 $000 Non­current assets Property, plant and equipment Patents Investments – in Solder – in Active – in others Current assets Inventories Trade receivables Bank Total assets Solder $000 $000 Active $000 $000 3,980 2,300 1,340 250 420 nil 2,500 800 150 3,450 ––––– ––––– 7,680 ––––– 200 ––––– 2,920 ––––– 60 ––––– 1,400 ––––– 570 400 300 420 380 400 nil 990 150 930 120 820 ––––– ––––– ––––– ––––– ––––– ––––– 8,670 3,850 2,220 ––––– ––––– ––––– Equity and liabilities Equity: Equity shares of $1 each KAPLAN PUBLISHING 2,000 1,000 500 349 Questions & Answers Reserves: Share premium Retained earnings Non­current liabilities Deferred tax Current liabilities Trade payables Taxation Overdraft Total equity and liabilities 1,000 500 4,500 5,500 1,900 ––––– ––––– ––––– 7,500 ––––– 200 100 2,400 1,200 1,300 ––––– ––––– ––––– 3,400 1,800 ––––– ––––– nil 80 750 450 280 140 nil 60 80 970 nil 450 nil 340 ––––– ––––– ––––– ––––– ––––– ––––– 8,670 3,850 2,220 ––––– ––––– ––––– The following information is relevant: (i) The balances of the retained earnings of the three companies were: Harden Solder Active $000 $000 $000 at 1 October 2,000 1,200 500 20X0 at 1 October 3,000 1,500 800 20X1 (ii) At the date of its acquisition the fair values of Solder’s net assets were equal to their book values with the exception of a plot of land that had a fair value of $200,000 in excess of its book value. (iii) On 26 September 20X2 Harden processed an invoice for $50,000 in respect of an agreed allocation of central overhead expenses to Solder. At the 30 September 20X2 Solder had not accounted for this transaction. Prior to this the current accounts between the two companies had been agreed at Solder owing $70,000 to Harden (included in trade receivables and trade payables respectively). (iv) During the year Active sold goods to Harden at a selling price of $140,000 which gave Active a profit of 40% on cost. Harden had half of these goods in inventory at 30 September 20X2. (v) It is group policy to value non­controlling interests at full value. The fair value of the non­controlling interest in Solder was as follows: 350 1 October 20X0 $600,000 30 September 20X2 $675,000 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Required: (a) Prepare the consolidated statement of financial position of Harden as at 30 September 20X2. (20 marks) Chapter 8: Tangible non­current assets Test your understanding 8 ­ Simpkins Question 1 During the preparation of the draft financial statements of Simpkins for the year to 30 September 20X1 the following problem area has arisen: Simpkins has three long leasehold properties in different regional areas. The original costs, accumulated depreciation and book (carrying) values of them at 1 October 20X0 are shown below. The accompanying ‘change’ column is the estimated percentage change from their book value, at 1 October 20X0, as provided by an independent surveyor on that date: Cost Property in the South Property in Midlands Property in the North $000 4,000 2,500 2,000 Depreciation (1 Oct 20X0) $000 800 1,000 1,200 Book value $000 3,200 1,500 800 Change value % +40 Nil ­ 20 The leaseholds were for a period of 50 years when they were acquired and the company policy is to depreciate them over their life on a straight­ line basis. None of the leaseholds are investment properties. As can be seen from the ‘change’ column the value of the leasehold in the South has increased significantly. In its financial statements for the year to 30 September 20X1, the directors of Simpkins are proposing to adopt the current value (as from 1 October 20X0) of the leasehold in the South, but to leave the remaining leaseholds at their original depreciated cost. In the case of the leasehold in the North, the directors justified this, on the basis that a recovery in the market value of the leasehold property was expected within the next few years. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 351 Questions & Answers Required: Assuming the directors are committed to using current value for the property in the South, advise the directors as to the acceptability of their proposal; and calculate the income statement charges and the non­ current asset statement of financial position extracts relating to all the properties for the year to 30 September 20X1 in accordance with the requirements of IAS 16 Property, Plant and Equipment. (5 marks) Test your understanding 9 ­ Myriad Question 2 Myriad owns several properties which are revalued each year. Three of its properties are rented out under annual contracts. Details of these properties and their valuations are: Property A B C Type/life freehold 50 years freehold 50 years freehold 15 years Cost $000 150 Value 30 Value 30 September September20X1 20X0 $000 $000 240 200 120 180 145 120 140 150 All three properties were acquired on 1 October 19W9. The valuations of the properties are based on their age at the date of valuation. Myriad’s policy is to carry all non­investment properties at cost. Annual amortisation, where appropriate, is based on the carrying value of assets at the beginning of the relevant period. Property A is let to a subsidiary of Myriad on normal commercial terms. The other properties are let on normal commercial terms to companies not related to Myriad. Myriad adopts the fair value model of accounting for investment properties in IAS 40 Investment Property, and the cost model for owner­ occupied properties in IAS 16 Property, Plant and Equipment. 352 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Required: (i) Describe the possible accounting treatments for investment properties under IAS 40 and explain why they may require a different accounting treatment to owner­occupied properties. (4 marks) (ii) Prepare extracts of the consolidated financial statements of Myriad for the year to 30 September 20X1 in respect of the above properties assuming the company adopts the fair value method in IAS 40. (6 marks) (Total: 10 marks) Chapter 9: Intangible assets Test your understanding 10 ­ Dexterity Question 1 (a) During the last decade it has not been unusual for the premium paid to acquire control of a business to be greater than the fair value of its tangible net assets. This increase in the relative SFP proportions of intangible assets has made the accounting practices for them all the more important. During the same period many companies have spent a great deal of money internally developing new intangible assets such as software and brands. IAS 38 Intangible Assets was issued in September 1998 and prescribes the accounting treatment for intangible assets. Required: In accordance with IAS 38, discuss whether intangible assets should be recognised, and if so how they should be initially recorded and subsequently amortised in the following circumstances: – KAPLAN PUBLISHING When they are purchased separately from other assets. 353 Questions & Answers – When they are obtained as part of acquiring the whole of a business, and – When they are developed internally. (10 marks) Note: your answer should consider goodwill separately from other intangibles. (b) Dexterity is a public listed company. It has been considering the accounting treatment of its intangible assets and has asked for your opinion on how the matters below should be treated in its financial statements for the year to 31 March 20X4. (i) On 1 October 20X3 Dexterity acquired the whole of the share capital of Temerity, a small company that specialises in pharmaceutical drug research and development. The purchase consideration was by way of a share exchange and valued at $35 million. The fair value of Temerity’s net assets was $15 million (excluding any items referred to below). Temerity owns a patent for an established successful drug that has a remaining life of eight years. A firm of specialist advisors, Leadbrand, has estimated the current value of this patent to be $10 million, however the company is awaiting the outcome of clinical trials where the drug has been tested to treat a different illness. If the trials are successful, the value of the patent is then estimated to be $15 million. Also included in the company’s statement of financial position is $2 million for medical research that has been conducted on behalf of a client. (4 marks) (ii) Dexterity has developed and patented a new drug which has been approved for clinical use. The costs of developing the drug were $12 million. Based on early assessments of its sales success, Leadbrand have estimated its market value at $20 million. (3 marks) 354 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 (iii) Dexterity’s manufacturing facilities have recently received a favourable inspection by government medical scientists. As a result of this the company has been granted an exclusive five­year licence to manufacture and distribute a new vaccine. Although the licence had no direct cost to Dexterity, its directors feel its granting is a reflection of the company’s standing and have asked Leadbrand to value the licence. Accordingly they have placed a value of $10 million on it. (3 marks) (iv) In the current accounting period, Dexterity has spent $3 million sending its staff on specialist training courses. Whilst these courses have been expensive, they have led to a marked improvement in production quality and staff now need less supervision. This in turn has led to an increase in revenue and cost reductions. The directors of Dexterity believe these benefits will continue for at least three years and wish to treat the training costs as an assets. (2 marks) (v) In December 20X3, Dexterity paid $5 million for a television advertising campaign for its products that will run for six months from 1 January 20X4 to 30 June 20X4. The directors believe that increased sales as a result of the publicity will continue for two years from the start of the advertisements. (3 marks) Required: Explain how the directors of Dexterity should treat the above items in the financial statements for the year to 31 March 20X4. (15 marks as indicated) Note: The values given by Leadbrand can be taken as being reliable measurements. You are not required to consider depreciation aspects. (Total: 25 marks) KAPLAN PUBLISHING 355 Questions & Answers Chapter 10: Impairment of assets Test your understanding 11 ­ Shiplake Question 1 It is generally recognised in practice that non­current assets should not be carried in a statement of financial position at values that are greater than they are ‘worth’. There has been little guidance on this with the result that impairment losses were not recognised on a consistent or timely basis or were not recognised at all. IAS 36 Impairment of Assets was issued in June 1998 on this topic and revised in March 2004. Required: (a) (i) Define an impairment loss and explain when companies should carry out a review for impairment of assets. (3 marks) (ii) Describe the circumstances that may indicate that a company’s assets may have become impaired. (7 marks) (b) Shiplake is preparing its financial statements to 31 March 20X2. The following situations have been identified by an impairment review team: (i) On 1 April 20X1 Shiplake acquired the whole share capital of two subsidiary companies, Halyard and Mainstay, in separate acquisitions. Consolidated goodwill was calculated as: Purchase consideration Estimated fair value of net assets Consolidated goodwill 356 Halyard $000 12,000 (8,000) ––––– 4,000 ––––– Mainstay $000 4,500 (3,000) ––––– 1,500 ––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 A review of the fair value of each subsidiary’s net assets was undertaken in March 20X2. Unfortunately both companies’ net assets had declined in value. The estimated value of Halyard’s net assets as at 1 April 20X1 was now only $7 million. This was due to more detailed information becoming available about the market value of its specialised properties. Mainstay’s net assets were estimated to have a fair value of $500,000 less than their carrying value. This fall was due to some physical damage occurring to its plant and machinery. (3 marks) (ii) Shiplake has an item of earth­moving plant, which is hired out to companies on short­term contracts. Its carrying value, based on depreciated historical cost, is $400,000. The estimated selling price of this asset is only $250,000, with associated selling expenses of $5,000. A recent review of its value in use based on its forecast future cash flows was estimated at $500,000. Since this review was undertaken there has been a dramatic increase in interest rates that has significantly increased the cost of capital used by Shiplake to discount the future cash flows of the plant. (6 marks) (iii) Shiplake is engaged in a research and development project to produce a new product. In the year to 31 March 20X1 the company spent $120,000 on research that concluded that there were sufficient grounds to carry the project on to its development stage and a further $75,000 had been spent on development. At that date management had decided that they were not sufficiently confident in the ultimate profitability of the project and wrote off all the expenditure to date to the income statement. In the current year further direct development costs have been incurred of $80,000 and the development work is now almost complete with only an estimated $10,000 of costs to be incurred in the future. Production is expected to commence within the next few months. Unfortunately the total trading profit from sales of the new product is not expected to be as good as market research data originally forecast and is estimated at only $150,000. As the future benefits are greater than the remaining future costs, the project will be completed, but due to the overall deficit expected, the directors have again decided to write off all the development expenditure. (4 marks) KAPLAN PUBLISHING 357 Questions & Answers Required: Explain, with numerical illustrations where possible, how the information in (i) to (iv) above would affect the preparation of Shiplake’s consolidated financial statements to 31 March 20X2. (Total: 25 marks) Test your understanding 12 ­ Multiplex Question 2 On 1 January 20X0 Multiplex acquired the whole of Steamdays, a company that operates a scenic railway along the coast of a popular tourist area. The summarised statement of financial position at fair values of Steamdays on 1 January 20X0, reflecting the terms of the acquisition was: Goodwill Operating licence Property ­ train stations and land Rail track and coaches Two steam engines Purchase consideration $000 200 1,200 300 300 1,000 ––––– 3,000 ––––– The operating licence is for ten years. It was renewed on 1 January 20X0 by the transport authority and is stated at the cost of its renewal. Carrying values of the property, rail track and coaches are based on their value in use. Engines are valued at their net selling prices. On 1 February 20X0 the boiler of one of the steam engines exploded, completely destroying the whole engine. Fortunately no one was injured, but the engine was beyond repair. Due to its age a replacement could not be obtained. Because of the reduced passenger capacity the estimated value in use of the whole of the business after the accident was assessed at $2 million. 358 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Passenger numbers after the accident were below expectations even after allowing for the reduced capacity. A market research report concluded that tourists were not using the railway because of their fear of a similar accident occurring to the remaining engine. In the light of this the value in use of the business was re­assessed on 31 March 20X0 at $1.8 million. On this date Multiplex received an offer of $900,000 in respect of the operating licence (it is transferable). The realisable value of the other net assets has not changed significantly. Required: Calculate the carrying value of the assets of Steamdays (in Multiplex’s consolidated statement of financial position) at 1 February 20X0 and 31 March 20X0 after recognising the impairment losses. (6 marks) Chapter 11: Inventories and construction contracts Test your understanding 13 ­ Merryview Question 1 Merryview specialises in construction contracts. One of its contracts, with Better Homes, is to build a complex of luxury flats. The price agreed for the contract is $40 million and its scheduled date of completion is 31 December 20X2. Details of the contract to 31 March 20X1 are: Commencement date Contract costs: Architects’ and surveyors’ fees Materials delivered to site Direct labour costs Overheads are apportioned at 40% of direct labour costs Estimated cost to complete (excluding depreciation – see below) 1 July 20X0 $000 500 3,100 3,500 14,800 Plant and machinery used exclusively on the contract cost $3,600,000 on 1 July 20X0. At the end of the contract it is expected to be transferred to a different contract at a value of $600,000. Depreciation is to be based on a time apportioned basis. Inventory of materials on site at 31 March 20X1 is $300,000. Better Homes paid a progress payment of $12,800,000 to Merryview on 31 March 20X1. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 359 Questions & Answers At 31 March 20X2 the details for the construction contract have been summarised as: Contract costs to date (i.e. since the start of the contract) excluding all depreciation Estimated cost to complete (excluding depreciation) $000 20,400 6,600 A further progress payment of $16,200,000 was received on 31 March 20X2. Merryview accrues profit on its construction contracts using the percentage of completion basis as measured by the percentage of the cost to date compared to the total estimated contract cost. Required: (a) Prepare extracts of the financial statements of Merryview for the construction contract with Better Homes for: (i) the year to 31 March 20X1 (8 marks) (ii) the year to 31 March 20X2. (7 marks) (Total: 15 marks) Test your understanding 14 ­ Multiplex Question 2 Multiplex is in the intermediate stage of a construction contract for the building of a new privately owned road bridge over a river estuary. The original details of the contract are: Approximate duration of contract: Date of commencement: Total contract price: Estimated total cost: 360 3 years 1 October 19W8 $40 million $28 million KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 An independent surveyor certified the value of the work in progress as follows: – on 31 March 19W9 – on 31 March 20X0 Total costs incurred at: – 31 March 19W9 – 31 March 20X0 $12 million $30 million (including the $12 million in 19W9) $9 million $28.5 million (including the $9 million in 19W9) Progress billings at 31 March 20X0 were $25 million On 1 April 19W9 Multiplex agreed to a contract variation that would involve an additional fee of $5 million with associated additional estimated costs of $2 million. The costs incurred during the year to 31 March 20X0 include $2.5 million relating to the replacement of some bolts which had been made from material that had been incorrectly specified by the firm of civil engineers who were contracted by Multiplex to design the bridge. These costs were not included in the original estimates, but Multiplex is hopeful that they can be recovered from the firm of civil engineers. Multiplex calculates profit on construction contracts using the percentage of completion method. The percentage of completion of the contract is based on the value of the work certified to date compared to the total contract price. Required: Prepare the income statement and statement of financial position extracts in respect of the contract for the year to 31 March 20X0 only. (9 marks) KAPLAN PUBLISHING 361 Questions & Answers Chapter 12: Financial assets and financial liabilities Test your understanding 15 ­ Multicolour Question 1 On 1 April 19X9 Multicolour issued $80 million 8% convertible loan stock at par. The stock is convertible into equity shares, or redeemable at par, on 31 March 20X4, at the option of the stockholders. The terms of conversion are that each $100 of loan stock will be convertible into 50 equity shares of Multicolour. A finance consultant has advised that if the option to convert to equity had not been included in the terms of the issue, then a coupon (interest) rate of 12% would have been required to attract subscribers for the stock. The value of $1 receivable at the end of each year at a discount rate of 12% are: Year 1 2 3 4 5 $ 0.89 0.80 0.71 0.64 0.57 Required: Calculate the income statement finance charge for the year to 31 March 20X0 and the statement of financial position extracts at 31 March 20X0 in respect of the issue of the convertible loan stock. (5 marks) 362 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Chapter 13: Leases Test your understanding 16 ­ Deltoid Question 1 The following statement of financial position has been extracted from the draft financial statements of Deltoid for the year to 31 March 20X2: Statement of financial position as at 31 March 20X2 Non­current assets Property, plant and equipment Current assets Inventory Trade accounts receivable Bank $000 3,850 2,450 250 –––––– Total assets Equity and liabilities Equity: Ordinary shares of 50 cents each Reserves Share premium Revaluation reserve Retained earnings b/f at 1 April 20X1 Profit after tax for year to 31 March 20X2 Total equity and liabilities KAPLAN PUBLISHING 6,550 –––––– 18,660 –––––– 2,000 1,000 3,000 3,700 2,000 –––––– Non­current liabilities 6% loan note Current liabilities Trade accounts payable Taxation $000 12,110 5,700 –––––– 11,700 3,000 2,820 1,140 –––––– 3,960 –––––– 18,660 –––––– 363 Questions & Answers The following additional information is available: (1) The financial statements include an item of plant based on its treatment in the company’s management accounts where plant is depreciated on a machine hour use basis. The details of this item of plant are: Cost (1 April 20X0) Estimated residual value Estimated machine hour life Measured usage in year to: 31 March 20X1 31 March 20X2 $250,000 $50,000 8,000 hours 2,000 hours 800 hours In the financial statements the company policy is that plant and machinery should be written off at 20% per annum on the reducing balance basis. (2) The income statement includes a charge of $150,000 being the first two of ten payments of $75,000 each in respect of a five­year lease of an item of plant. The payments were made on 1 April 20X1 and 1 October 20X1. The fair value of this plant at the date it was leased was $600,000. Information obtained from the finance department confirms that this is a finance lease and an appropriate periodic rate of interest is 10% per annum. Deltoid has treated the lease as an operating lease in the above financial statements. The company depreciates plant used under finance leases on a straight­line basis over the life of the lease. (3) Deltoid made a 1 for 4 bonus issue of shares on 1 March 20X2 utilising the revaluation reserve. This has not yet been recorded in the above financial statements. Required: Redraft the statement of financial position of Deltoid as at 31 March 20X2 making appropriate adjustments for the items in (1) to (3) above. (20 marks) Note: work to the nearest $000 and show separately your working for the retained earnings included in the statement of financial position. 364 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Test your understanding 17 ­ Bowtock Question 2 Bowtock has leased an item of plant under the following terms: • • • • • Commencement of the lease was 1 January 20X2. Term of lease five years. Annual payments in advance $12,000. Cash price and fair value of the asset – $52,000 at 1 January 20X2 Implicit interest rate within the lease (as supplied by the lessor) 8% per annum (to be apportioned on a time basis where relevant). The company’s depreciation policy for this type of plant is 20% per annum on cost (apportioned on a time basis where relevant). Required: Prepare extracts of the income statement and statement of financial position for Bowtock for the year to 30 September 20X3 for the above lease. (5 marks) Chapter 14: Substance over form Test your understanding 18 ­ Atkins Question 1 The principle of recording the substance or economic reality of transactions rather than their legal form lies at the heart of the Framework for the Preparation and Presentation of Financial Statements (Framework) and several International Accounting Standards. The development of this principle was partly in reaction to a minority of public interest companies entering into certain complex transactions. These transactions sometimes led to accusations that company directors were involved in ‘creative accounting’. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 365 Questions & Answers Required: (a) (i) Explain, with relevant examples, what is generally meant by the term ‘creative accounting’. (5 marks) (ii) Explain why it is important to record the substance rather than the legal form of transactions and describe the features that may indicate that the substance of a transaction is different from its legal form. (5 marks) (b) (i) Atkins’s operations involve selling cars to the public through a chain of retail car showrooms. It buys most of its new vehicles directly from the manufacturer on these terms: – Atkins will pay the manufacturer for the cars on the date they are sold to a customer or six months after they are delivered to its showrooms whichever is the sooner. – The price paid will be 80% of the retail list price as set by the manufacturer at the date that the goods are delivered. – Atkins will pay the manufacturer 1.5% per month (of the cost price to Atkins) as a ‘display charge’ until the goods are paid for. – Atkins may return the cars to the manufacturer any time up until the date the cars are due to be paid for. Atkins will incur the freight cost of any such returns. Atkins has never taken advantage of this right of return. – The manufacturer can recall the cars or request them to be transferred to another retailer any time up until the time they are paid for by Atkins. Required: Discuss which party bears the risks and rewards in the above arrangement and come to a conclusion on how the transactions should be treated by each party. (6 marks) 366 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 (ii) Atkins bought five identical plots of development land for $2 million in 19W9. On 1 October 20X1 Atkins sold three of the plots of land to an investment company, Landbank, for a total of $2.4 million. This price was based on 75% of the fair market value of $3.2 million as determined by an independent surveyor at the date of sale. The terms of the sale contained two clauses: – Atkins can re­purchase the plots of land for the full fair value of $3.2 million (the value determined at the date of sale) any time until 30 September 20X4, and – On 1 October 20X4, Landbank has the option to require Atkins to re­purchase the properties for $3.2 million. You may assume that Landbank seeks a return on its investments of 10% per annum. Required: Discuss the substance of the above transactions. (3 marks) Prepare extracts of the income statement and statement of financial position (ignore cash) of Atkins for the year to 30 September 20X2: – if the plots of land are considered as sold to Landbank (2 marks) – reflecting the substance of the above transactions. (4 marks) (Total: 25 marks) Test your understanding 19 ­ Jenson Question 2 Jenson has entered into the following transactions/agreements in the year to 31 March 20X0: (i) Goods, which had a cost of $20,000, were sold to Wholesaler for $35,000 on 1 July 19W9. Jenson has an option to repurchase the goods from Wholesaler at any time within the next two years. The repurchase price will be $35,000 plus interest charged at 12% per annum from the date of sale to the date of repurchase. It is expected that Jenson will repurchase the goods. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 367 Questions & Answers (ii) Jenson owns the rights to a fast food franchise. On 1 April 19W9 it sold the right to open a new outlet to Mr Cody. The franchise is for five years. Jenson received an initial fee of $50,000 for the first year and will receive $5,000 per annum thereafter. Jenson has continuing service obligations on its franchise for advertising and product development that amount to approximately $8,000 per annum per franchised outlet. A reasonable profit margin on the provision of the continuing services is deemed to be 20% of revenues received. (iii) On 1 September 19W9 Jenson received total subscriptions in advance of $240,000. The subscriptions are for 24 monthly publications of a magazine produced by Jenson. At the year end Jenson had produced and despatched six of the 24 publications. The total cost of producing the magazine is estimated at $192,000 with each publication costing a broadly similar amount. Required: Describe how Jenson should treat each of the above examples in its financial statements in the year to 31 March 20X0. (8 marks) Chapter 15: Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets Test your understanding 20 ­ Bodyline Question 1 IAS 37 Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets was issued in 1998. The Standard sets out the principles of accounting for these items and clarifies when provisions should and should not be made. Prior to its issue, the inappropriate use of provisions had been an area where companies had been accused of manipulating the financial statements and of creative accounting. Required: (a) Describe the nature of provisions and the accounting requirements for them contained in IAS 37. (6 marks) (b) Explain why there is a need for an accounting standard in this area. Illustrate your answer with three practical examples of how the standard addresses controversial issues. (6 marks) 368 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 (c) Bodyline sells sports goods and clothing through a chain of retail outlets. It offers customers a full refund facility for any goods returned within 28 days of their purchase provided they are unused and in their original packaging. In addition, all goods carry a warranty against manufacturing defects for 12 months from their date of purchase. For most goods the manufacturer underwrites this warranty such that Bodyline is credited with the cost of the goods that are returned as faulty. Goods purchased from one manufacturer, Header, are sold to Bodyline at a negotiated discount which is designed to compensate Bodyline for manufacturing defects. No refunds are given by Header, thus Bodyline has to bear the cost of any manufacturing faults of these goods. Bodyline makes a uniform mark up on cost of 25% on all goods it sells, except for those supplied from Header on which it makes a mark up on cost of 40%. Sales of goods manufactured by Header consistently account for 20% of all Bodyline’s sales. Sales in the last 28 days of the trading year to 30 September 20X3 were $1,750,000. Past trends reliably indicate that 10% of all goods are returned under the 28­day return facility. These are not faulty goods. Of these 70% are later resold at the normal selling price and the remaining 30% are sold as ‘sale’ items at half the normal retail price. In addition to the above expected returns, an estimated $160,000 (at selling price) of the goods sold during the year will have manufacturing defects and have yet to be returned by customers. Goods returned as faulty have no resale value. Required: Describe the nature of the above warranty/return facilities and calculate the provision Bodyline is required to make at 30 September 20X3: (i) for goods subject to the 28 day returns policy, and (ii) for goods that are likely to be faulty. (8 marks) KAPLAN PUBLISHING 369 Questions & Answers (d) Rockbuster has recently purchased an item of earth moving plant at a total cost of $24 million. The plant has an estimated life of 10 years with no residual value, however its engine will need replacing after every 5,000 hours of use at an estimated cost of $7.5 million. The directors of Rockbuster intend to depreciate the plant at $2.4 million ($24 million/10 years) per annum and make a provision of $1,500 ($7.5 million/5,000 hours) per hour of use for the replacement of the engine. Required: Explain how the plant should be treated in accordance with International Accounting Standards and comment on the Directors’ proposed treatment. (5 marks) (Total: 25 marks) Chapter 16: Taxation Test your understanding 21 ­ Energiser Question 1 The following extracted balances relate to Energiser at 31 December 20X4: $000 Ordinary shares of 20c each Retained profits 1 January 2004 6% redeemable preference shares Trade payables Income tax Deferred tax – 1 January 2004 Land and buildings – cost Plant and equipment ­ cost Depreciation 1 January 2004 – land and buildings Depreciation 1 January 2004 – plant and equipment Trade receivables Inventory – 1 January 2004 Bank revenue 370 $000 100,000 128,400 60,000 73,800 4,200 29,400 300,000 217,200 18,000 49,200 62,400 51,300 7,400 600,000 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Purchases Distribution expenses Administration expenses Preference dividend Interim ordinary dividend 316,900 52,800 46,400 3,600 5,000 ––––––––– ––––––––– 1,063,000 1,063,000 ––––––––– ––––––––– Additional information (1) Revenue includes $100 million for an item of plant sold on 1 September 20X4. The plant had a book value of $80 million at the date of its sale, which was charged to cost of sales. On the same date, Energiser entered into an agreement to lease back the plant for the next five years (being the estimated remaining life of the plant). Energiser has negotiated extended credit so that the first instalment of capital and interest on the lease falls after 31 December 2005, more than one year from the year end. An arrangement of this type is deemed to have financing cost of 12% per annum. No depreciation has been charged on the item of plant in the current year. (2) The inventory at 31 December 20X4 was valued at cost of $57 million. This includes $9 million of slow moving goods. Energiser believes that it will be able to sell these goods for only $4 million. (3) The land and buildings cost of $300 million includes land at a cost of $60 million. The remaining life of the building as at 1 January 20X4 was estimated at 40 years. (4) Plant and equipment (other than that referred to in note 1 above) is depreciated at 20% per annum on the reducing balance basis. All depreciation is to be charged to cost of sales. (5) The balance on the income tax account in the trial balance is the result of the settlement of the previous year’s tax charge. The directors have estimated the provision for income tax for the year to 31 December 20X4 at $18.4 million. For the deferred tax provision, the only temporary differences are accelerated capital allowances. At 31 December 20X4 these temporary differences were $91 million. Assume an income tax rate of 30%. (6) On 1 January 20X4 Energiser issued a loan note, the details of which are: KAPLAN PUBLISHING Nominal value issued $60 million Discount on issue 6% Nominal interest rate 8% 371 Questions & Answers The loan note is redeemable on 31 December 20X7 at a premium of 10%. Interest is payable annually on 31 December. Energiser has not yet made any entries in respect of this loan note. (7) The outstanding receivable balance of a major customer amounting to $12 million was factored to Debtco on 1 December 20X4. The terms of the factoring were: – Debtco will pay 80% of the gross debtor outstanding to Energiser immediately. – The balance will be paid (less the charges below) when the trade receivable is collected in full. Any amount of the debt outstanding after four months will be transferred back to Energiser at its full book value. – Debtco will charge 1% per month on the net amount owing from Energiser at the beginning of each month. Debtco had not collected any of the factored debtor by the year­end. – Energiser debited the cash received from Debtco to its bank account and removed the debtor from its sales ledger. It has prudently charged the difference as an administration cost. (8) The directors do not wish to propose a final ordinary dividend. Required: Prepare Energiser’s income statement for the year ended 31 December 20X4 and its statement of financial position at that date. These should be in a form suitable for publication. (25 marks) All workings must be clearly shown. Test your understanding 22 ­ Telenorth Question 2 The following trial balance relates to Telenorth at 30 September 20X1: $000 Sales Inventory 1 October 20X0 Purchases Distribution expenses Administration expenses Loan note interest paid 372 $000 283,460 12,400 147,200 22,300 34,440 300 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Interim dividends ­ ordinary ­ preference Investment income 25 year leasehold building– cost Plant and equipment – cost Computer system – cost Investments – at valuation Depreciation 1 October 20X0 (note 2) ­ leasehold ­ plant and equipment ­ computer system Trade receivables (note 3) Bank overdraft Trade payables Deferred tax (note 4) Ordinary shares of $1 each Suspense account (note 5) 6% Loan notes (issued 1 October 20X0) 8% Preference shares (qualifying as equity shares) Revaluation reserve (note 4) Retained earnings 1 October 20X0 2,000 480 1,500 56,250 55,000 35,000 34,500 18,000 12,800 9,600 35,700 1,680 17,770 5,200 20,000 26,000 10,000 12,000 3,400 14,160 ––––––– ––––––– 435,570 435,570 ––––––– ––––––– The following notes are relevant: (1) Counting of inventory could not be conducted by Telenorth until 4 October 20X1 due to operational reasons. The value of the inventory on the premises at this date was $16 million at cost. Between the year­end and the inventory count the following transactions have been identified: Normal sales at a mark up on cost of 40% $1,400,000 Sales on a sale or return basis at a mark up on cost of 30% $650,000 Goods received at cost $820,000 All sales and purchases had been correctly recorded in the period in which they occurred. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 373 Questions & Answers (2) Telenorth has the following depreciation policy: – Leasehold – straight­line. – Plant and equipment – five years straight line with residual values estimated at $5,000,000. – Computer system – 40% per annum reducing balance. Depreciation of the leasehold and plant is treated as cost of sales; depreciation of the computer system is an administration expense. (3) The outstanding balance (receivable) of a major customer amounting to $12 million was factored to Kwikfinance on 1 September 20X1. The terms of the factoring were: – Kwikfinance will pay 80% of the gross balance receivable to Telenorth immediately. – The balance will be paid (less the charges below) when the receivable is collected in full. Any amount of the debt outstanding after four months will be transferred back to Telenorth at its full book value. – Kwikfinance will charge 1.0% per month of the net amount owing from Telenorth at the beginning of each month. Kwikfinance had not collected any of the factored receivable balance by the year­end. Telenorth debited the cash from Kwikfinance to its bank account and removed the receivable balance from its sales ledger. It has prudently charged the difference as an administration cost. (4) A provision for tax, excluding the amount of any withholding taxes, of $23.4 million for the year to 30 September 20X1 is required. The deferred tax liability is to be increased by $2.2 million, of which $1 million relates to other comprehensive income and is to be charged direct to the revaluation reserve. (5) The suspense account contains the proceeds of two share issues: 374 – The exercise of all the outstanding directors’ share options of four million shares on 1 October 20X0 at $2 each. – A fully subscribed rights issue on 1 July 20X1 of 1 for 4 held at a price of $3 each. The stock market price of Telenorth’s shares immediately before the rights issue was $4. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Required: (a) (i) prepare the income statement of Telenorth for the year to 30 September 20X1, and (9 marks) (ii) prepare a statement of financial position as at 30 September 20X1 in accordance with current International Accounting Standards as far as the information permits. (11 marks) (Total: 20 marks) Notes to the financial statements are not required. Test your understanding 23 ­ Picklette Question 3 The following information has been extracted from the books of Picklette for the year to 31 March 20X9. Administrative expenses Interest paid Called up share capital (ordinary shares of $1 each) Dividend Cash at bank and in hand Income tax (remaining balance from previous year) Warranty provision Distribution costs Land and buildings: at cost accumulated depreciation (at 1 April 20X8) KAPLAN PUBLISHING Dr $000 170 5 Cr $000 200 6 9 10 90 240 210 48 375 Questions & Answers Plant and machinery: at cost accumulated depreciation (at 1 April 20X8) Retained earnings (at 1 April 20X8) Loan Purchases Sales Inventory (at 1 April 20X8) Trade payables Trade receivables 125 75 270 80 470 1,300 150 60 728 ––––– 2,123 ––––– ––––– 2,123 ––––– Additional information (1) Inventory at 31 March 20X9 was valued at $250,000. (2) Buildings and plant and machinery are depreciated on a straight­ line basis (assuming no residual value) at the following rates: On cost: Buildings Plant and machinery 5% 20% (3) Land at cost was $110,000. Land is not depreciated. (4) There were no purchases or sales of non­current assets during the year to 31 March 20X9. (5) The depreciation charges for the year to 31 March 20X9 are to be apportioned as follows: Cost of sales Distribution costs Administrative expenses 60% 20% 20% (6) Income taxes is for the year to 31 March 20X9 (at a rate of 30%) are estimated to be $135,000. (7) The directors paid a dividend of 3p per share. The loan is repayable in five years. (8) The year end provision for warranty claims has been estimated at £75,000. Warranty costs are charged to administrative expenses. 376 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Required: Insofar as the information permits, prepare Picklette plc’s income statement for the year to 31 March 20X9 and a statement of financial position as at that date without accompanying notes. (15 marks) Chapter 17: Reporting financial performance Test your understanding 24 ­ Mrs Harper Question 1 You are a partner in a small audit and accounting practice. You have just completed the audit and finalised the financial statements of a small family owned company in discussion with its managing director Mrs Harper. After the meeting Mrs Harper has asked for your help. She has obtained the published financial statements of several quoted companies in which she is considering buying some shares as a personal investment. She presents you with the following information: (a) In the year to 30 September 20X2, two companies, Gamma and Toga, reported identical profits before tax of $100 million. Information in the Chairmen’s reports said both companies also expected profits from their core activities (to be interpreted as from continuing operations) to grow by 10% in the following year. Mrs Harper has extracted information from the income statements and made the following summary: Gamma Toga $ million $ million Operating profit: Continuing activities 70 90 Acquisitions nil 50 Discontinued activities 30 (40) –––– –––– 100 100 –––– –––– A note to the financial statements of Toga said that both the discontinuation and acquisition occurred on 1 April 20X2 and were part of an overall plan to focus on its traditional core activities after incurring large losses on a new foreign venture. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 377 Questions & Answers Required: (i) Briefly explain to Mrs Harper why information on discontinued operations is useful. (3 marks) (ii) Calculate the expected operating profit for both companies for the year to 30 September 20X3 (assuming the Chairmen’s growth forecasts are correct): – in the absence of information of the discontinued operations, and – based on the information provided above. (4 marks) (b) Mrs Harper has noticed that the tax charge for a company called Stepper is $5 million on profits before tax of $35 million. This is an effective rate of tax of 14.3%. Another company Jenni has an income tax charge of $10 million on profit before tax of $30 million. This is an effective rate of tax of 33.3% yet both companies state the rate of income tax applicable to them is 25%. Mrs Harper has also noticed that in the statements of cash flows each company has paid the same amount of tax of $8 million. Required: Advise Mrs Harper of the possible reasons why the income tax charge in the financial statements as a percentage of the profit before tax may not be the same as the applicable income tax rate, and why the tax paid in the statement of cash flows may not be the same as the tax charge in the income statement. (6 marks) (Total: 13 marks) 378 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Test your understanding 25 ­ Bewley Question 2 On 1 January 20X0 the Board of Bewley approved a resolution to close the whole of its loss­making engineering operation. A binding agreement to dispose of the assets was signed shortly afterwards. The sale will be completed on 10 June 20X0 at an agreed value of $30 million. The costs of the closure are estimated at: • • • • $2 million for redundancy/retrenchment. • Operating losses for the period from 1 April 20X0 to the date of sale are estimated at $4.5 million. $3 million in penalty costs for non­completion of contracted orders. $1.5 million for associated professional costs. Losses on the sale of the net assets and liabilities, whose book value at 31 March 20X0 was $66 million and $20 million respectively. Bewley accounts for its various operations on a divisional basis. Required: Advise the directors on the correct treatment of the closure of the engineering division for the year ended 31 March 20X0. (5 marks) Chapter 18: Earnings per share Test your understanding 26 ­ Rodney Miller Question 1 A client, Rodney Miller has obtained the published financial statements of several quoted companies in which he is considering buying some shares as a personal investment. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 379 Questions & Answers He has obtained the following information from the published financial statements of one of the companies, Taylor: Earnings per share: Year to 30 September Basic earnings per share 20X2 20X1 25 cents 20 cents The earnings per share is based on attributable earnings of $50 million ($30 million in 20X1) and 200 million ordinary shares in issue throughout the year (150 million weighted average number of ordinary shares in 20X1). SFP extracts: 8% Convertible loan stock 20X2 $ million 200 20X1 $ million 200 The loan stock is convertible to ordinary shares in 20X4 on the basis of 70 new shares for each $100 of loan stock. Note to the financial statements: There are directors’ share options (in issue since 19W9) that allow Taylor’s directors to subscribe for a total of 50 million new ordinary shares at a price of $1.50 each. (Assume the current rate of income tax for Taylor is 25% and the market price of its ordinary shares throughout the year has been $2.50) Rodney Miller has read that the trend of the earnings per share is a reliable measure of a company’s profit trend. He cannot understand why the increase in profits is 67% ($30 million to $50 million), but the increase in the earnings per share is only 25% (20 cents to 25 cents). He is also confused by the company also quoting a diluted earnings per share figure, which is lower than the basic earnings per share. Required: (i) Explain why the trend of earnings per share may be different from the trend of the reported profit, and which is the more useful measure of performance. (3 marks) 380 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 (ii) Calculate the diluted earnings per share for Taylor based on the effect of the convertible loan stock and the directors’ share options for the year to 30 September 20X2 (ignore comparatives). (5 marks) (iii) Explain the relevance of the diluted earnings per share measure. (4 marks) (Total: 12 marks) Test your understanding 27 ­ Niagara’s Question 2 Extracts of Niagara’s consolidated income statement for the year to 31 March 20X3 are: Sales Cost of sales Gross profit Other operating expenses Finance costs Impairment of non­current assets Income from associates Profit before tax Taxation Profit for the period KAPLAN PUBLISHING $000 36,000 (21,000) –––––– 15,000 (6,200) (800) (4,000) 1,500 –––––– 5,500 (2,800) –––––– 2,700 –––––– 381 Questions & Answers Attributable to: Shareholders of the parent Non­controlling interests 2,585 115 –––––– 2,700 –––––– The impairment of non­current assets attracted tax relief of $1 million which has been included in the tax charge. Niagara paid an interim ordinary dividend of 3c per share in June 20X2 and declared a final dividend on 25 March 20X3 of 6c per share. The issued share capital of Niagara on 1 April 20X2 was: Ordinary shares of 25c each 8% Preference shares $3 million $1 million The preference shares are non­redeemable. The company also had in issue $2 million 7% convertible loan stock dated 20X5. The loan stock will be redeemed at par in 20X5 or converted to ordinary shares on the basis of 40 new shares for each $100 of loan stock at the option of the stockholders. Niagara’s income tax rate is 30%. There are also in existence directors’ share warrants (issued in 20X1) which entitle the directors to receive 750,000 new shares in total in 20X5 at no cost to the directors. 382 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 The following share issues took place during the year to 31 March 20X3: • 1 July 20X2; a rights issue of 1 new share at $1.50 for every 5 shares held. The market price of Niagara’s shares the day before the rights was $2.40. • 1 October 20X2; an issue of $1 million 6% non­redeemable preference shares at par. Both issues were fully subscribed. Niagara’s basic earnings per share in the year to 31 March 20X2 was correctly disclosed as 24c. Required: Calculate for Niagara for the year to 31 March 20X3: (i) the basic earnings per share including the comparative (4 marks) (ii) the fully diluted earnings per share (ignore comparative); and advise a prospective investor of the significance of the diluted earnings per share figure. (6 marks) (Total: 10 marks) KAPLAN PUBLISHING 383 Questions & Answers Chapter 19: Interpretation of financial statements Test your understanding 28 ­ Webster Question 1 Webster is a diversified holding company that is looking to acquire an engineering company. Two private limited engineering companies, Cole and Darwin, are available for sale. The summarised financial statements for the year to 31 March 20X0 of both companies are as follows: Income statements: Cole $000 Sales revenues (note 1) Opening inventory Purchases (note 2) Closing inventory Gross profit Operating expenses Debenture interest Overdraft interest (note 5) 450 2,030 ––––– 2,480 (540) ––––– $000 3,000 (1,940) ––––– 1,060 480 80 nil ––––– Net profit 384 Darwin $000 $000 4,400 720 3,080 ––––– 3,800 (850) (2,950) ––––– ––––– 1,450 964 nil 10 ––––– (560) ––––– 500 ––––– (974) ––––– 476 ––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Statements of financial position: Cole $000 Non­current assets Property (note 3) Plant (note 4) Current assets Inventory Accounts receivable Bank Non­current liabilities 10% Debenture Current liabilities Accounts payable Overdraft Total equity and liabilities KAPLAN PUBLISHING $000 $000 1,140 1,200 ––––– 2,340 540 522 20 ––––– Total assets Equity and liabilities: Equity shares of $1 each Reserves: Revaluation reserve Retained earnings 1 April 19X9 Profit for year to 31 March 20X0 Darwin 1,082 ––––– 3,422 ––––– $000 1,900 1,200 ––––– 3,100 850 750 nil ––––– 1,600 ––––– 4,700 ––––– 1,000 500 nil 700 684 1,912 500 1,184 476 2,388 ––––– ––––– 2,184 ––––– ––––– 3,588 800 438 nil ––––– 438 ––––– 3,422 ––––– nil 562 550 ––––– 1,112 ––––– 4,700 ––––– 385 Questions & Answers Webster bases its preliminary assessment of target companies on certain key ratios. These are listed below with the relevant figures for Cole and Darwin calculated from the above financial statements: Cole ROCE 500 + 80 ––––––––––– 2,184 + 80 476 ––––––––––– 3,588 Asset turnover (3,000/2,984) (4,400/3,588) Gross profit margin Net profit margin Accounts receivable collection period Accounts payable payment period × 100 × 100 Darwin 19.4% 13.3% 1.01 35.3% 16.7% 64 days 1.23 33.0% 10.8% 62 days 79 days 67 days Note: capital employed is defined as shareholders’ funds plus long­term debt at the year end; asset turnover is sales revenues divided by gross assets less current liabilities. The following additional information has been obtained: (1) Cole is part of the Velox Group. On 1 March 20X0 it was permitted by its holding company to sell goods at a price of $500,000 to Brander, a fellow subsidiary. Cole’s normal selling price for these goods would have been $375,000. In addition Brander was instructed to pay for the goods immediately. Cole normally allows a three month payment period to customers. 386 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 (2) On 1 January 20X0 Cole purchased $275,000 (cost price to Cole) of its materials from Advent, another member of the Velox Group. Advent was also instructed to depart from its normal trading terms that would have resulted in a charge of $300,000 to Cole for these goods. The Group’s finance director also authorised a four­month payment period on this sale. Normal payment terms in this industry would be to receive two months’ credit from suppliers. Cole had sold all of these goods at the year­end. (3) Non­current assets: Details relating to the two companies’ non­current assets at 31 March 20X0 are: Depreciation Book value – property – plant Cost/ revaluation $000 3,000 6,000 $000 1,860 4,800 Darwin – property – plant 2,000 3,000 100 1,800 $000 1,140 1,200 ––––– 2,340 ––––– 1,900 1,200 ––––– 3,100 ––––– Cole Both companies own very similar properties. Darwin’s property was revalued to $2,000,000 at the beginning of the current year (i.e. 1 April 19W9). On this date Cole’s property, which is carried at cost less depreciation, had a book value of $1,200,000. Its current value (on the same basis as Darwin’s property) was also $2,000,000. On this date (1 April 19W9) both properties had the same remaining life of 20 years. (4) Darwin purchased new plant costing $600,000 in February 20X0. In line with company policy a full year’s depreciation at 20% per annum has been charged on all plant owned at the year­end. The plant is still being tested and will not come on­stream until next year. The purchase of the plant was largely financed by an overdraft facility that resulted in the interest cost shown in the income statement. Both companies depreciate plant over a five­year life. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 387 Questions & Answers (5) The bank overdraft that would have been required but for the favourable treatment towards Cole in respect of the items in (1) and (2) above, would have attracted interest of $15,000 in the year to 31 March 20X0. Required: (a) Restate the financial statements of Cole and Darwin for the year to 31 March 20X0 in order that they may be considered comparable for decision making purposes. State any assumptions you make (10 marks) (b) Recalculate the key ratios used by Webster and, together with any other relevant points, comment on how the revised ratios may affect the relative assessment of the two companies. (10 marks) (Total: 20 marks) Test your understanding 29 ­ Judicious Question 2 You are the assistant financial controller of Judicious. One of your company’s credit controllers has asked you to consider the account balance of one of your customers, Breadline. He is concerned at the pattern of payments and increasing size and age of the account balance. As part of company policy he has obtained the most recently filed financial statements of Breadline and these are summarised below. A note to the financial statements of Breadline states that it is a wholly owned subsidiary of Wheatmaster, and its main activities are the production and distribution of bakery products to wholesalers. By coincidence your company’s Chief Executive has been made aware that Breadline may be available for sale. She has asked for your opinion on whether Breadline would make a suitable addition to the group’s portfolio. 388 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Breadline Income statement year to: Sales revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Operating expenses Finance costs – loan note – overdraft Profit before tax Taxation Profit for the year 31 December 20X1 $000 $000 8,500 (5,950) –––––– 2,550 (560) 10 10 (20) –––––– –––––– 1,970 (470) –––––– 1,500 31 December 20X0 $000 $000 6,500 (4,810) –––––– 1,690 (660) nil 5 (5) –––––– –––––– 1,025 (175) –––––– 850 Breadline paid no dividend in 20X0 but paid a dividend of $900,000 for the year ending 31 December 20X1. Statements of financial position as at: Non­current 31 December 20X1 31 December assets 20X0 Freehold premises nil 1,250 at valuation Leasehold 2,500 nil premises Plant 1,620 750 –––––– –––––– 4,120 2,000 Current assets Inventory 370 240 Accounts receivable 960 600 Bank nil 1,330 250 1,090 –––––– –––––– –––––– –––––– Total assets 5,450 3,090 ______ –––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING 389 Questions & Answers Equity and liabilities Equity: Ordinary shares of $1 each Reserves: Share premium Revaluation reserve (re freehold premises) Retained earnings Non­current liabilities 2% Loan note Current liabilities Accounts payable Overdraft Total equity and liabilities 500 200 nil 3,000 –––––– 100 nil 700 3,200 –––––– 3,700 1,700 –––––– 500 1,030 220 –––––– 1,250 –––––– 5,450 –––––– 2,400 –––––– 2,500 nil 590 nil –––––– 590 –––––– 3,090 –––––– From your company’s own records you have ascertained that sales to Breadline for the year to 20X1 and 20X0 were $1,200,000 and $800,000 respectively and the year­end accounts receivable balances were $340,000 and $100,000 respectively. Normal credit terms, which should apply to Breadline, are that payment is due 30 days after the end of the month of sale. You are also aware that the company has not changed its address and is trading from the same premises. A note to Breadline’s financial statements says that the profit on the disposal of the freehold premises has been included in cost of sales as this is where the depreciation on the freehold was charged. 390 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Note: a commercial rate of interest on the loan note of Breadline would be 8% per annum. Required: (a) Describe the matters that may be relevant when entity financial statements are used to assess the performance of a company that is a wholly owned subsidiary. (5 marks) Note: your answer should give attention to related party issues. (b) From the information above and with the aid of suitable ratios, prepare a report for your Chief Executive on the overall financial position of Breadline. Your answer should include reference to matters in the financial statements of Breadline that may give you cause for concern or require further investigation. (20 marks) (Total: 25 marks) Chapter 20: Cash flow statements Test your understanding 30 ­ Placid Question 1 The following are the financial statements, with an extract from the notes, of Placid. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 391 Questions & Answers Placid income statement for the year ended 31 March 2006 $ million Sales 1,162 Cost of sales (866) –––– Gross profit 296 Distribution costs (47) Administrative expenses (110) –––– 139 79 (55) –––– 163 (24) –––– 139 –––– Operating profit Interest received Interest paid Profit before taxation Taxation Profit for the financial year Placid statement of financial position as at 31 March 2006 $m $m $m Non­current assets Intangible assets 277 Tangible assets 1,023 Investments 69 ––––– 1,369 Current assets Inventory Trade receivables Investments Cash at bank and in hand 246 460 ­ 250 ––––– 234 600 68 ––––– 902 128 353 20 124 ––––– 956 ––––– 2,325 ––––– 392 2005 $m 625 ––––– 1,527 ––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Equity Called up share capital Share premium Revaluation reserve Retained profits Non­current liabilities Debenture stock Deferred taxation Current liabilities Overdrafts Trade payables Taxation 29 447 251 165 ––––– 892 24 377 ­ 48 ––––– 449 755 4 555 2 388 244 42 ––––– 185 311 25 ––––– 674 ––––– 2,325 ––––– 521 ––––– 1,527 ––––– Notes: (1) The non­current asset investments relate to the shares held by Placid in a competitor company. (2) The intangible assets are patents used in production. (3) The current asset investments were shares in Sparks and Fencer plc, held for a short­term gain. The sale of the current asset investments realised $25 million. The gain on the disposal has been subsumed into interest received. (4) The trading profit is after charging depreciation on the tangible assets of $22 million and amortisation on the intangible assets of $7 million. The revaluation reserve relates wholly to tangible assets. (5) During the year ended 31 March 2006, plant and machinery, costing $1,464 million, written down to $244 million at 31 March 2005, was sold for $250 million. The profit on disposal has been subsumed into cost of sales. (6) A proportion of the debenture stock was issued at par for oil used in production, the remaining $130m was issued for cash. (7) During the year ended 31 March 2006 25 million 20p shares were issued at a premium of $2.80. (8) During the year ended 31 March 2006 an equity dividend of $22 million was paid. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 393 Questions & Answers Required: (a) Prepare a statement of cash flows of Placid for the year ended 31 March 2006. (18 marks) (b) Comment on the working capital and cash flow of Placid. (7 marks) (Total: 25 marks) Test your understanding 31 ­ Nedberg Question 2 The financial statements of Nedberg for the year to 30 September 20X2, together with the comparative statement of financial position for the year to 30 September 20X1 are shown below: Income statement – year to 30 September 20X2 Sales revenue Cost of sales (note 1) Gross profit for period Operating expenses (note 1) Interest – Loan note Profit before tax Taxation Net profit for the period 394 $m 3,820 (2,620) ––––– 1,200 (280) ––––– 920 (30) ––––– 890 (270) ––––– 620 ––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Statements of financial position as at 30 September: 20X2 Non­current assets $m Property, plant and equipment Intangible assets (note 2) 20X1 $m 1,890 $m 670 ––––– 2,560 $m 1,830 300 ––––– 2,130 Current assets Inventory Accounts receivable Cash 1,420 990 70 ––––– Total assets Equity and liabilities Ordinary shares of $1 each Reserves Share premium Revaluation Retained earnings Non­current liabilities (note 3) Current liabilities (note 4) Total equity and liabilities 2,480 ––––– 5,040 ––––– 940 680 nil ––––– 1,620 ––––– 3,750 ––––– 750 500 350 140 1,910 ––––– 3,150 870 100 nil 1,600 ––––– 2,200 540 1,020 ––––– 5,040 ––––– 1,010 ––––– 3,750 ––––– Notes to the financial statements: (1) Cost of sales includes depreciation of property, plant and equipment of $320 million and a loss on the sale of plant of $50 million. It also includes a credit for the amortisation of government grants. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 395 Questions & Answers (2) Intangible non­current assets: 1 Deferred development expenditure Goodwill 3. 4. 5. 396 Non­current liabilities: 10% loan note Government grants Deferred tax 20X2 20X1 $m 470 200 ––––– 670 ––––– $m 100 200 ––––– 300 ––––– 300 260 310 ––––– 870 ––––– 100 300 140 ––––– 540 ––––– Current liabilities: Accounts payable Bank overdraft Accrued loan interest Taxation 875 730 nil 115 15 5 130 160 ––––– ––––– 1,020 1,010 ––––– ––––– Extract from statement of changes in equity – Movement on retained earnings: Opening balance 1,600 1,000 Total comprehensive income for the 620 800 year Dividends – interim (320) (200) Transfer from revaluation reserve 10 ––––– ––––– Closing balance 1,910 1,600 ––––– ––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 The following additional information is relevant: (i) Intangible non­current assets: The company successfully completed the development of a new product during the current year, capitalising a further $500 million before amortisation charges for the period. (ii) Property, plant and equipment/revaluation reserve: – The company revalued its buildings by $200 million on 1 October 20X1. The surplus was recorded as other comprehensive income and credited to a revaluation reserve. – New plant was acquired during the year at a cost of $250 million and a government grant of $50 million was received for this plant. – On 1 October 20X1 a bonus issue of 1 new share for every 10 held was made from the revaluation reserve. – $10 million has been transferred from the revaluation reserve to realised profits as a year­end adjustment in respect of the additional depreciation created by the revaluation. – The remaining movement on property, plant and equipment was due to the disposal of obsolete plant. (iii) Share issues: In addition to the bonus issue referred to above Nedberg made a further issue of ordinary shares for cash. Required: (a) A statement of cash flows for Nedberg for the year to 30 September 20X2 prepared in accordance with IAS 7 Statement of Cash Flows. (20 marks) (b) Comment briefly on the financial position of Nedberg as portrayed by the information in your statement of cash flows. (5 marks) (Total: 25 marks) KAPLAN PUBLISHING 397 Questions & Answers Test your understanding answers Test your understanding 1 ­ Recost Answer 1 (a) The main drawback of the use of historic cost accounts for assessing the performance of a business is that they do not take into account the current values of assets and, to a lesser extent, liabilities. This can become a serious problem and give misleading information when either specific or general price inflation rates are considered to be high. The effect is that many of the values of the assets in the statement of financial position are understated, and, partly because of related depreciation, profits tend to be overstated. More detailed criticisms of historic cost accounts during a period of rising prices are: Effects on the statement of financial position (i) Most non­current assets can be considerably understated in terms of their current worth. The most affected assets tend to be land and buildings, investments and some plant. (ii) In general net current assets tend not to be affected by inflation mainly because they are monetary in nature. The possible exception is trading inventories. (iii) Liabilities tend to be ignored when current values are discussed. This may be an error because, for example, a long term loan carrying a fixed rate of interest, may have a current value that is considerably different to when it was taken out (ignoring the possibility of any repayments). This is because current interest rates may have changed (often as a reaction to levels of inflation) since the loan was originally taken out. (iv) The accounting equation dictates that if the net assets are understated, then so too are shareholders’ funds. Effects on the income statement Many costs tend to be understated in terms of their current value. Where this occurs it means the profit is overstated in as much as the use of lower costs leads to a higher profit. Many commentators argue that pure historical cost profits are made up of a current operating profit (see below) plus inflationary gains relating to the: – 398 Costs of goods sold (both purchased and manufactured). This can be mitigated, but not completely removed, by the use of LIFO, however this is not common practice in many countries and is now prohibited by IAS 2 Inventories. KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 – Depreciation charges for non­current assets. In historic cost accounts these are based on historical values rather than current values, and therefore understate the values of the assets that have been used (consumed) during the period. – Some methods of accounting for inflation include monetary working capital and/or ‘gearing’ adjustments to historical cost profits. These are intended to reflect the inflation effects of holding net monetary working capital and debt. The above combined effects lead to the following criticisms and limitations of the use of historic cost accounts to assess a business’s performance: Lack of comparability It may be invalid to compare the results of two companies. One company may have assets that are relatively old (and of lower cost) whereas another company may have similar, but more recently purchased (and of higher cost) assets. In effect such companies would have a similar operating capacity, but it would be recorded at different values. This situation can also be found within a single company that has operating divisions with similar characteristics to the above scenario. Management may assess their relative performance using historical costs (which would be an invalid basis) to make decisions relating to future investment or even closure. There is also a lack of comparability between a company’s current year’s results and those of previous years i.e. trend analysis may be distorted. Conceptual inconsistency Accounting theorists sometimes argue that historic cost accounts are not internally consistent because they are in fact ‘mixed value’ accounts. This means that some historical costs are at current values, whereas other historical costs are at out­of­date values. Thus current values, of say sales revenues, are being matched with out­of­date values such as depreciation relating to older assets. Many important ratios which are calculated as a basis for interpreting and assessing company performance can be distorted by inflation. Important examples are: return on capital employed, profit margins, many asset turnover ratios, gearing levels and earnings per share. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 399 Questions & Answers The misleading effects of the above on different users Investors may find it difficult to compare the results of different companies as a basis for investment decisions. A shareholder may be tempted to accept a low bid for his/her shares if weight is given to the asset backing, based on book values, of the shares. Dividends may seem low in relation to reported profits, this may be because management is recommending dividends based on a current operating profit. Employees may make high wage demands based on reported profit rather than current operating profits. Governments generally tax reported profits which means companies pay tax on higher, inflation boosted, profits. (b) The advantages and criticisms of General (Current) Purchasing Power and Current Cost Accounting are set out below: General (Current) Purchasing Power Accounts It is claimed that general purchasing power (GPP) accounts retain many of the advantages of historic cost accounts and overcome some of their deficiencies. Like historic cost accounts GPP accounts are transaction based, and are therefore objective and verifiable. This is because they are a restatement of historic cost accounts (which possess the above qualities) adjusted for the movement in an inflation index, usually published by the government. Because the income statement and the statement of financial position are adjusted for price movements over time, GPP accounts are said to be comparable between companies and over time. This overcomes many of the difficulties of historic cost accounts. If the index used to adjust the historic cost accounts is a consumer based index (as it usually is), then they are more appropriate to shareholders because this index is well understood by them and more appropriate to their spending patterns. The figure for shareholders funds is said to be a measure of the spending power (or consumption) that is being forgone in making (or holding) the investment in the company, and can be judged in those terms. Opponents or critics of GPP accounting argue that many of the claimed advantages may not be true. GPP accounts suffer from some practical as well as theoretical problems: 400 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 (i) GPP values are not real values, current or otherwise; they are the result of statistical calculations. For many companies the GPP values of their non­current assets will only be similar to their real (current) values if the movement of the specific price indexes relating to those assets is similar to that of the General Price Index. An extreme case of this problem would occur where there was general (retail) price inflation, but the company trades in an activity where the prices of the goods they manufacture and supply are falling. Hi­fi, video and computer equipment may be examples of this. Average measures of inflation, particularly if they are measures of consumer inflation, are not usually appropriate to account for specific price inflation experienced by companies, which differs from company to company. (ii) Most items in the income statement are adjusted by the average inflation factor for the period. During periods of inflation this is greater than one and can give the general effect of increased profits. Although this effect is mitigated by higher depreciation charges, GPP profits for profitable companies can be higher than their historic cost profits. A major criticism of historic cost accounts is that they overstate operating profits, GPP accounts can worsen this problem rather than solve it. Highly geared companies tend to show even greater GPP profits (due to gains on net monetary liabilities), and such companies are more vulnerable when inflation is high. This is because interest rates are often increased by Governments in an attempt to control inflation. This has a detrimental effect on companies with high variable rate borrowings. Current Cost Accounting Current cost accounting (CCA) principles, from a conceptual point of view, are more soundly based and therefore more difficult to criticise than GPP accounts. They correct most of the limitations of historic cost accounts that are due to increased price levels. They reflect the current values of a company’s specific assets although this is not necessarily the current cost of those assets. The reported current operating profit is considered to be more relevant to many decisions such as dividend distribution, employee wage claims and even as a basis for taxation. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 401 Questions & Answers The problems of CCA lie in their preparation and understanding. In practical terms it can be very difficult to determine the current value of assets, and many alternative forms of current value exist e.g. replacement cost, realisable value and value in use. Methods of determining current costs include the use of manufacturers’ price lists for plant and inventory, professional revaluation of assets e.g. land and buildings and the use of specific price indexes published by government agencies. Whatever method is used it is often subjective and sometimes complex. This makes the cost of the preparation and audit of current cost accounts expensive. An interesting point arising from the past use of CCA in some countries is that when current cost results of companies were published there was no significant differential change in share prices relating to the current cost information. The Efficient Market Hypothesis would suggest that if CCA provided ‘new’ information then market prices would react. An interpretation of the above observation is that the information revealed by CCA was already ‘known’ by the market makers and imputed into share prices. Thus many feel that the expense of producing CCA gives no benefit to users. This perhaps explains why historic cost accounts are still dominant in financial reporting. Test your understanding 2 ­ Hepburn and Salter Answer 1 The directors do appear to be misunderstanding the basis of determining subsidiary company status. IAS 27 Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements bases its definition of a subsidiary on control rather than ownership. In the case of Woodbridge, Hepburn in fact owns 6,000 of the 10,000 voting shares, and, in the absence of any other information, this would constitute control of Woodbridge by virtue of its 60% of voting rights. Therefore Woodbridge’s results should be consolidated by Hepburn from the date of its acquisition. It may be that the motive for the directors’ position is that they wish to improve group profits by avoiding consolidation of Woodbridge’s losses. This is, however, not a valid reason for exclusion from consolidation. 402 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Test your understanding 3 ­ Hanford & Stopple Answer 1 (a) Hanford consolidated statement of financial position at 30 September 20X1 Non­current assets $000 Property, plant and equipment (W8) Goodwill (W3) $000 109,510 6,850 ––––––– 116,360 Current assets Inventory (7,450 + 4,310) Accounts receivable (12,960 + 4,330 – 820 (W7)) Bank Equity and liabilities Equity attributable to the equity holders of the parent: Ordinary shares of $1 each (20,000 +10,000 (W6)) Reserves: Share premium (10,000 + 10,000 (W6)) Retained earnings (W5) 11,760 16,470 520 ––––––– 28,750 ––––––– 145,110 ––––––– 30,000 20,000 65,750 ––––––– Non­controlling interests (W4) 85,750 ––––––– 115,750 6,950 ––––––– 122,700 Non­current liabilities 8% Loan notes 20X4 Current liabilities Trade accounts payable (5,920 + 4,160 – 620 (W7)) Bank overdraft Provision for taxation (3,070 + 2,180) 6,000 9,460 1,700 5,250 ––––––– Total equity and liabilities KAPLAN PUBLISHING 16,410 ––––––– 145,110 403 Questions & Answers Workings (all figures in $000) (W1) Group Structure Hanford | 75% 6m/8m Stopple Note: the unrealised profit on the sale of the plant was initially $400,000, of this 10% i.e. $40,000 has been realised via Stopple's depreciation charge, giving a net adjustment of $360,000 to both Hanford's profits (W5) and the carrying value of the plant. (W2) Net assets in subsidiary Share capital Share premium Retained earnings (6,000 + 4,000) Fair value adjustment Administration charges At acquisition $000 8,000 2,000 10,000 4,000 –––––– 24,000 –––––– At reporting date $000 8,000 2,000 14,000 4,000 (200) –––––– 27,800 –––––– Fair value adjustments The insurance claim is a contingent asset and cannot be recognised by Stopple. IFRS revised requires Hanford to make an assessment of all assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities of Stopple at the date of acquisition. Contingent assets can only be recognised if they are virtually certain, the receipt of the claim is merely ‘highly likely’. Therefore it is not recognised by the group at the date of acquisition. Therefore the fair value adjustment is only for the land. 404 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 (W3) Goodwill ­ Proportionate share method $000 24,850 (18,000) ______ 6,850 ______ Cost of investment For 75% Net assets at acq (75% × 24,000) Goodwill (W4) Non­controlling interest 25% × 27,800 (W2) = 6,950 (W5) Consolidated retained earnings Hanford Profit on sale of plant (see below) Stopple Group share post acquisition profits (27,800 ­ 24,000) × 75% $000 63,260 (360) 2,850 –––––– 65,750 –––––– (W6) Share exchange Hanford acquired six million shares in Stopple. On the basis of an exchange of five for three, Hanford would issue 10 million new shares. The total value of the consideration is $24.85 million of which $4.85 million was for cash, therefore the value of the 10 million shares would be $20 million, or $2 each i.e. they were issued at a premium of $1 each. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 405 Questions & Answers (W7) Elimination of current accounts The difference on the current accounts is due to the invoice for central administration of $200,000. A summary of the intra­group adjustment/cancellation is: Dr Hanford’s overdraft Accounts payable Accounts receivable Cr 200 620 –––– 820 –––– 820 –––– 820 –––– (W8) Property, plant and equipment Amount from question – Hanford – Stopple Fair value adjustment Unrealised profit in transfer of plant 78,690 27,180 4,000 (360) ––––––– 109,510 ––––––– Note: the unrealised profit on the sale of the plant was initially $400,000, of this 10% i.e. $40,000 has been realised via Stopple's depreciation charge, giving a net adjustment of $360,000 to both Hanford's profits (W5) and the carrying value of the plant. (b) The reasons why a parent company may not wish to consolidate a subsidiary can be broken down into two broad groups; (i) to improve the reported position of the group financial statements; and (ii) where consolidating a subsidiary might not give a fair presentation of the performance and position of the group. Improvement of the financial position The financial statements of a subsidiary could show any of the following: 406 – substantial operating losses – a poor liquidity position, or – high levels of borrowing (high gearing). KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 If a parent were to consolidate such a subsidiary, it would proportionately worsen the group position in the above areas. Thus a parent may prefer not to consolidate poorly performing subsidiaries. Fair presentation There is a case for excluding subsidiaries from a parent’s consolidated financial statements for the following reasons: – The subsidiary operates under severe long­term restrictions. In effect the parent does not have full control (particularly over the ability to transfer funds to the parent) over the subsidiary, – Control is intended to be temporary because the investment is held exclusively with a view to its subsequent resale. It is apparent that the first group of reasons for non­consolidation is not permitted by International Accounting Standards, whereas in theory the latter group might be. In addition, subsidiaries may sometimes be excluded on the basis of differing activities. Companies that have adopted this approach argue that to add together the assets and liabilities of companies whose activities differ greatly could lead to consolidated financial statements that give a misleading impression (or not provide fair presentation). IAS 27 has never permitted exclusion on these grounds because it feels that ‘differing activity’ problems are overcome by the provision of segmental information. The revised version of IAS 27 Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements does not allow any exclusions from consolidation; all subsidiaries must be consolidated. However, IAS 27 requires disclosure of the nature and extent of any significant restrictions on the ability of a subsidiary to transfer funds to the parent. Where a subsidiary is held exclusively with a view to subsequent resale (provided it has not previously been consolidated) IFRS 5 Non­current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations requires that it is presented separately in the statement of financial position and that other information is disclosed, so that users of the financial statements are made aware that control is only intended to be temporary. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 407 Questions & Answers Test your understanding 4 ­ Hepburn and Salter Answer 1 Hepburn Consolidated income statement year to 31 March 20X0 $000 Sale revenue (1,200 + 500 – 100 intra­group sales) 1,600 Cost of sales (W7) (890) ––––– Gross profit 710 Operating expenses (120 + 44) (164) Finance costs (12 x 6/12) (6) ––––– Profit before tax 540 Income tax expense (100 + 20) (120) ––––– Profit for the period 420 ––––– Attributable to: Equity holders of the parent 400 Non­controlling interests (200 x 20% × 6/12) 20 ––––– 420 ––––– Consolidated statement of financial position at 31 March 20X0 Non­current assets $000 Property, plant and equipment (620 + 660 + 125) Intangible: Goodwill (W3) Investments (20 + 10) Current assets Inventory (240 + 280 – 10) [W1] Accounts receivable (170 + 210 – 56 (W6)) Bank (20 + 40 + 20 (W5)) Total assets 408 $000 1,405 255 30 ––––– 1,690 510 324 80 ––––– 914 ––––– 2,604 ––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Equity and liabilities: Equity shares of $1 each (400 + 300 (W3)) Reserves: Share premium (W3) Retained earnings (W6) 700 600 480 ––––– Non­controlling interest (W4) 1,080 ––––– 1,780 250 ––––– 2,030 Non­current liabilities 8% Debentures Current liabilities Trade payables (210 + 155 – 36 (W6)) Taxation (50 + 45) 150 329 95 ––––– 424 ––––– 2,604 ––––– Workings (W1) Group Structure Hepburn 80% Salter The unrealised profit (URP) in inventory is calculated as: Intra­group sales of $100,000 of which one half is in inventory at the year end = $50,000. This has been sold at a mark­up of 25% on cost, therefore the URP in inventory is $50,000 × 25%/125% = $10,000. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 409 Questions & Answers (W2) Net Assets ­ Salter Share Capital retained earnings (500 + (200x6/12)) Book Value Fair Value adjustment Land Fair value at date of acquisition $000 150 600 at reporting date $000 150 700 ____ 750 ____ 850 125 ____ 875 125 ____ 975 (W3) Goodwill ­ Fair Value (full goodwill method) Hepburn issued five shares for every two shares it acquired in Salter. Therefore Hepburn issued ((150,000/2 x 5) x 80%) = 300,000 shares at a value of $3 each for a total consideration of $900,000. This would be recorded in Hepburn’s books as equity share capital of $300,000 and share premium of $600,000. $000 Investment at cost (300 × $3) For 80% (875) Parent shares of goodwill FV of NCI NCI in net assets at date of acq (875 x 20%) Total Goodwill 410 $000 900 (700) ____ 200 230 175 —— 55 –––– 255 –––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 (W4) Non­controlling interest (Minority Interest) $000 195 20% 975 NCI in goodwill 55 ____ 250 –––– (W5) Consolidated reserves $000 410 80 Hepburn’s reserves Share of Salter’s post acquisition profits (200 x 6/12 x 80%) URP in inventory (10) –––– 480 –––– (W6) Elimination of current accounts The difference on the current accounts is due to cash in transit of $20,000. A summary of the intra­group cancellations is: Cash/bank Accounts payable Accounts receivable $000 20 36 –––– 56 –––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING $000 56 –––– 56 –––– 411 Questions & Answers (W7) Cost of sales $000 650 330 (100) 10 –––– 890 –––– Hepburn Salter (660 × 6/12) Intra­group sales URP in inventory (below) Test your understanding 5 ­ Holding Answer 2 Holding has acquired 18 million of Subside’s 24 million equity shares which represents 75% ownership. (a) Goodwill $m Cost of investment Non­controlling interest Share capital Revaluation reserve (W1) Profit and loss reserve (W2) Net assets of subsidiary at acquisition date Goodwill 412 24 64 88 –––– 25%x 176 $m 174 44 ___ 218 (176) –––– 42 –––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Workings (W1) Fair value gains/revaluation reserve Property – at 30 June 20X8 – increase up to 1 January 20X9 Plant: Net book value 30 June 20X8 Depreciation 6 months to date of acquisition (20 × 6/12) Net book value at date of acquisition Fair value at date of acquisition Fair value increase Total revaluation gains (24 + 40) $m 20 4 –––– 24 –––– 60 (10) –––– 50 (90) –––– 40 –––– 64 –––– (W2) Pre­acquisition profits Retained earnings at 30 June 20X8 Retained profit for period (6/15m × $60m) Total pre­acquisition profits KAPLAN PUBLISHING 64 24 –––– 88 –––– 413 Questions & Answers (b) Consolidated income statement of Holding for the year to 30 September 20X9 Sales revenue (W1) Cost of sales (W2) Gross profit Operating expenses (W3) Interest payable (10 + (9/12m × 5)) Profit before tax Income tax expense (22 + (9/12m × 10)) Profit for the period Attributable to: Equity holders of the parent Non­controlling interest (W4) $ million 488 (286) –––– 202 (93) (13) –––– 96 (28) –––– 68 –––– 62 6 –––– 68 –––– Workings: ($ million) (W1) Most of the figures in the consolidated income statement are based on the whole of the holding company’s figures plus the post acquisition figures of the subsidiary. The results of the subsidiary are for a 15 month period, of which nine months is post acquisition. Thus the post acquisition results would be 9/15 or 60% of Subside’s relevant figures. Sales revenue Holding Subside (9/12 × 280) Intra­group sales 414 $m 350 168 (30) –––– 488 –––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 (W2) Cost of sales Holding Subside (9/12 × 170) Intra­group sales Unrealised profit in inventory (see below) Additional depreciation (see below) $m 200 102 (30) 2 12 –––– 286 –––– Unrealised profit A mark­up of 25% on cost is equivalent to 20% of the selling price. Holding has $10 million ($30 m x 1/3) of inventories at the transfer price, thus the unrealised profit is ($10 m x 20%) $2 million. Additional depreciation (plant of Subside) At the date of the acquisition (1 January 20X9) the plant is two and a half years old and has a remaining life also of two and a half years. Therefore the revaluation gain of $40 million will be amortised at $16 million per annum ($40 m/2.5). The post acquisition period is 9 months and would thus require additional depreciation of $12 million (9/12 × $16m). (W3) Operating expenses $m Holding 72 Subside (9/12% × 35) 21 –––– 93 –––– (W4) Non­controlling interest The profit after tax of Subside is $60 million of which $36 million (9/15) is post acquisition. The depreciation adjustment of $12 million (see W4 above) is deducted from this to give an adjusted figure of $24 million. The NCI has a 25% interest in this profit = $6 million. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 415 Questions & Answers Test your understanding 6 ­ Bacup, Townley and Rishworth Answer 1 (a) Bacup Consolidated statement of financial position as at 31 March 20X7 $000 $000 Non­current assets: Tangible assets (3,820 + 4,425) 8,245 Goodwill (W3) 460 Investment in associate (W6) 420 ––––– 9,125 Current assets: Inventory (2,740 + 1,280 – 40) 3,980 Receivables (1,960 + 980 – 250) 2,690 Bank (1,260 + 50 cash in transit) 1,310 ––––– 7,980 ––––– Total assets 17,105 ––––– Ordinary shares of 25 cents each 4,000 Reserves: Share premium 800 Retained earnings (W5) 4,272 ––––– 5,072 ––––– 9,072 Non­controlling interest (W4) 233 ––––– Equity 9,305 Current liabilities: Trade payables (2,120 + 3,070 — 200) 4,990 Bank overdraft 2,260 Taxation (400 + 150) 550 ––––– 7,800 ––––– Total equity and liabilities 17,105 ––––– 416 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Workings (W1) Net assets in subsidiary Share capital Share premium Retained earnings (W2) At acquisition $000 500 125 300 –––– 925 At reporting date $000 500 125 540 –––– 1,165 Net assets in associate At acquisition At reporting date $000 $000 Share capital 200 200 Retained earnings 525 600 –––– –––– 725 800 Pre/post acquisition reserves of Townley Pre Post (W2) $000 $000 Retained earnings 380 400 Development expenditure (80) (120) Inventory URP – (40) –––– –––– 300 240 –––– –––– Townley Goodwill (W3) $000 Cost of investment (0.75 × 1,600) 1,200 Non­controlling interest (20% x 925) 185 ––––– 1,385 Net assets of Townley at acquisition (925) ____ 460 –––– Non­controlling interest (W4) $000 Share of net assets (20% × 1,165) 233 KAPLAN PUBLISHING 417 Questions & Answers (W5) Retained earnings Bacup Unrealised profit on inventory Townley (540 – 300) × 80% Rishworth (600 – 525) × 40% $000 4,060 (10) 192 30 ––––– 4,272 ––––– Note: inventory URP (unrealised profit in inventories): – Sold by Bacup to Rishworth, group share only as it is an associate, 40% of (125 × 25/125) = 10; – Sold by Townley to Bacup, total profit as it is a subsidiary, 200 × 25/125 = 40. (W6) Associate – Rishworth Carrying value in the statement of financial position at 31 March 20X7 Cost Share of post acquisition profits (40% x (600­525)) PURP $000 400 30 (10) –––– 420 (b) The group statement of financial position is of little use in assessing the liquidity of any member of the group. It must be appreciated that the group does not exist as a legal entity; it is an economic reporting entity. For example it is not possible to sue a group, one would have to sue the relevant member of the group. Even if the liquidity position shown by calculations using the group statement of financial position is favourable (for the statement of financial position in the answer to (a) they are not good at all), it implies nothing about the individual members of the group. A criticism often levelled at group statement of financial position is that they can give the impression that all of the group’s assets are available to meet all of the group’s liabilities. The reality is that only the assets of an individual member of the group are available to discharge the liabilities of that individual member. 418 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Occasionally some lenders, usually banks, will obtain guarantees from the holding company when advancing loans or overdrafts to subsidiaries. When this occurs it contradicts the above paragraph. Sometimes a holding company will support a subsidiary that is in financial difficulties when it has no legal obligation to do so. It does this to preserve the value, reputation and goodwill of the group. Further investigation (i) The management of Norden Manufacturing must obtain the separate financial statements of Townley in order to calculate appropriate liquidity ratios. From the information in the question Townley’s liquidity position is a cause of serious concern. However, the usefulness of this could be questioned even if the liquidity position was more favourable. This is due to the limitations of such ratios e.g. they are open to ‘window dressing’ and ‘creative accounting’ techniques. (ii) The above should be supplemented by the use of a credit reference agency to obtain a report on the position of Townley. (iii) Discreet enquiries should be made with existing customers and suppliers to see if they have had any unsatisfactory dealings with Townley. (iv) It is always worth trying to get the holding company, i.e. Bacup, to guarantee any liability that Townley may incur to Norden Manufacturing. (v) As a further precaution Norden Manufacturing could sell goods ‘subject to reservation of title’. Test your understanding 7 ­ Harden Answer 2 (a) Consolidated statement of financial position of Harden as at 30 September 20X2 $000 $000 Non­current assets Property, plant and equipment (W8) Patents (250 + 420) Consolidated goodwill (W3) KAPLAN PUBLISHING 6,480 670 200 ––––– 870 419 Questions & Answers Investments Associated company (W9) Others (150 + 200) Current assets Inventories (W6) Trade receivables (420 + 380 – 70 – 50) (W7) Bank 960 350 ––––– 962 680 150 ––––– Total assets Equity attributable to equity holders of the parent Equity shares of $1 each 2,000 Reserves Share premium 1,000 Retained earnings (W5) 5,172 ––––– Non­controlling interest (W4) Non­current liabilities Deferred tax Current liabilities Trade payables (750 + 450 – 70) (W7) Taxation Overdraft Total equity and liabilities 420 1,310 ––––– 8,660 1,792 ––––– 10,452 8,172 730 ––––– 8,902 200 1,130 140 80 ––––– 1,350 ––––– 10,452 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Workings ($000) (W1) Group Structure Harden 80% 40% active Solder (W2) Net assets in subsidiary Share capital Share premium Retained earnings Fair value adjustment At acquisition $000 1,000 500 1,200 200 ––––– 2,900 At reporting date $000 1,000 500 1,900 200 ––––– 3,600 Net assets in associate At acquisition Share capital Share premium Retained earnings KAPLAN PUBLISHING $000 500 100 800 ––––– 1,400 _____ At reporting date $000 500 100 1,200 ––––– 1,800 _____ 421 Questions & Answers (W3) Goodwill ­ Fair value (full goodwill) method Cost of investment For 80% Net assets acquired (80% (2,900)) Goodwill ­ parents share FV of NCI 600 NCI in Net assets at date of acq (580) Total Goodwill Solder $000 2,500 (2,320) _____ 180 20 _____ 200 ––––– (W4) Non­controlling interest Fair value at acquisition Share of post acquisition profits (20% x(3,600­ 2,900) ­ 50) $000 600 130 ___ 730 (W5) Retained earnings Harden Solder – group share post acquisition 80% × ((1,900 – 50) – 1,200) Active – group share post acquisition 40% × (1,200 – 800) Less: unrealised profit (W6) 422 $000 4,500 520 160 (8) ––––– 5,172 ––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 (W6) Inventories Amounts per question (570 + 400) Group share of unrealised profit (140 x 40/140 x ½ x 40%) $000 970 (8) –––– 962 –––– (W7) Elimination of current accounts The current accounts of Harden and Solder were agreed at $70,000 before the charge for the allocation of central overheads. When Harden processed this transaction it would have debited Solder’s current account to give a balance of $120,000 which must be eliminated. The corresponding adjustments are to eliminate $70,000 from Solder’s trade payables and debit $50,000 to the retained earnings of Solder. In summary: Trade payables (elimination of intra­group creditor) Retained earnings of Solder reflecting the charge Trade receivables (elimination of intra­group debtor) Dr 70 Cr 50 120 –––– 120 –––– –––– 120 –––– (W8) Tangible non­current assets Balance from question – Harden – Solder Land fair value increase $000 3,980 2,300 200 ––––– 6,480 ––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING 423 Questions & Answers (W9) Associated company – carrying value in consolidated statement of financial position $000 800 160 –––– 960 –––– Investment at cost Post acquisition profits (40% × (1,200 – 800)) Test your understanding 8 ­ Simpkins Answer 1 IAS 16 Property, Plant and Equipment does not allow companies to carry out selective revaluations of non­current assets (sometimes referred to as ‘cherry picking’). Where a company decides to revalue a non­current asset, it must be consistent and revalue all assets of the same class. Furthermore where a class of non­current assets has been revalued its carrying values must be kept up to date. Thus the proposal of the directors of Simpkins would fall foul of IAS 16. Either all of the properties must be revalued, thus recognising the loss on the property in the North, or none of them should be revalued. The non­recognition of a fall in an asset’s market value can no longer be justified on the basis that a recovery in market prices is expected in the near future. Income statement: Property in the South: Depreciation ($3.2 million x 140%)/40 years In the Midlands: Depreciation ($1.5 million/30 years) In the North: Loss on revaluation (20% x $800,000) Depreciation (800,000 x 160,000)/20 years 424 $000 $000 112 50 160 32 –––– 192 –––– 354 –––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 At 1 October 20X0 the accumulated depreciation of the property in the South is $800,000. This represents ten years’ depreciation charges leaving a remaining life of 40 years. Similar calculations for the properties in the Midlands and the North give remaining lives of 30 and 20 years respectively. In the absence of a previous revaluation surplus on the property in the North, the loss on its revaluation in the current year must be charged to the income statement; it cannot be offset against a surplus on a different asset. Statement of financial position: Property in the South Property in the Midlands Property in the North KAPLAN PUBLISHING Revaluation $000 4,480 1,500 640 ––––– 6,620 ––––– Depreciation $000 112 50 32 –––– 194 ––––– Book value $000 4,368 1,450 608 –––– 6,426 ––––– 425 Questions & Answers Test your understanding 9 ­ Myriad Answer 2 (i) It is argued that the principal reasons for holding investment properties are that the owner expects to receive rental income from them and benefit from capital appreciation. They are not held for ‘consumption’ in the normal course of business i.e. they are not used as part of a company’s operations in the production or supply of goods and services or administrative purposes. As they are held as an investment for (eventual) disposal, it is often considered that it is the current values of the investments and the changes in them that are more important than their original costs. IAS 40 Investment Property takes this into account by permitting a choice of either a ‘cost’ model of a ‘fair value’ model on which the accounting treatment of investment properties must be based. Cost model Under the cost model (as in IAS 16 Property, Plant and Equipment) investment properties are measured at depreciated historic cost (less any impairments). In effect this treats investment properties in a similar manner to owner­occupied properties. Where the cost model is adopted, the fair values of investment properties must be disclosed. Fair value model This requires investment properties to be measured at their fair values on the statement of financial position with changes in fair values being recognised in income. This differs from a revaluation model that requires (with certain exceptions) revaluation surpluses to be recognised as changes in equity (reserve movements), not as income. In the introduction to the Standard the IASB makes it clear that they consider the fair value model to be desirable, although they point out that it is an evolutionary step forward and therefore stop short, at this stage, of making it a requirement. (ii) Consolidated statement of financial position extractsas at 30 September 20X1 Non­current assets Property, plant and equipment Investment properties 426 Cost/ Accumulated Carrying valuation depreciation value –A $000 150 $000 6 (2 years) $000 144 –B –C 145 150 Nil Nil 145 150 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Consolidated income statement extracts year to 30 September 20X1 Depreciation: Property A (150/50 years) Deficit in fair value of investment property B (180 – 145) Surplus in fair value of investment property C (140 – 150) $000 3 (35) 10 Note: property A is let to a subsidiary of Myriad, therefore in Myriad’s entity and consolidated financial statements it would be treated as an owner­occupier property (cost model in IAS 16). Test your understanding 10 ­ Dexterity Answer 1 Dexterity (a) Goodwill: International Accounting Standards state that goodwill is the difference between the purchase consideration and value of the NCI and the fair value of the acquired business’s identifiable (separable) net assets. Identifiable assets and liabilities are those that are capable of being sold or settled separately, i.e. without selling the business as a whole. Purchased goodwill should be recognised in the statement of financial position at this value and it should not be amortised. However it should be tested at least annually for impairment. Other intangibles: Where an intangible asset other than goodwill is acquired as a separate transaction, the treatment is relatively straightforward. It should be capitalised at cost and amortised over its estimated useful life if it has a finite life, and not amortised if it has an indefinite life. The fair value of the purchase consideration paid to acquire an intangible is deemed to be its cost. Intangibles purchased as part of the acquisition of a business should be recognised separately to goodwill if they can be measured reliably. Reliable measurement does not have to be at market value, techniques such as valuations based on multiples of revenue or notional royalties are acceptable. This test is not meant to be overly restrictive and is likely to be met in valuing intangibles such as brands, publishing titles, patents etc. Any intangible not capable of reliable measurement will be subsumed within goodwill. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 427 Questions & Answers Recognition of internally developed intangibles is much more restrictive. IAS 38 states that internally generated brands, mastheads, publishing titles, customer lists and similar items should not be recognised as intangible assets as these items cannot be distinguished from the cost of developing the business as a whole. The Standard does require development costs to be capitalised if they meet detailed recognition criteria. (i) The purchase consideration of $35 million should be allocated as: Net tangible assets Work in progress Patent Goodwill $m 15 2 10 8 ––– 35 ––– The difficulty here is the potential value of the patent if the trials are successful. In effect this is a contingent asset. There is insufficient information to make a judgment of the fair value of the contingent asset and in these circumstances it would be prudent to value the patent at $10 million. The additional $5 million is an example of where an intangible cannot be measured reliably and thus it should be subsumed within goodwill. The other issue is that although research cannot normally be treated as an asset, in this case the research is being done for another company and is in fact work in progress and should be recognised as such. (ii) This is an example of an internally developed intangible asset and although the circumstances of its valuation are similar to the patent acquired above it cannot be recognised at Leadbrand’s valuation. Internally generated intangibles can only be recognised if they meet the definition of development costs in IAS 38. Internally generated intangibles are permitted to be carried at a revalued amount (under the allowed alternative treatment) but only where there is an active market of homogeneous assets with prices that are available to the public. By their very nature drug patents are unique (even for similar types of drugs) therefore they cannot be part of a homogeneous population. Therefore the drug would be recorded at its development cost of $12 million. 428 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 (iii) This is an example of a ‘granted’ asset. It is neither an internally developed asset nor a purchased asset. In one sense it is recognition of the standing of the company that is part of the company’s goodwill. IAS 38’s general requirement requires intangible assets to be initially recorded at cost and specifically mentions granted assets. IAS 38 also refers to IAS 20 Accounting for Government Grants and Disclosure of Government Assistance in this situation. This standard says that both the asset and the grant can be recognised at fair value initially (in this case they would be at the same amount). If fair values are not used for the asset it should be valued at the amount of any directly attributable expenditure (in this case this is zero). It is unclear whether IAS 38’s general restrictive requirements on the revaluation of intangibles as referred to above (i.e. the allowed alternative treatment) are intended to cover granted assets under IAS 20. (iv) There is no doubt that a skilled workforce is of great benefit to a company. In this case there is an enhancement of revenues and a reduction in costs and if resources had been spent on a tangible non­current asset that resulted in similar benefits they would be eligible for capitalisation. However the Standard specifically excludes this type of expenditure from being recognised as an intangible asset and such highly trained staff can be described as ‘pseudo­assets’. The main reason is the issue of control (through custody or legal rights). Part of the definition of any asset is the ability to control it. In the case of employees (or, as in this case, training costs of employees) the company cannot claim to control them, as it is quite possible that employees may leave the company and work elsewhere. (v) The benefits of effective advertising are often given as an example of goodwill (or an enhancement of it). If this view is accepted then such expenditures are really internally generated goodwill which cannot be recognised. In this particular case it would be reasonable to treat the unexpired element of the expenditure as a prepayment (in current assets); this would amount to 3/6 of $5 million i.e. $2.5 million. This represents the cost of the advertising that has been paid for, but not yet taken place. In the past some companies have treated anticipated continued benefits as deferred revenue expenditure, but this is no longer permitted as it does not meet the Standard’s recognition criteria for an asset. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 429 Questions & Answers Test your understanding 11 ­ Shiplake Answer 1 Shiplake a. (i) An impairment loss arises where the carrying value of an asset, or group of assets, is higher than their recoverable amounts. In effect the Standard requires that assets should not appear in a statement of financial position at a value which is higher than they are ‘worth’. The recoverable amount of an asset is defined as the higher of its net realisable value (i.e. the amount at which it can be sold for net of direct selling expenses) or its value in use (i.e. its estimated future net cash flows discounted to a present value). IAS 36 Impairment of Assets recognises that many assets do not produce independent cash flows and therefore the value in use may have to be calculated for a group of assets – a cash­generating unit. The Standard recognises that it would be too onerous for companies to have to test for impaired assets every year and therefore only requires impairment reviews when there is some indication that an impairment has occurred. The exception to this general principle is where an intangible asset has an indefinite useful life or is not yet available for use, in which case an impairment review is required at least annually. This also applies to goodwill acquired in a business combination. 430 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 (ii) Impairments generally arise where there has been an event or change in circumstances. It may be that something has happened to the assets themselves (e.g. physical damage) or there has been a change in the economic environment relating to the assets (e.g. new regulations may have come into force). The Standard gives several examples of indicators of impairment, which may be available from internal or external sources: KAPLAN PUBLISHING – Poor operating results. This could be a current operating loss or a low profit. One year’s losses in itself does not necessarily mean there has been an impairment, but if this is coupled with previous losses or expected future losses then this is an indication of impairment. – A significant decline in an asset’s market value (in excess of normal depreciation through use or the passage of time) or evidence of obsolescence (through market changes or technology) or physical damage. – Evidence of a reduction in the useful economic life or estimated residual value of assets. – Adverse changes in the market or economy such as the entrance of a major competitor, new statutory or regulatory rules or any indicator of value that has been used to value an asset (e.g. on acquisition a brand may have been valued on a ‘multiple of sales revenues’. If subsequent sales were below expectations this may indicate an impairment). – A commitment to a significant reorganisation or restructuring of the business. – Loss of key employees or major customers. – Increases in long­term interest rates (this could materially impact on value in use calculations thus affecting the recoverable amounts of assets). – Where the carrying amount of an entity’s net assets is more than its market capitalisation. 431 Questions & Answers b. (i) On the acquisition of a subsidiary, the purchase consideration must be allocated to the fair value of its net assets with the residue being classed as goodwill (or 'negative goodwill' if the assets have a greater fair value than the purchase consideration). IFRS 3 revised Business Combinations recognises that it is not always possible to accurately determine the value of some assets at the date of acquisition and therefore allows a measurement period’ up to the end of the first full reporting period following the period of acquisition. As the revision to the value of Halyard’s assets was due to more detailed information becoming available, the fall in its asset values should be treated as an adjustment to provisional valuations made at the time of acquisition. In effect the net assets and goodwill should be restated to $7 million and $5 million respectively; the fall of $1 million is not an impairment loss and should not be charged to the income statement. The above assumes that the recoverable value of the company as a whole is greater than $12 million. The fall in value of Mainstay’s assets is the result of events that occurred after the acquisition (i.e. physical damage to the plant) and this does constitute an impairment loss. The plant and machinery should be written down to its recoverable amount and the loss charged to the income statement. On the assumption that the recoverable value of the company as a whole has not fallen, goodwill will not be affected. (ii) On the basis of the original estimates, Shiplake’s earth­moving plant was not impaired, the value in use of $500,000 being greater than its carrying value. However due to the ‘dramatic’ increase in interest rates causing Shiplake’s cost of capital to increase, the value in use of the plant will have to be recalculated. As the discount rate has risen this will cause the value in use to fall. There is insufficient information to be able to quantify this fall. If the new discounted value is above the carrying value of $400,000 there is still no impairment. If it is between $245,000 and $400,000, this will be the recoverable amount of the plant and it should be written down to this value. As the plant can be sold for $250,000 less selling costs of $5,000, $245,000 is the least amount that the plant should be written down to even if its revised value in use is below this figure. 432 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 (iii) The treatment of the research and development costs in the year to 31 March 20X1 was correct due to the element of uncertainty at the date. The development costs of $75,000 written off in that same period should not be capitalised at a later date even if the uncertainties leading to its original write off are favourably resolved. The treatment of the development costs in the year to 31 March 20X2 is incorrect. The directors’ decision to continue the development is logical as (at the time of the decision) the future costs are estimated at only $10,000 and the future revenues are expected to be $150,000. It is also true that the project is now expected to lead to an overall deficit of $135,000 (120 + 75 + 80 + 10 – 150 (in $000)). However, at 31 March 20X2 the unexpensed development costs of $80,000 are expected to be recovered. Provided the criteria in IAS 38 Intangible Assets are met these costs of $80,000 should be recognised as an asset in the statement of financial position and ‘matched’ to the future earnings of the new product. Thus the directors’ logic of writing off the $80,000 development cost at 31 March 20X2 because of an expected overall loss is flawed. The directors do not have the choice to write off the development expenditure. Test your understanding 12 ­ Multiplex Answer 2 Notes Goodwill Operating licence Property – train stations/land Rail track and coaches Steam engines KAPLAN PUBLISHING Assets: First Revised Second Revised 1 Jan impair assets: impairment assets: 20X0 ­ment 1 Feb 31 Mar 20X0 20X0 $000 $000 $000 $000 $000 200 (200) nil nil 1,200 (200) 1,000 (100) 900 300 (50) 250 (50) 200 300 (50) 250 1,000 (500) ––––– ––––– 3,000 (1,000) ––––– ––––– 500 ––––– 2,000 ––––– (50) 200 ––––– (200) ––––– 500 ––––– 1,800 ––––– 433 Questions & Answers The first impairment loss of $1 million: • $500,000 must be written off the engines as one of them no longer exists and is no longer part of the cash­generating unit • • the goodwill of $200,000 must be eliminated; and the balance of $300,000 is allocated pro rata to the remaining net assets other than the engine which must not be reduced below its net selling price of $500,000 The second impairment loss of $200,000: • the first $100,000 is applied to the licence to write it down to its net selling price • the balance is applied pro rata to assets carried at other than their net selling prices, i.e. $50,000 to both the property and the rail track and coaches. Test your understanding 13 ­ Merryview Answer 1 (i) Merryview – Income statement (extracts) – year to 31 March 20X1 $000 Sales revenue (40,000 x 35% (W1)) 14,000 Cost of sales (W1) (9,100) –––––– Profit on contract 4,900 –––––– Statement of financial position (extracts) as at 31 March 20X1 Non­current assets Plant and machinery (3,600 – 900 (W2)) Current assets Amount due from customer (W3) 2,700 1,500 (ii) Merryview – Income statement (extracts) – year to 31 March 20X2 Sales revenue (40,000 x 75% – 14,000 (W1)) Cost of sales (22,500 – 9,100 (W1)) Profit on contract 434 $000 16,000 (13,400) –––––– 2,600 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Statement of financial position (extracts) as at 31 March 20X2 Non­current assets Plant and machinery (3,600 – 900 – 1,200 (W2)) Current assets Amount due from customer (W3) 1,500 1,000 Workings (all figures $000): (W1) Contract costs as at 31 March 20X1: Architects’ and surveyors’ fees Materials used (3,100 – 300 inventory) Direct labour costs Overheads (40% of 3,500) Plant depreciation (9 months (W2)) Cost at 31 March 20X1 Estimated cost to complete: Excluding depreciation Plant depreciation (3,600 – 600 – 900) 500 2,800 3,500 1,400 900 –––––– 9,100 14,800 2,100 –––––– Estimated total costs on completion Percentage of completion at 31 March 20X1 (9,100/26,000) Contract costs as at 31 March 20X2: Summarised costs excluding depreciation Plant depreciation (21 months at $100 per month) Cost to date Estimated cost to complete: Excluding depreciation Plant depreciation (9 months) Estimated total costs on completion Percentage of completion at 31 March 20X2 (22,500/30,000) KAPLAN PUBLISHING 16,900 –––––– 26,000 –––––– = 35% 20,400 2,100 –––––– 22,500 6,600 900 –––––– 7,500 –––––– 30,000 –––––– = 75% 435 Questions & Answers (W2) The plant has a depreciable amount of $3,000k (3,600 – 600 residual value). Its estimated life on this contract is 30 months (1 July 20X0 to 31 December 20X2). Depreciation would be $10k per month i.e. $900k for the period to 31 March 20X1; $1,200k for the period to 31 March 20X2; and a further $900k to completion. (W3) Amount due from customer at 31 March 20X1: Contract costs incurred (9,100 + 300 material inventory) Recognised profit 9,400 4,900 –––––– 14,300 (12,800) –––––– 1,500 –––––– Cash received at 31 March 20X1 Amount due at 31 March 20X1 Amount due from customer at 31 March 20X2: Contract costs incurred Recognised profit (4,900 + 2,600) Cash received – 31 March 20X1 – 31 March 20X2 22,500 7,500 30,000 (12,800) (16,200) –––––– Amount due at 31 March 20X2 (29,000) –––––– 1,000 –––––– Test your understanding 14 ­ Multiplex Answer 2 Income statement year to 31 March 20X0 Contract revenue (W2) Contract costs recognised (balancing figure) Contract profit (W3) Statement of financial position extracts as at 31 March 20X0 Current assets Gross amounts due from customers (W5) 436 $m 18.0 (14.1) ––––– 3.9 ––––– $m 11.0 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Note to the financial statements Contingent asset The company is in the process of attempting to recover $2.5 million from a firm of civil engineers. The engineers were contracted to design the structure of a road bridge to be built by Multiplex. The engineers incorrectly specified certain materials to be used on the contract, which had to be replaced at a later date. The company’s lawyers have advised that there is a good prospect of a successful recovery of these costs. Workings (W1) The percentage completion is calculated as: at 31 March 19W9 Work certified ––––––– $12 million –––––––––– Contract price $30 million at 31 March 20X0 $30 million = –––––––– = 66.7% (or 30% 2/3) $45 million (W2) The figure for 20X0 includes the variation to the contract. The accumulated contract revenues at 31 March 20X0 would be $30 million (2/3 x $45 million). The contract revenue to be reported in 20X0 would be $18 million i.e. accumulated revenue of $30 million less the contract revenue of $12 million reported in the previous year. (W3) The accumulated profit at 31 March 20X0 would have been 2/3 of the revised estimated total profit of $15 million ($45 million contract price less $30 million costs). However the cost of the rectification work of $2.5 million must be charged to the year in which it occurs (i.e. the year to 31 March 20X0). This gives a reported profit for the year of $3.9 million ($10 million – $3.6 million in 19W9 – $2.5 million rectification work). KAPLAN PUBLISHING 437 Questions & Answers (W4) The income statement for the year to 31 March 19W9 would be: $m Contract revenue 12.0 Contract costs incurred (balancing figure) (8.4) –––– Profit ((40 – 28) x 30%) 3.6 –––– (W5) The gross amount due from customers is made up of: costs incurred to date plus recognised profits (3.6 + 3.9) less progress billings 28.5 7.5 (25.0) –––– 11.0 –––– Test your understanding 15 ­ Multicolour Answer 1 Income statement extracts: $000 Loan stock interest paid ($80 million x 8%) Required accrual of finance cost Total finance cost for loan stock ($68,704,000 x 12%) $000 6,400 1,844 ––––– 8,244 ––––– Statement of financial position extracts: Non­current liabilities 8% loan stock 20X4 Accrual of finance costs Equity and liabilities Share options 438 68,704 1,844 ––––– 70,548 ––––– 11,296 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Workings IAS 32 and 39, dealing with financial instruments, require compound or hybrid financial instruments such as convertible loan stock to be treated under the substance of the contractual agreement. For this type of instrument this means that its equity element and liability (debt) element must be separately identified and presented as such in the statement of financial position. In practice there are several methods of calculating the split between the two elements. For example there are several option pricing models. However, given the limited information in the question, the split can only be calculated by a ‘residual value of equity’ approach. This involves calculating the present value of the cash flows attributable to a ‘pure’ debt instrument and treating the difference between this and the issue proceeds (the residue) as the equity component. Cash flow Year 1 interest Year 2 interest Year 3 interest Year 4 interest Year 5 interest and capital Residual equity element (share options) Proceeds of issue KAPLAN PUBLISHING $m 6.4 6.4 6.4 6.4 86.4 Factor Discounted cash flow $000 x 0.89 5,696 x 0.80 5,120 x 0.71 4,544 x 0.64 4,096 x 0.57 49,248 ––––––– 68,704 11,296 ––––––– 80,000 ––––––– 439 Questions & Answers Test your understanding 16 ­ Deltoid Answer 1 Statement of financial position of Deltoid as at 31 March 20X2 Non­current assets $000 $000 Property, plant and equipment (12,110 + 600 – 20 (W1) – 120 (W3)) Current assets Inventory Trade accounts receivable Bank 12,570 3,850 2,450 250 –––––– Total assets Equity and liabilities: Equity Ordinary shares of 50c each (2,000 + 500 bonus issue) Reserves Share premium Revaluation reserve (3,000 – 500 bonus issue) Retained earnings (W1) 6,550 –––––– 19,120 –––––– 2,500 1,000 2,500 5,660 –––––– 9,160 –––––– 11,660 Non­current liabilities Finance lease (W3) 6% loan note Current liabilities Trade accounts payable Accrued interest (W3) Finance lease (W3) Taxation Total equity and liabilities 440 371 3,000 –––––– 2,820 24 105 1,140 –––––– 3,371 4,089 –––––– 19,120 –––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Workings (W1) Recalculation of retained earnings Retained profit for year to 31 March 20X2 from question Additional depreciation of: plant (W2) (20) leased plant (120) (W3) –––– Add back: lease rentals (W3) Additional finance costs: leased plant (W3) 2,000 (140) 150 (50) –––– 1,960 3,700 Restated retained profit for year Retained profit b/f at 1 April 20X1 from question Current policy 50 ––––– 5,660 ––––– Group policy (250 x 20%) 50 20 (200 x 20%) 40 Retained earnings (W2) Change of depreciation policy Year to 31 March 20X1 ((250 – 50) x 2,000/8,000) Year to 31 March 20X2 ((250 –50) x 800/8,000) The net effect of this is an increase in the depreciation charge of $20,000 for the current year only. (W3) Leased plant – this has been treated as an operating lease whereas it should be treated as a finance lease: $000 Fair value/cost 1st payment 1 April 20X1 Interest to 30 September 20X1 (10% for 6 months) 2nd payment 1 October 20X1 KAPLAN PUBLISHING 600 (75) –––– 525 26 –––– 551 (75) 441 Questions & Answers Capital outstanding at 31 March 20X2 Accrued interest to 31 March 20X2 Total outstanding at 31 March 20X2 3rd payment due 1 April 20X2 Interest to 30 September 20X2 (10% for 6 months) 4th payment 1 October 20X2 Capital outstanding at 31 March 20X3 476 24 –––– 500 (75) –––– 425 21 –––– 446 (75) –––– 371 –––– Summarising: • The lease payments of $150,000 should be eliminated from expenses and replaced with a depreciation charge of $120,000 ($600,000 x 20% pa). • Interest of $50,000 ($26,000 paid, $24,000 accrued) should be included as a finance cost. • Current liabilities are $24,000 for accrued interest and $105,000 ($476,000 – $371,000) for the capital element of the finance lease. • Non­current liabilities are $371,000 for the capital element of the finance lease. Test your understanding 17 ­ Bowtock Answer 2 $ Income statement extracts year to 30 September 20X3 Depreciation of leased asset (W1) Lease interest expense (W2) 442 10,400 2,672 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Statement of financial position extracts as at 30 September 20X3 $ Leased asset at cost 52,000 Accumulated depreciation (7,800 + 10,400 (W1)) 18,200 ______ Carrying value 33,800 Non­current liabilities Obligations under finance leases (W2) 21,696 Current liabilities Accrued lease interest (W2) 1,872 Obligations under finance leases (W2) 9,504 Workings (W1) Depreciation for the year ended 30 September 20X2 would be $7,800 ($52,000 x 20% x 9/12). Depreciation for the year ended 30 September 20X3 would be $10,400 ($52,000 x 20%) (W2) The lease obligations are calculated as follows: Cash price/fair value Rental 1 January 20X2 Interest to 30 September 20X2 (40,000 x 8% x 9/12) Interest to 1 January 20X3 (40,000 x 8% x 3/12) Rental 1 January 20X3 Capital outstanding 1 January 20X3 Interest to 30 September 20X3 (31,200 x 8% x 9/12) Interest to 1 January 20X4 (31,200 x 8% x 3/12) KAPLAN PUBLISHING $ 52,000 (12,000) –––––– 40,000 2,400 800 –––––– 43,200 (12,000) –––––– 31,200 1,872 624 –––––– 33,696 –––––– 443 Questions & Answers The lease interest expense for the year to 20 September 20X3 is $2,672 (800 + 1,872 from above), of which $1,872 is a current liability. The total capital amount outstanding at 30 September 20X3 is $31,200 (the same as at 1 January 20X3 as no further payments have been made). This must be split between current and non­current liabilities. Next year’s payment will be $12,000 of which $2,496 (1,872 + 624) is interest. Therefore capital repaid in the next year will be $9,504 (12,000 – 2,496). This leaves capital of $21,696 (31,200 – 9,504) as a non­ current liability. Test your understanding 18 ­ Atkins Answer 1 Atkins a. (i) Creative accounting is a term in general use to describe the practice of applying inappropriate accounting policies or entering into complex or ‘special purpose’ transactions with the objective of making a company’s financial statements appear to disclose a more favourable position, particularly in relation to the calculation of certain ‘key’ ratios, than would otherwise be the case. Most commentators believe creative accounting stops short of deliberate fraud, but is nonetheless undesirable as it is intended to mislead users of financial statements. Probably the most criticised area of creative accounting relates to off balance sheet financing. This occurs where a company has financial obligations that are not recorded in its statement of financial position. There have been several examples of this in the past: – Finance leases treated as operating leases. – Borrowings (usually convertible loan stock) being classified as equity. – Secured loans being treated as ‘sales’ (sale and repurchase agreements). – The non­consolidation of ‘special purpose vehicles’ (quasi subsidiaries) that have been used to raise finance. – Offsetting liabilities against assets (certain types of accounts receivable factoring). The other main area of creative accounting is that of increasing or smoothing profits. Examples of this are: 444 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 – The use of inappropriate provisions (this reduces profit in good years and increases them in poor years). – Not providing for liabilities, either at all or not in full, as they arise. This is often related to environmental provisions, decommissioning costs and constructive obligations. – Restructuring costs not being charged to income (often related to a newly acquired subsidiary – the costs are effectively added to goodwill). It should be noted that recent International Accounting Standards have now prevented many of the above past abuses, however more recent examples of creative accounting are in use by some of the new Internet/Dot.com companies. Most of these companies do not (yet) make any profit so other performance criteria such as site ‘hits’, conversion rates (browsers turning into buyers), burn periods (the length of time cash resources are expected to last) and even sales revenues are massaged to give a more favourable impression. (ii) One of the primary characteristics of financial statements is reliability i.e. they must faithfully represent the transactions and other events that have occurred. It can be possible for the economic substance of a transaction (effectively its commercial intention) to be different from its strict legal position or ‘form’. Thus financial statements can only give a faithful representation of a company’s performance if the substance of its transactions is reported. It is worth stressing that there will be very few transactions where their substance is different from their legal form, but for those where it is, they are usually very important. This is because they are material in terms of their size or incidence, or because they may be intended to mislead. Common features which may indicate that the substance of a transaction (or series of connected transactions) is different from its legal form are: KAPLAN PUBLISHING – Where the ownership of an asset does not rest with the party that is expected to experience the risks and rewards relating to it (i.e. equivalent to control of the asset). – Where a transaction is linked with other related transactions. It is necessary to assess the substance of the series of connected transactions as a whole. – The use of options within contracts. It may be that options are either almost certain to be (or not to be) exercised. In such cases these are not really options at all and should be ignored in determining commercial substance. 445 Questions & Answers – Where assets are sold at values that differ from their fair values (either above or below fair values). Many complex transactions often contain several of the above features. Determining the true substance of transactions can be a difficult and sometimes subjective procedure. b. (i) This is an example of consignment inventory. From Atkins’s point of view the main issue is whether or at what point in time the goods have been purchased and should therefore be recognised. As is often the case in these types of agreement there is conflicting evidence as to which party bears the risks and rewards relating to the vehicles. The manufacturer retains the legal right of ownership until the goods are paid for by Atkins. Consistent with this the manufacturer also has the right to have the goods returned or passed on to another supplier. The fact that Atkins may choose to return the goods to the manufacturer is also indicative that the manufacturer is exposed to the risk of obsolescence or falling values. These factors would seem to suggest that the vehicles have not been sold and should therefore remain in the inventory of the manufacturer and not be recognised in the accounting records of Atkins. There are, however, some contrary indications to this view. The price for the goods is fixed as of the date of transfer, not the date that they are deemed ‘sold’. This means that Atkins is protected from any price increases by the manufacturer. The 1.5% paid to the manufacturer appears to be in substance a finance charge, despite it being described as a ‘display charge’. A finance charge indicates that Atkins must have a liability to the manufacturer; in effect this liability is the amount payable in respect of the cost of the vehicles. Although Atkins has a right of return, it cannot exercise this without a cost. There is an explicit freight cost, but this may not be the only cost. It could well be that Atkins may suffer poor future supplies from the manufacturer if it does return goods. The question says that Atkins has never taken advantage of this option, which would seem to suggest that it should be ignored. 446 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Conclusion The substance of this transaction appears to suggest that the goods have been purchased by Atkins and the company is paying a finance cost. Therefore the vehicles should be recognised in Atkins’s statement of financial position, together with the respective liability. It would seem logical that if Atkins considers the goods as purchased, then the manufacturer should consider them as sold. The problem is that prudence may prevent the manufacturer from recognising the profit on the sale, as the period for the right to return the goods has not expired. Therefore, either the sales are not recognised by the manufacturer (the goods would remain in its inventory), or if they are, an allowance should be made in respect of the unrealised profits. This could lead to the unusual situation that the goods may appear in both companies’ statement of financial position. (ii) Although the question says that Atkins has sold the land to Landbank and even though there will be a legal transfer of the land, the substance of this transaction is that of a secured loan. The two clauses in combination mean that in practice Atkins will repurchase the land on or before 1 October 20X4. This is because if its value is above $3.2 million Atkins will exercise its option to purchase, conversely if the value is below $3.2 million Landbank will exercise its option to require a repurchase. Either way Atkins will repurchase the land. When this is understood it becomes clear that the difference between the ‘sale’ price of $2.4 million and the repurchase price of $3.2 million represents a finance charge on a secured loan. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 447 Questions & Answers Under the assumption that the land is sold: Income statement – year to 30 September 20X2 $ 2,400,000 (1,200,000) ––––––––– 1,200,000 ––––––––– $ Sales Cost of sales (3 /5 x $2 million) Profit on sale of land Statment of financial position as at 30 September 20X2 Non­current assets Development land ($2 million – $1.2 million 800,000 above) Under the assumption that the arrangement is a secured loan: Income statement – year to 30 September 20X2 $ Interest on loan (240,000) (10% of in substance loan of $2.4 million) Statement of financial position as at 30 September 20X2 Non­current assets Development land at cost Non­current liabilities Secured loan Accrued interest 448 $ $ 2,000,000 2,400,000 240,000 –––––––– (2,640,000) –––––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Test your understanding 19 ­ Jenson Answer 2 (i) Although this agreement may be worded as a sale, and even if the title to the goods passes to Wholesaler, it seems clear that this is not a sale ­ it is a secured loan. Therefore Jenson should not treat the income from Wholesaler as revenue, but instead as a loan in its statement of financial position. The goods should continue to be recognised as inventory in the statment of financial position, and accrued interest of $3,150 ($35,000 x 12% x 9/12) should be provided for in the income statement. (ii) It appears that the ongoing fees after the first initial payment are insufficient to cover Jenson’s servicing cost and provide a reasonable profit. In these circumstances IAS 18 Revenue requires part of the initial fee of $50,000 to be deferred and recognised in future periods as the servicing costs are incurred. As there is a requirement to earn a (reasonable) profit of 20% on revenues, with ongoing servicing costs of $8,000, revenues of $10,000 would need to be recognised in the next four years. The actual fees receivable are $5,000, therefore Jenson will have to defer $20,000 ($5,000 x 4 years) of the initial fee. Thus in the year to 31 March 20X0 Jenson would recognise $30,000 ($50,000 – $20,000) of the initial franchise fee. (iii) An accruals/matching approach to this problem would be to say that the profit on each publication would be $2,000 (($240,000 – $192,000)/24). In the year to 31 March 20X0, as six of the 24 publications have been produced and delivered, the income statement would be: Sales (6 x 240,000/24) Cost of sales (6 x 192,000/24) Profit $ 60,000 (48,000) ––––––– 12,000 ––––––– Deferred income on the statement of financial position would be $180,000 ($240,000 – $60,000). KAPLAN PUBLISHING 449 Questions & Answers Test your understanding 20 ­ Bodyline Answer 1 Bodyline (a) IAS 37 Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets only deals with those provisions that are regarded as liabilities. The term provision is also used in some countries to describe those amounts set aside to write down the value of assets such as depreciation charges and provisions for diminution in value (e.g. provision to write down the value of damaged or slow moving inventory). The definition of a provision in the Standard is quite simple; provisions are liabilities of uncertain timing or amount. If there is reasonable certainty over these two aspects the liability is not to be presented as a provision on the statement of finacial position. There is clearly an overlap between provisions and contingencies. Because of the ‘uncertainty’ aspects of the definition, it can be argued that to some extent all provisions have an element of contingency. The IASB distinguishes between the two by stating that a contingency is not recognised as a liability if it is either only possible and therefore yet to be confirmed as a liability, or where there is a liability but it cannot be measured with sufficient reliability. The IASB notes the latter should be rare. The IASB intends that only those liabilities that meet the characteristics of a liability in its Framework for the Preparation and Presentation of Financial Statements should be reported in the statement of financial position. IAS 37 summarises the above by requiring provisions to satisfy all of the following three recognition criteria: – There is a present obligation (legal or constructive) as a result of a past event. – It is probable that a transfer of economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation. – The obligation can be estimated reliably. A provision is triggered by an obligating event. This must have already occurred, future events cannot create current liabilities. The first of the criteria refers to legal or constructive obligations. A legal obligation is straightforward and uncontroversial, but constructive obligations are a relatively new concept. These arise where a company creates an expectation that it will meet certain obligations that it is not legally bound to meet. These may arise due to a published statement or even by a pattern of past practice. In reality constructive obligations are usually accepted because the alternative action is unattractive or may damage the reputation of the company. 450 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 The most commonly quoted example of such is a commitment to pay for environmental damage caused by the company, even where there is no legal obligation to do so. To summarise: a company must provide for a liability where the three defining criteria of a provision are met, but conversely a company cannot provide for a liability where they are not met. The latter part of the above may seem obvious, but it is an area where there has been some past abuse of provisioning as is referred to in (b). (b) The main need for an accounting standard in this area is to clarify and regulate when provisions should and should not be made. Many controversial areas including the possible abuse of provisioning are based on contravening aspects of the above definitions. One of the most controversial examples of provisioning is in relation to future restructuring or reorganisation costs (often as part of an acquisition). This is sometimes extended to providing for future operating losses. The attraction of providing for this type of expense/loss is that once the provision has been made, the future costs are then charged to the provision such that they bypass the income statement (of the period when they occur). Such provisions can be glossed over by management as ‘exceptional items’, which analysts are expected to disregard when assessing the company’s future prospects. If this type of provision were to be incorporated as a liability as part of a subsidiary’s net assets at the date of acquisition, the provision itself would not be charged to the income statement. IAS 37 now prevents this practice as future costs and operating losses (unless they are for an onerous contract) do not constitute past events. Another important change initiated by IAS 37 is the way in which environmental provisions must be treated. Practice in this area has differed considerably. Some companies did not provide for such costs and those that did often accrued for them on an annual basis. If say a company expected environmental site restoration cost of $10 million in 10 years time, it might argue that this is not a liability until the restoration is needed or it may accrue $1 million per annum for 10 years (ignoring discounting). Somewhat controversially this practice is no longer possible. IAS 37 requires that if the environmental costs are a liability (legal or constructive), then the whole of the costs must be provided for immediately. That has led to large liabilities appearing in some companies’ statements of financial position. A third example of bad practice is the use of ‘big bath’ provisions and over­provisioning. In its simplest form this occurs where a company makes a large provision, often for non­specific future expenses, or as part of an overall restructuring package. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 451 Questions & Answers If the provision is deliberately overprovided, then its later release will improve future profits. Alternatively the company could charge to the provision a different cost than the one it was originally created for. IAS 37 addresses this practice in two ways: by not allowing provisions to be created if they do not meet the definition of an obligation; and specifically preventing a provision made for one expense to be used for a different expense. Under IAS 37 the original provision would have to be reversed and a new one would be created with appropriate disclosures. Whilst this treatment does not affect overall profits, it does enhance transparency. Note: other examples would be acceptable. (c) Guarantees or warranties appear to have the attributes of contingent liabilities. If the goods are sold faulty or develop a fault within the guarantee period there will be a liability, if not there will be no liability. The IASB view this problem as two separate situations. Where there is a single item warranty, it is considered in isolation and often leads to a disclosable contingent liability unless the chances of a claim are thought to be negligible. Where there are a number of similar items, they should be considered as a whole. This may mean that whilst the chances of a claim arising on an individual item may be small, when taken as a whole, it should be possible to estimate the number of claims from past experience. Where this is the case, the estimated liability is not considered contingent and it must be provided for. (i) Bodyline’s 28­day refund policy is a constructive obligation. The company probably has notices in its shops informing customers of this policy. This would create an expectation that the company will honour its policy. The liability that this creates is rather tricky. The company will expect to give customers refunds of $175,000 ($1,750,000 x 10%). This is not the liability. 70% of these will be resold at the normal selling price, so the effect of the refund policy for these goods is that the profit on their sale must be deferred. The easiest way to account for this is to make a provision for the unrealised profit. This has to be calculated for two different profit margins: Goods manufactured by Header (at a mark up of 40% on cost): $24,500 ($175,000 x 70% x 20%) x 40/140 = $7,000. Goods from other manufacturers (at a mark up of 25% on cost). $98,000 ($175,000 x 70% x 80%) x 25/125 = $19,600. 452 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 The sale of the remaining 30% at half the normal selling price will create a loss. Again this must be calculated for both group of sales: Goods manufactured by Header were originally sold for $10,500 (175,000 x 30% x 20%). These will be resold (at a loss) for half this amount i.e. $5,250. Thus a provision of $5,250 is required. Goods manufactured by other manufacturers were originally sold for $42,000 (175,000 x 30% x 80%). These will be resold (at a loss) for half this amount, i.e. $21,000. Thus a provision of $21,000 is required. The total provision in respect of the 28­day return facility will be $52,850 (7,000 + 19,600 + 5,250 + 21,000). (d) (i) Goods likely to be returned because they are faulty require a different treatment. These are effectively sales returns. Normally the manufacturer will reimburse the cost of the faulty goods. The effect of this is that Bodyline will not have made the profit originally recorded on their sale. This applies to all goods other than those supplied by Header. Thus these sales returns would be $128,000 (160,000 x 80%) and the credit due from the manufacturer would be $102,400 (128,000 x 100/125 removal of profit margin). The overall effect is that Bodyline would have to remove profits of $25,600 from its financial statements. For those goods supplied by Header, Bodyline must suffer the whole loss as this is reflected in the negotiated discount. Thus the provision required for these goods is $32,000 (160,000 x 20%), giving a total provision of $57,600 (25,600 + 32,000). (e) The Directors’ proposed treatment is incorrect. The replacement of the engine is an example of what has been described as cyclic repairs or replacement. Whilst it may seem logical and prudent to accrue for the cost of a replacement engine as the old one is being worn out, such practice leads to double counting. Under the Directors’ proposals the cost of the engine is being depreciated as part of the cost of the asset, albeit over an incorrect time period. The solution to this problem lies in IAS 16 Property, Plant and Equipment. The plant constitutes a ‘complex’ asset i.e. one that may be thought of as having separate components within a single asset. Thus part of the plant $16.5 million (total cost of $24 million less $7.5 assumed cost of the engine) should be depreciated at $1.65 million per annum over a 10­year life and the engine should be depreciated at $1,500 per hour of use (assuming machine hour depreciation is the most appropriate method). If a further provision of $1,500 per machine hour is made, there would be a double charge against profit for the cost of the engine. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 453 Questions & Answers IAS 37 also refers to this type of provision and says that the future replacement of the engine is not a liability. The reasoning is that the replacement could be avoided if, for example, the company chose to sell the asset before replacement was due. If an item does not meet the definition of a liability it cannot be provided for. Test your understanding 21 ­ Energiser Answer 1 Income statement for the year ended 31 December 20X4 Revenue (600,000 – 100,000) Cost of sales (W1) Gross profit Distribution costs Administrative expenses (46,400 – 2,400) Operating profit Interest payable (4,000 (W3) + 7,200 (W5)+ 96 (W6) + 3,600 (prefs)) $000 500,000 (291,800) ––––––– 208,200 (52,800) (44,000) ––––––– 111,400 (14,896) ––––––– 96,504 (12,100) ––––––– 84,404 ––––––– Profit before taxation Taxation ( – 4,200 + 18,400 – 2,100) (W4) Profit after taxation Statement of financial position as at 31 December 20X4 $000 Non­current assets Land and buildings (W2) Plant and equipment (W2) 454 $000 276,000 198,400 –––––– 474,400 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Current assets Inventory (57,000 – (9,000 – 4,000)) Trade receivables (62,400+12,000) Bank (7,400 –100,000 + 100,000 + 56,400 – 4,800 – 9,600 + 9,600) 52,000 74,400 59,000 ––––– 185,400 –––––– 659,800 –––––– Equity Ordinary share capital Retained earnings (W7) Non­current liabilities 6% redeemable preference shares Lease creditor (100,000+4,000) (W3) Loan note (56,400 + 7,200 – 4,800) (W5) Deferred Tax (W4) Current liabilities Trade payables Income tax Debt factor loan (9,600 + 96) KAPLAN PUBLISHING 100,000 207,804 –––––– 307,804 60,000 104,000 58,800 27,300 –––––– 73,800 18,400 9,696 –––––– –––––– 250,100 –––––– 101,896 –––––– 659,800 –––––– 455 Questions & Answers Workings (W1) Cost of sales Opening inventory Purchases Sale and leaseback error Closing inventory (57,000 – 5,000) Dep’n buildings Dep’n plant Dep’n plant (W2) Cost per TB Sale and leaseback correction Dep’n per TB Charge (300,000 – 60,000)/40 years 80,000/5 years (217,200 – 49,200) x 20% Carrying value $000 51,300 316,900 (80,000) (52,000) 6,000 16,000 33,600 ––––––– 291,800 ––––––– Buildings Fixtures and fittings $000 $000 300,000 217,200 80,000 ––––––– ––––––– 300,000 297,200 ––––––– ––––––– 18,000 49,200 6,000 ––––––– 24,000 ––––––– 276,000 ––––––– 16,000 33,600 ––––––– 98,800 ––––––– 198,400 ––––––– (W3) Note 1 Energiser has recorded sale of plant by making the following double entries: Dr Cr Dr Cr 456 Bank Revenue Cost of Sales Non­current assets 100 million 100 million 80 million 80 million KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 These double entries should now be reversed since the transaction has been accounted for incorrectly. In substance, this is a loan of the sale proceeds of £100 million and the plant should remain in fixed assets at $80 million. The loan carries interest at 12% per annum. Note that only four months’ worth of interest is charged in the year ended 31 December 20X4 since the transaction took place on 1 September 20X4. The following double entries should now be recorded: Dr Cr Dr Cr Bank Lease creditor Income statement – interest Lease creditor 100 million 100 million 4 million 4 million (W4) Deferred tax 1 January Decrease (balance) 31 December (91,000 x 30%) $000 29,400 (2,100) ––––––– 27,300 ––––––– (W5) Loan note Proceeds Issue costs – discount at 6% Net proceeds KAPLAN PUBLISHING $000 60,000 (3,600) ––––––– 56,400 ––––––– 457 Questions & Answers Repayments Loan note Premium at 10% Interest (60,000 x 8% x 4 years) Net proceeds Finance costs 60,000 6,000 19,200 ––––––– 85,200 (56,400) ––––––– 28,800 ––––––– Annual finance cost to Income statement = $28,800,000/4 yrs = $7,200,000 Double entries: Dr Cr Dr Cr Dr Cr Bank Loan note Interest payable Loan note Loan note Bank 56.4m 56.4m 7.2m 7.2m 4.8m 4.8m (8% interest paid on 31 December 20X4) (W6) Factored debt Energiser has Dr Dr Cr Bank (80% x 12 million) Admin expenses Trade receviables 9.6 million 2.4 million 12 million The terms indicate that Energiser still faces all of the risks and rewards attaching to the $12 million trade receivable. Therefore in substance the $12 million is a short­term loan for four months with interest at 1% per month. 458 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Therefore, the above double entry should be reversed and the following double entry made: Dr Cr Dr Cr Bank Short­term loan Interest (1% x 9.6 million) Short­term loan 9.6 million 9.6 million 96,000 96,000 (W7) Retained earnings $000 84,404 5,000 ––––––– 79,404 128,400 ––––––– 207,804 Profit for the year Dividends Retained earnings for the year Retained earnings b/f Retained earnings c/f Test your understanding 22 ­ Telenorth Answer 2 a. (i) Telenorth Income statement for year to 30 September 20X1 $000 Sales revenue Cost of sales (W1) Gross profit Distribution expenses Administration expenses (W1) KAPLAN PUBLISHING (22,300) (42,200) –––––––– $000 283,460 (155,170) –––––––– 128,290 (64,500) –––––––– 63,790 459 Questions & Answers Financing cost (96 + 600) (W3) Investment income (696) 1,500 –––––––– 804 –––––––– 64,594 (24,600) –––––––– 39,994 –––––––– Profit before tax Income tax (23,400 + 1,200) Net profit for the period (ii) Telenorth Statement of financial position as at 30 September 20X1 Assets Non­current assets Property, plant and equipment (W2) Investments Current assets Inventory (W4) Trade accounts receivable (35,700 + 12,000) (W3) $000 16,680 47,700 $000 83,440 34,500 –––––––– 117,940 64,380 –––––––– –––––––– 182,320 –––––––– Equity and liabilities Equity: Ordinary shares of $1 each (20,000 + 4,000 + 6,000)(W6) 8% Preference shares Reserves: Revaluation (3,400 – 1,000 deferred tax) Share premium (4,000 + 12,000)(W6) Retained earnings (W6) 460 30,000 12,000 –––––––– 42,000 2,400 16,000 51,194 69,594 –––––––– –––––––– 111,594 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Non­current liabilities 6% Loan notes Deferred tax (5,200 + 1,200 + 1,000) Current liabilities Trade and other payables (W5) Loan from Kwikfinance (9,600 + 96) (W3) Provision for income tax Dividends (W5) Overdraft Total equity and liabilities 10,000 7,400 –––––––– 18,070 9,696 23,400 480 1,680 –––––––– 17,400 53,326 –––––––– 182,320 –––––––– Workings (all figures in $000) (W1) Cost of sales: Opening inventory Purchases Depreciation (W2) Closing inventory (W4) Administration: Per question Incorrect factoring charge (W3) Depreciation of computer system (W2) KAPLAN PUBLISHING 12,400 147,200 12,250 ––––––– 171,850 (16,680) ––––––– 155,170 ––––––– 34,440 (2,400) 10,160 ––––––– 42,200 ––––––– 461 Questions & Answers (W2) Property, plant and equipment Leasehold Plant and equipment Computer system Cost Depreciation Carrying value 56,250 20,250 (18,000 + 2,250) 55,000 22,800 (12,800 + 10,000) 35,000 19,760 (9,600 + 10,160) 36,000 32,200 15,240 –––––– 83,440 –––––– Depreciation for year: Leasehold (56,250/25 years) Plant (55,000 – 5,000/5­year life) 2,250 10,000 ––––––– 12,250 ––––––– Charged to cost of sales Computer system charged to administration (35,000 – 9,600) x 40%) 10,160 ––––––– (W3) Accounts receivable/factoring As Telenorth still bears the risk of slow payment and bad debts, the substance of the factoring is that of a loan on which finance charges will be made. The amount receivable from the customer should not have been derecognised (removed from the SFP) nor should all of the difference between the amount due from the customer and the amount received from the factor have been treated as an administration cost. The required adjustments are as follows: Accounts receivable Loan from factor Administration (12,000 – 9,600) Finance costs: accrued interest ($9.6 million x 1.0%) Accruals Dr 12,000 9,600 2,400 96 –––––– 12,096 –––––– 462 Cr 96 –––––– 12,096 –––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 There would also be loan note interest of $600,000 charged for the year ($300,000 paid + $300,000 accrued). (W4) Closing inventory As this was not counted at the year­end, the actual value counted needs to be adjusted for movements in the period between the year­end and the date of the count: Balance on 4 October 20X1 Add goods sold at cost: normal sales (1,400/140 x 100) sale or return (650/130 x 100) Less goods received at cost Adjusted value 16,000 1,000 500 (820) –––––– 16,680 –––––– (W5) Current liabilities Trade and other payables: Accounts payable from question Accrued loan note interest (W3) 17,770 300 –––––– 18,070 –––––– 480 –––––– Dividends (W6) Share capital/retained earnings/suspense account: The elimination of the suspense account is as follows: Suspense account (per trial balance) Directors’ options: share capital (4 million at $1) share premium (4 million at $1) Rights issue: share capital (20 million + 4 million)/4) share premium (6 million at $2) Dr 26,000 4,000 4,000 6,000 –––––– 26,000 –––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING Cr 12,000 –––––– 26,000 –––––– 463 Questions & Answers Retained earnings: Balance 1 October 20X0 Net profit for the period Dividends – Preference (8% x 12,000) Ordinary Balance 30 September 20X1 14,160 39,994 960 2,000 –––––– (2,960) –––––– 51,194 –––––– Test your understanding 23 ­ Picklette Answer 3 Picklette income statement Revenue Cost of sales (470 + 150 – 250 + (60% × 30)) Gross profit Distribution ((20% x 30) + 240) Administration ((20% x 30) + 170 ­ 15) Operating profit Finance costs Profit before tax Income Tax (135 + 10) Profit for the period 464 $000 1,300 (388) ––––– 912 (246) (161) ––––– 505 (5) ––––– 500 (145) ––––– 355 ––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Statement of financial position $000 Non current assets Tangible (W1) Current assets Inventory Receivables Bank $000 182 250 728 9 ––––– 987 ––––– 1,169 ––––– Share capital Retained earnings (W2) 200 619 ––––– 819 Non­current liabilities Loan Provision for warranties Current liabilities (60 + 135) KAPLAN PUBLISHING 80 75 ––––– 155 195 ––––– 1,169 ––––– 465 Questions & Answers Working 1 Cost b/f Depreciation b/f Charge c/f Carrying value c/f Land and buildings $000 Plant and machinery $000 Total 210 –––– 125 –––– 335 –––– 48 5 –––– 53 –––– 75 25 –––– 100 –––– 123 30 –––– 153 –––– 157 –––– 25 –––– 182 –––– $000 Working 2 Profit for the year Dividends Retained earnings b/f Retained earnings c/f $000 355 (6) –––– 349 270 –––– 619 –––– Test your understanding 24 ­ Mrs Harper Answer 1 a. (i) The requirement in IFRS 5 Non­current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations to provide an analysis between continuing and discontinued operations is intended to improve the predictive usefulness of financial statements. 466 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 In essence there can be no more important information when trying to assess the future performance of a company than to know which parts of it are continuing their operations and those which have ceased or been sold or are about to be in the near future. Only the results of continuing operations should be used in forecasting future results; profits or losses from discontinued operations will not be repeated. Information on discontinued operations can also help to assess management’s strategy. One would expect loss­making activities to be sold or closed down, but selling a profitable activity may indicate that a company has liquidity or debt problems. (ii) If no information on continuing and discontinued activities were available then the best estimate of the future profit of both companies would be $110 million (i.e. $100 million × 110%). Utilising the available information, a very different picture emerges: Gamma Toga $ million $ million Forecast profit 77 209 Gamma’s forecast is based on profit from continuing activities of $70 million increasing by 10% to $77 million. Toga’s forecast is also based on its continuing activities, but it is in two parts. The ‘existing’ activities that made profits of $90 million would be expected to produce profits of $99 million in 20X3. Its newly acquired activities would be expected to produce profits of $110 million. The latter figure is based on the $50 million profit in 20X2 being for only six months, a full year would have presumably yielded $100 million. In 20X3 this would increase by 10% to $110 million. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 467 Questions & Answers (b) There are two main reasons why the income tax charge in the financial statements is not at the same rate as the stated percentage. The first reason is that tax is payable on the taxable profits of a company, which may differ considerably from the accounting profit. Such differences may be because some items of income or expenditure included in the financial statements may be disallowable for tax purposes (or allowed in a different accounting period) and some taxation allowances (e.g. tax depreciation allowances) are not included in the accounting profit. These differences may be mitigated by deferred tax on temporary differences. The second reason for differences is that the income tax charge does not usually consist solely of the charge on the current year’s profit. Commonly the tax charge also includes an element of deferred tax (this may be a debit or credit) and possibly an adjustment to the previous year’s tax provision (due to it being settled at an amount different to the provision). Other more complex items such as withholding taxes on income and double (dual) taxation relief may also be included in the tax charge. The main reason why the income tax charge in the income statement differs to that in the statement of cash flows is that the tax charge in the financial statements is a provision for tax that is normally settled in the following period. This means that the cash flow figure for tax actually paid is the amount needed to settle the previous year’s tax liability. Other differences may be due to items referred to above such as deferred tax movements that are not cash flows. Test your understanding 25 ­ Bewley Answer 2 Under IFRS 5 Non­current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations the engineering division meets the definition of a disposal group which must be treated in the financial statements in the same way as an asset ‘held for sale’. As the division was not sold until after the year end then the directors must include it in the statement of financial position at the lower of the carrying amount and the fair value less costs to sell. The current carrying value of the division is $46m ($66m – $20m) and the fair value less costs to sell is the agreed value of $30m. Therefore the division should appear in the statement of financial position at 31 March 20X0 at a value of $30m quite separate from Bewley’s other non­ current assets. The impairment of $16m ($46m – $30m) must be recognised in the income statement. 468 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 As the division is classified as ‘held for sale’, it represents a separate major line of business and it is part of a single co­ordinated plant to dispose of this separate major line, then it meets the IFRS 5 definition of discontinued operations. Therefore in the income statement there should be a single amount comprising the total post­tax profit or loss of the division and the $16m impairment required to measure the division at fair value less costs to sell. As the company is committed to the closure it should also recognise a provision for the cost of the closure (as required by IAS 37). The total provision should be made up of the following amounts: Redundancies Professional costs Penalty costs $m 2.0 1.5 3.0 ––– 6.5 ––– The operating losses of $4.5 million in the period from 1 April 20X0 until the date of closure can no longer be provided for at the date the closure is announced. IAS 37 Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets now prohibits this type of provision unless it relates to losses on ‘onerous contracts’. There is no indication in the question that these future losses relate to onerous contracts. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 469 Questions & Answers Test your understanding 26 ­ Rodney Miller Answer 1 (i) The trend shown by a comparison of a company’s profits over time is rather a ‘raw’ measure of performance and can be misleading without careful interpretation of all the events that the company has experienced. In the year to 30 September 20X2, Taylor’s eps has increased by 25% (from 20 cents to 25 cents), whereas its profit has increased by a massive 67% (from $30 to $50 million). It is not possible to determine exactly what has caused the difference between the percentage increase in the eps and the percentage increase in the reported profit of Taylor, but a simpler example may illustrate a possible explanation. Assume company A acquired company B by way of a share exchange. Both companies had the same market value and the same profits. A comparison of A’s post combination profits with its pre­combination profits would be very misleading. They would have appeared to double. This is because the post combination figures incorporate both companies’ results, whereas the pre­combination profits would be those of company A alone. The trend shown by the earnings per share goes some way to addressing such distortion. In the above the increase in post combination profit would also be accompanied by an increase in the issued share capital (due to the share exchange) thus the reported eps of company A would not be distorted by its acquisitive growth. It can therefore be argued that the trend of a company’s eps is a more reliable measure of its earnings performance than the trend shown by its reported profits. (ii) Both the convertible loan stock and the directors’ share options will give rise to dilution: 8% Loan stock – on conversion there will be 140 million new shares (200 million x 70/100). The interest saved, net of tax at 25%, will be $12 million ($200 million x 8% x 75%). The directors’ share options will yield income of $75 million (50 million x $1.50). At the market price of $2.50 this would be sufficient to purchase 30 million shares. As the options are for 50 million shares the dilutive effect of the options is 20 million shares. 470 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Diluted EPS year to 30 September 20X2: Earnings Number of shares $62 million 360 million (basic $50 million + $12 million re loan stock) (basic 200 million + 140 million re loan stock + 20 million re options) Diluted eps 17.2 cents (iii) The relevance of the diluted earnings per share measure is that it highlights the problem of relying too heavily on a company’s basic eps when trying to predict future performance. There can exist certain circumstances which may cause future eps to be lower than current levels irrespective of future profit performance. These are said to cause a dilution of the eps. Common examples of diluting circumstances are the existence of convertible loan stock or share options that may cause an increase in the future number of shares without being accompanied by a proportionate increase in earnings. It is important to realise that a diluted eps figure is not a prediction of what the future eps will be, but it is a ‘warning’ to shareholders that, based on the current level of earnings, the basic reported eps would be lower if the diluting circumstances had crystallised. Clearly future eps will be based on future profits and the number of shares in issue. Test your understanding 27 ­ Niagara’s Answer 2 (i) All items in arriving at the profit for the financial year are included in the calculation of the earnings per share. Earnings attributable to the ordinary shares are after the deduction of the following dividends on the non­redeemable preference shares: 8% on $1 million for full year new issue 6% on $1 million for six months Preference dividends Earnings attributable to ordinary shares (2,585,000 – 110,000) $ 80,000 30,000 –––––––– 110,000 –––––––– $2,475,000 –––––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING 471 Questions & Answers Weighted average number of shares in issue: Calculation of theoretical ex­rights price: 100 shares at $2.40 would be worth rights to 20 shares at $1.50 each costing $ 240 30 –––– 270 –––– 120 shares now worth This gives a theoretical ex­rights value of $2.25 per share ($270/120). Weighted average calculation: 12,000,000 x $2.4/$2.25 x 3/12 14,400,000 (12 million x 1.2) x 9/12 Weighted average number 3,200,000 10,800,000 –––––––––– 14,000,000 –––––––––– Earnings per share is 1 7.7c ($2,475,000/14,000,000 x 100). Restated earnings per share for the year to 31 March 20X2 is 22.5c (24 x 2.25/2.40). (ii) Fully diluted earnings per share On conversion the loan stock would create an extra 800,000 new shares ($2 million x 40/$100). The effect on earnings would be a saving of interest of $140,000 ($2 million x 7%) before tax and $98,000 after tax (140,000 x (100% – 30%)). The directors’ warrants would create an additional 750,000 new shares without any effect on earnings. Fully diluted earnings per share is 16.5c ((2,475,000 + 98,000)/(14,000,000 + 800,000 + 750,000)). 472 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 The basic earnings per share is a measure of past performance. The diluted earnings per share figure is more forward looking and is intended to act as a warning to existing and prospective shareholders. Although it is still based on past performance, it does give effect to potential ordinary shares outstanding during the period. Its disclosure is required where circumstances exist that would cause the eps to be lower if those circumstances had crystallised. It is not a prediction of the future earnings per share figures, as these will be based on the future profits and the number of shares in issue in the future. The diluted EPS is more a ‘theoretical’ value, as it is unlikely that the profit in the period when the circumstances crystallise will be the same as the current year’s profit. The convertible loan stock in the question is a good example of diluting circumstance. On conversion the share entitlement will cause the number of shares in issue in the future to be greater than the present (assuming loan stockholders opt for conversion). There will be a compensating increase in profit as a result of the non­payment of interest but overall the expected conversion will cause a dilution. Test your understanding 28 ­ Webster Answer 1 Income statements to 31 March 20X0 Cole Darwin $000 $000 $000 $000 Sales (3,000 – 125 W1) 2,875 4,400 Opening inventory 450 720 Purchases (W2) 2,055 3,080 ––––– ––––– 2,505 3,800 Closing inventory (540) (1,965) (850) (2,950) ––––– ––––– ––––– ––––– Gross profit 910 1,450 Operating expenses 480 964 Depreciation 40 (W3) (120) adjustment Debenture interest 80 nil Overdraft interest 15 (615) ((W4) nil (844) ––––– ––––– ––––– ––––– Net profit 295 606 ––––– ––––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING 473 Questions & Answers Statements of financial position as at 31 March 20X0 Cole Darwin Non­current assets Property (W3) Plant Current assets Inventory Accounts receivable (522 + 375 W1) Bank (W4) 1,900 1,200 ––––– 3,100 1,900 (W3) 720 ––––– 2,620 540 850 897 nil ––––– 750 1,437 (W4) 60 ––––– ––––– 4,537 ––––– Total assets Equity and liabilities Equity shares of $1 each Reserves: Revaluation reserve (W3) Retained earnings (684 + 295 + 40) 1,000 1,660 ––––– 4,280 ––––– 500 760 (1,912 + 1,019 606) 700 2,518 ––––– 2,779 ––––– 3,718 800 nil Non­current liabilities 10% Debentures Current liabilities Trade accounts payable (438 – 275 W2) Overdraft (W4) Total equity and liabilities 163 795 ––––– 562 958 ––––– 4,537 ––––– nil ––––– 562 ––––– 4,280 ––––– Workings: all figures in $000 (W1) If the sale to Brander of $500 had been on normal commercial terms it would have been $375. Applying this would cause a reduction in sales of $125. The effect of applying normal credit arrangements would be that the revised sales figure of $375 would still be in accounts receivable and the original sale proceeds of $500 would not have been received and thus increase Cole’s overdraft (see W4). 474 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 (W2) The purchase from Advent under normal trading terms would have resulted in an increase in cost of sales of $25. Applying a normal two­month credit period would mean that the goods would have been paid for by the year­end thus increasing the overdraft by a further $300, and accounts payable would be reduced by the original value of the transaction of $275. (W3) Non­current assets/depreciation Cole – property Depreciation for the year to 31 March 20X0 based on the revalued amount would be the same as Darwin’s, $100 (2,000/20 years), this would give Cole an additional depreciation charge of $40 (100 × 60). The revaluation of Cole’s property would lead to a revaluation reserve of $800. An amount equal to the excess depreciation of $40 is normally transferred from the revaluation reserve to retained earnings. Darwin – plant As the plant acquired in February 20X0 has not yet contributed to the operations of Darwin, then, for comparability purposes, it could be logical to ignore its acquisition. The effects of this are: – cost of plant would be reduced by $600. This would also affect the bank balance – see (W4) below. – depreciation of $120 (600 x 20%) would be reversed. The overall effect of depreciation in the income statements would be: Original depreciation on property (1,200 – 1,140) Depreciation on revalued amount Reversal of depreciation on new plant Net depreciation adjustment KAPLAN PUBLISHING Cole $000 (60) Darwin $000 100 –––– debit 40 –––– (120) –––– credit (120) –––– 475 Questions & Answers Summary of non­current assets: Cost/ revaluation Depreciation $000 $000 Carrying value $000 2,000 100 1,900 6,000 4,800 1,200 ––––– 3,100 ––––– 2,000 2,400 (3,000 – 600) 100 1,680 (1,800 – 120) 1,900 720 Cole – property – plant (unchanged) Darwin – property – plant ––––– 2,620 ––––– (W4) Bank balances – balance b/f – reversal of sale proceeds – payment for increased purchases – payment for plant reversed – payment/saving of overdraft interest – balance c/f Cole $000 20 (500) (300) (15) –––– (795) –––– Darwin $000 (550) 600 10 –––– 60 –––– (b) Ratios from question: Return on capital employed Asset turnover Gross profit margin Net profit margin Accounts receivable collection period Accounts payable payment period 476 Cole 19.4% 1.01 times 35.3% 16.7% 64 days 79 days Darwin 13.3% 1.23 times 33.0% 10.8% 62 days 67 days KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Ratios from restated financial statements: Return on capital employed Cole 10.5% (295 + 80)/(2779 + 800) x 100 Asset turnover (2875/3,579) 0.80 times Gross profit margin (910/2875) x 100 31.7% Net profit margin (295/2,875) x 100 10.3% Accounts receivable collection period (897/2875) x 365 114 days Accounts payable payment period (163/2055) x 365 29 days Drawin 16.3% (606/3,718) x 100 (4,400/3,718) 1.18 times 33.0% (606/4,400) x 13.8% 100 62 days 67 days Note: the figures without workings have not changed. Comments: An assessment of the performance of the two companies based on the unadjusted ratios would favour Cole as most of its ‘key’ ratios are better than Darwin’s. Cole’s overall profitability as measured by the ROCE is higher. This is due to higher profit margins as Darwin’s asset turnover is in fact higher than Cole’s. A point of note is that both companies have rather poor asset turnovers, implying inefficient use of assets. The management of working capital of the two companies is rather similar with the exception that Cole is obtaining (or taking) a slightly longer credit period from its suppliers. Webster may be better advised to calculate liquidity ratios as well as working capital ratios. This would show that Cole’s liquidity ratios are a healthy 2.5 (1,082/438) and 1.23 (542/438) for the current and quick ratios (acid test) respectively, whereas Darwin’s figures are only 1.4 (1,600/1,112) and 0.7 (750/1,112) which are a cause for concern and further investigation. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 477 Questions & Answers When the above ratios are recalculated on the adjusted financial statements, the relative position is very much reversed. The favourable trading terms and conditions that have been orchestrated by Cole’s parent company have favourably distorted its financial statements. Equally, due to the limitations of traditional ratio analysis, Darwin’s ratios are unfavourably affected by its policy of revaluing property, and acquiring additional plant just before the year­end. The revised ratios show Darwin is much more profitable than Cole with better margins and more efficient use of assets. Further Cole’s ‘true’ liquidity position is not impressive; a current ratio of 1.5 (1,437/958) and a quick ratio of 0.93 (897/ 958). The management of working capital figures show poor credit control of accounts receivable (114 days) and, despite the question saying Cole normally takes two months credit, there is very early payment of suppliers. This may be due to suppliers imposing strict terms as a result of past experiences, or Cole may have a poor credit rating. It can also be seen that Darwin’s poor liquidity ratios are in the main due to financing the acquisition of the new plant from overdraft facilities. Darwin may be advised to re­finance this plant from medium term borrowings (say a five­year debenture). In coming to a decision about which company Webster should purchase there are many other factors that should be considered, as examples: (i) What is the asking price of the companies? If Cole is priced cheaply, reflecting its problems, and Darwin is expensive clearly this will be critical in any decision to purchase. (c) (ii) It must be remembered that Webster will be buying the future profits/cash flows of a company and past financial statements may be misleading in this respect. For example the new plant coming on stream will affect Darwin’s future profits. Another aspect relating to this point is that other information (which may not be available to Webster) may be very useful e.g. profit and cash flow forecasts. Also non­financial information can be very important, for example, has either company got a full or an empty order book? Does either company have a history of good or poor labour relations? (iii) It may be that neither company would be a good purchase and other potential acquisitions should be considered. (d) Information in the notes: Assuming that financial statements are prepared in accordance with International Accounting Standards and are publicly available, most of the information in notes (1) to (5) of the question would have to be disclosed in the financial statements. 478 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Specifically: (1) and (2) This information concerns related party transactions. IAS 24 Related Party Disclosures specifically says the following must be disclosed: – the nature of related party transactions including: – the volume of transactions – outstanding items – any other elements necessary for an understanding of the financial statements (this may include disclosure of the details of profit margins and credit terms). (3) IAS 16 Property, Plant and Equipment requires that where a company adopts revalued amounts for its properties these values would be included in the statement of financial position with various supporting information. IAS 16 also encourages the disclosure of the ‘fair value’ (which is probably similar to the market value) of property, plant and equipment where this is materially different from its carrying amount. If Cole has responded to this encouragement the market value of its property would be disclosed. However even if the fair value has not been disclosed, an informed ‘user’ of financial statements may have a shrewd idea of its value as a result of a knowledge of property market conditions in general. (4) Although the acquisition of the plant would be detailed as part of the movement in non­current assets, the exact date of purchase and the manner of its financing would not usually be available. (5) In the absence of the information in respect of notes (1) and (2) it would be impossible to calculate the effect they would have on Cole’s overdraft and on its interest cost. Even where such transactions have to be disclosed it is unlikely that they would extend to the specific disclosure of an implied interest cost. Tutorial note: Journal entries for the adjustments in part (a) $000 Cole (i) (ii) KAPLAN PUBLISHING Dr Sales Dr Accounts receivable Cr Bank Dr Purchases Dr Trade accounts payable Cr Bank $000 125 375 500 25 275 300 479 Questions & Answers (iii) (v) Dr Property (SFP carrying value) Cr Revaluation reserve Dr Depreciation (income statement) 40 Cr Property (SFP carrying value) Dr Overdraft interest 15 Cr Bank 800 Dr Bank Cr Plant Dr Plant Cr Depreciation (income statement) Dr Bank Cr Overdraft interest 600 800 40 15 Darwin (iv) 600 120 120 10 10 Test your understanding 29 ­ Judicious Answer 2 (a) A company that is a wholly owned subsidiary is a related party of its parent company. This means that the financial statements may have been affected by related party transactions. Such transactions may or may not be at ‘arm’s length’ i.e. on normal commercial terms. Even where related party transactions are at arm’s length, it is still important to realise that they are related party transactions. This is because it is quite possible that they would not have occurred but for the relationship. For example a parent company may purchase all of its motor vehicle fleet requirements from one of its subsidiaries on normal commercial terms. Whilst this may appear perfectly proper, it may mean that, but for the custom of its parent, the subsidiary’s sales and profits would have been much less. The types of transaction that may occur between related parties are: 480 – purchases and sales, possibly at favourable prices or advantageous settlement terms; provision of finance, again possibly at artificially low (favourable) rates of interest – equipment or other property may be provided under favourable terms – favourable agency arrangements – provision of services, such as sharing technical knowledge from research and development activities or allowing patented goods to be produced under licence, and KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 – guarantees for loans or overdrafts. All of the above would mean that there is hardly any area of financial reporting that could not be influenced by the presence of related party transactions with the possibility that this may cause severe distortion of the financial statements. Although there is a requirement to disclose related party relationships and transactions, many related party transactions may not be disclosed. Apart from related party issues, a common error when dealing with individual subsidiaries is to assume that the liabilities of an individual subsidiary may be ‘covered’ by assets owned by other members of the group, or that the parent company will guarantee a subsidiary’s liabilities. This is not usually the case. (b) Report on the Financial Position of Breadline Introduction The following report is based on the available financial statements of Breadline for the year to 31 December 20X1, which include comparative figures for the year 20X0. The comments have been based on taking the financial statements at face value. Towards the end of the report under ‘causes of concern’ I have expressed matters that could seriously affect the position of Breadline as portrayed in its financial statements. Profitability Breadline’s overall profitability has shown a creditable improvement from a ROCE of 41% to 47.1%. Calculation of the asset turnover and profit margins reveal that this improvement has arisen from increased profit margins (at both the gross and net level) as the asset turnover of Breadline has declined from 2.6 to 2.0 times. Liquidity This is an area of concern as both the current ratio and the quick ratio (acid test) have deteriorated considerably from normal and acceptable positions in 20X0 to worryingly low levels of 1.1:1 (current) and 0.77:1 (quick) in 20X1. Looking in more depth at the composition of these ratios: Inventory holding has gone from 18 days to 23 days. In general these are relatively low levels, but given the trade of Breadline (bakery), large inventory holdings would not be expected. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 481 Questions & Answers The accounts receivable collection period shows a modest decline from 34 days in 20X0 to 41 days in 20X1; despite the worsening of this ratio it is still an efficient collection period. The accounts payable period: two figures have been calculated for this ratio. The figure for the payment of our own balance shows a very serious worsening of the payment period from 46 days (which was in line with our credit terms) in 20X0 to an unacceptable period of 103 days for 20X1. The payment period when our own balance is excluded also shows an increasing payment period from 45 days in 20X0 to 53 days in 20X1, however this is nothing like the increase for our own account. Although the increasing payment period is partly responsible for the worsening of the liquidity ratios of Breadline, it is the deterioration in the cash position that is the main cause. It has gone from a balance in hand of $250,000 in 20X0 to an overdraft of $220,000 in 20X1. Further evidence of a deteriorating cash flow position is the company having to raise a loan (of $500,000) in the current year. Gearing and financing Gearing is not a significant issue for Breadline. The company had nil gearing in 20X0 and the issue of the loan note (at the beginning of the current year) has created modest gearing of 12%. The company appears to have made an issue of shares during the year to the amount of $600,000 cash ($400,000 capital + $200,000 premium – see below). This is a significant amount representing 17% of net assets at the end of 20X0. It would appear the composition of the retained earnings at 31 December 20X1 is made up of a brought forward balance of $1,700,000 plus $600,000 retained profit for the current year (after a dividend of $900,000) and the transfer of the revaluation reserve of $700,000 to realised profits (as the company’s freehold has now been sold). Thus it must be a cash issue of shares that has caused the increase in share capital and share premium. 482 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Causes of concern/further investigations Sale of property The company appears to have sold its freehold premises and leased it back as a leasehold property. The main reason for this conclusion is that our company is aware that Breadline traded from the same business address in both 20X0 and 20X1. There is no indication of how long the lease is, but even if it is for a long period, its cost ($2.5 million) is likely to have been less than the freehold was sold for as even a long lease would be worth less than the freehold. Therefore there must have been a large profit on the sale of at least $1,250,000. This should be $2,500,000 (minimum value of the freehold) less $1,250,000 (the carrying value of the freehold). This profit has been included in the income statement as a reduction of the cost of sales. This profit seems to be largely responsible for the improvement in Breadline’s margins and overall profitability. If the ROCE is calculated excluding this profit it would be 17.4% [(1,970 +10 – 1,250)/(3,700 + 500) × 100)], which is much worse than the previous year’s 41%. Normally this type and size of profit is separately disclosed either on the face of the income statement or in a note to the financial statements. It should not be considered as a reduction of the cost of sales. Clearly any prospective purchaser of Breadline cannot expect to repeat this type of profit in future periods. Issue of Loan note/Share capital The most striking feature of the issue of the loan note is the interest rate it carries. At only 2% this is well below the commercial rate of 8%. It is possible that the loan note has been issued to Breadline’s parent company, and the low interest rate is a feature of the related party relationship. If it is not a related party transaction, it may be that the low interest is compensated for by high premium on its redemption. If this is so the premium should be amortised over the life of the loan note to give a higher finance charge. One way or another it appears that the issue of the loan note has led to an artificially low finance cost and is another example of flattering profitability. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 483 Questions & Answers The issue of the shares is even more perplexing. As Breadline is a 100% owned subsidiary of Wheatmaster, the shares must have been issued to Wheatmaster. It is not immediately obvious why this share issue occurred. The practical effect of the issue is that Breadline received $600,000 from its parent. What is interesting is that Breadline paid a dividend of $900,000 to its parent company during the year. Given the size of Breadline’s overdraft, it may have had insufficient cash to pay the dividend without the receipt from the proceeds of the share issue. Thus the issue may have been a mechanism to enable Breadline to transfer some of its profits to its parent company. Conclusion The apparent improvement in Breadline’s profitability seems largely due to related party issues and the sale and leaseback of the freehold property. Thus it is illusory rather than a genuine commercial improvement. The company’s liquidity is also poor and its most valuable asset (the freehold property) has now been replaced by a leasehold property of unknown duration. All of these may be symptoms of the parent company preparing to sell the business and attempting to improve the financial position of Breadline. There is insufficient information to conclude whether Breadline would be a good (or poor) acquisition, but it is important that such an evaluation is made based on ‘non­manipulated’ information. A more immediate concern is the deterioration in the payment period to our company. Breadline must be contacted immediately to find out why the account is so late in being paid. It would not be advisable to allow any further trading on credit until the account is within the stated credit terms. Enquiries should be made as to why our internal credit control procedures have allowed the situation to develop this far. D E Franks Assistant Financial Controller 484 KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Appendix Performance ratios 20X1 Return on capital employed 47.1% (1,970 + 10)/ (3,700 + 500) x 100 Net assets turnover 2.0 times (8,500/4,200) Gross profit margin (see 30% below) (2,550/8,500) x 100 Net profit (after tax) margin 17.6% (1,500/8,500) x 100 Current ratio (1,330/1,250) 1.1:1 Quick ratio (960/1,250) 0.77:1 Inventory holding period 23 days (370/5,950) x 365 Accounts receivable collection 41 days period (960/8,500) x 365 Accounts payable payment 53 days period (see below) (excluding Judicious) (1,030 – 340)/ (5,950 – 1,200)) x 365 Judicious payment period 103 days (340/1,200) x 365 Gearing (500/4,200) x 100 12% 20X0 (1,025/2,500) x 41.0% 100 (6,500/2,500) 2.6 times (1,690/6,500) x 100 (850/6,500) x 100 (1,090/590) (850/590) (240/4,810) x 365 (600/6,500) x 365 (590 – 100)/ (4,810 – 800) x 365 26% 13.1% 1.8:1 1.4:1 18 days 34 days 45 days (100/800) x 365 46 days The 2% loan note has been treated as a financing item in calculating the net asset turnover. The accounts payable payment period is based on the cost of sales as the purchases figure is not available. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 485 Questions & Answers Test your understanding 30 ­ Placid Answer 1 a. Statement of cash flows Operating profit Depreciation Inventory increase Trade receivables increase Trade payables decrease Amortisation Profit on disposal of FA Non cash purchase Cash generated from operations Interest received (79 – 5) Interest paid Taxation Investing activities Sale of tangible non­current assets Acquisition of intangible assets Acquisition of tangible non­current assets Acquisition of Investments. Sale of current asset investments Financing activities Debenture Issue Share Issue (70 S/P + 5 S/C) Equity dividend paid Cash flow 486 $m 139 22 (118) (107) (67) 7 (6) 70 –––– (60) 74 (55) (5) –––– (46) 250 (50) (438) (1) 25 –––– (214) 130 75 (22) –––– 183 –––– (77) –––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 (b) Cash flow interpretation (1) Statement of cash flows – Cash generated from operations is negative which is worrying as it indicates that cash may not be available to finance mandatory cash outflows such as tax in the future. Further investigation, however reveals that this is largely due to the very poor management of working capital. Assuming that working capital management can be improved in the near future, the outflow of cash from operations should be able to be reversed. – The level of expenditure on non­current assets is very high and far exceeds the proceeds of the sale of non­current assets plus depreciation. This suggests that the company is not only replacing those assets that it disposed of in the year, but also investing to increase its non­current asset base and so achieve growth. – The majority of the cash to finance this expansion has been raised through the issue of debentures and shares. (2) Working capital management – Placid is building up inventory and appears to be giving extended credit to its customers. Both of these activities mean that cash is tied up in working capital. Despite this trade payables are decreasing, suggesting that they are being paid quickly – possibly earlier than required. This mis­management of working capital is resulting in an unhealthy statement of cash flows. Conclusion Placid itself is financially healthy, as indicated by the income statement and statement of financial position: • • It shows a good operating profit. It is able to issue shares which suggests that the market is confident of its prospects. The management of working capital is, however, a key area for improvement. KAPLAN PUBLISHING 487 Questions & Answers Recommendations • • • • • • Review management decisions. Sweep up overdraft. Achieve control of inventory by selling it. Tighten up the credit control function Use the credit facilities extended by suppliers. Delay further non­current asset investment. Test your understanding 31 ­ Nedberg Answer 2 (a) Statement of cash flows of Nedberg for the Year to 30 September 20X2 $m Cash flows from operating activities Net profit before interest and tax Adjustments for: Amortisation – development expenditure (W1) Depreciation – property, plant and equipment Amortisation of government grant (W2) Loss on sale of plant Increase in inventory (1,420 – 940) Increase in accounts receivable (990 – 680) Increase in accounts payable (875 – 730) Cash generated from operations Interest paid (30 – (15 – 5 accrual adjustments)) Income tax paid (W3) Net cash from operating activities Cash flows from investing activities Purchase of property, plant and equipment (W4) Capitalised development costs (W1) Receipt of government grant Proceeds of sale of plant (W4) 488 $m 920 130 320 (90) 50 (480) (310) 145 –––– 685 (20) (130) 535 (250) (500) 50 20 –––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 Net cash used in investing activities Cash flows from financing activities Issue of ordinary shares (W5) Issue of loan notes (300 – 100) Dividends paid Net cash from financing activities Net increase in cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period Cash and cash equivalents at end of period (680) 450 200 (320) –––– 330 –––– 185 (115) –––– 70 –––– Workings (W1) Development expenditure Balance b/f Amount capitalised Amortisation – balancing figure Balance c/f $m 100 511100 (130) –––– 470 –––– (W2) Government grant Balance b/f Cash received Amortisation Balance c/f KAPLAN PUBLISHING $m 300 50 (90) –––– 260 –––– 489 Questions & Answers (W3) Income tax Tax provision b/f Deferred tax b/f Charged to income statement Tax provision c/f Deferred tax c/f Difference cash paid $m 160 140 270 (130) (310) –––– 130 –––– (W4) Property, plant and equipment Balance b/f Revaluation surplus Plant acquired Depreciation Disposal at net book value – balancing figure Balance c/f Disposal of plant: Net book value from above Loss on sale (from question) Difference is sale proceeds 490 $m 1,830 200 250 (320) (70) –––– 1,890 –––– 70 (50) –––– 20 –––– KAPLAN PUBLISHING chapter 21 (W5) Share capital Ordinary shares b/f Bonus issue 1 for 10 (from revaluation reserve) Ordinary shares c/f Difference issue for cash Plus increase in share premium (350 – 100) Total cash proceeds of issue of ordinary shares $m (500) (50) 750 –––– 200 250 –––– 450 –––– (W6) Reconciliation of reserve movements Revaluation reserve: Balance b/f Revaluation of buildings Bonus issue Transfer to realised profits Balance c/f KAPLAN PUBLISHING $m Nil 200 (50) (10) –––– 140 –––– 491 Questions & Answers (b) The cash flows generated from operations of $685 million are relatively healthy and more than adequate to pay the interest costs and taxation, but not as large as the equivalent profit figure. For most companies the operating cash flows tend to be higher than the profit before interest and tax due to the effects of depreciation/amortisation (which are not cash flows). In the case of Nedberg the depreciation/amortisation effect has been more than offset by a much higher investment in working capital of $645 million. Inventory has increased by over 50% and accounts receivable by 45%. This may be an indication of expanding activity, but it could also be an indication of poor inventory management policy and poor credit control, or even the presence of some obsolete inventory or unprovided bad accounts receivable. A cause of concern is the size of the dividends, at $320 million they represent 52% of the profit for the period. This is a very high distribution ratio, and it seems curious that the company is returning such large amounts to shareholders at the same time as they are raising finance. $450 million has been received from the issue of new shares and $200 million from a further issue of loan notes. The company has invested considerably in new plant ($250 million) and even more so in development expenditure ($500 million). If management has properly applied the capitalisation criteria in IAS 38 Intangible Assets, then this indicates that they expect good future returns from the investment in new products or processes. The net investment in non­current assets is $680 million which closely correlates to the proceeds from financing of $650 million. In general it is acceptable to finance increases in the capacity of non­current assets by raising additional finance, however operating cash flows should finance replacement of consumed non­current assets. 492 KAPLAN PUBLISHING